Ford Automobile 2011 Escape Hybrid User Manual

Table of Contents  
All rights reserved. Reproduction by any means, electronic or mechanical  
including photocopying, recording or by any information storage and retrieval  
system or translation in whole or part is not permitted without written  
authorization from Ford Motor Company. Ford may change the contents without  
notice and without incurring obligation.  
Copyright © 2010 Ford Motor Company  
3
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
CONGRATULATIONS  
Congratulations on acquiring your new Ford Hybrid. Please take the time  
to get well acquainted with your vehicle by reading this handbook. The  
more you know and understand about your vehicle, the greater the  
safety and pleasure you will derive from driving it.  
For more information on Ford Motor Company and its products visit the  
following website:  
In the United States: www.ford.com  
In Canada: www.ford.ca  
Additional owner information is given in separate publications.  
This Owner’s Guide describes every option and model variant available  
and therefore some of the items covered may not apply to your  
particular vehicle. Furthermore, due to printing cycles it may describe  
options before they are generally available.  
Remember to pass on this Owner’s Guide when reselling the vehicle. It is  
an integral part of the vehicle.  
WARNING: Fuel pump and high voltage battery shut-off  
switches: In the event of an accident the fuel pump shut-off  
switch may automatically cut off the fuel supply to the engine and the  
high voltage shut-off switch cuts off power from the high voltage  
battery. These switches can also be activated through sudden vibration  
(e.g. collision when parking). For information on resetting the fuel  
pump shut-off switch and the high voltage battery shutoff switch, refer  
to the Fuel pump/high voltage shut-off switches in the Roadside  
Emergencies chapter.  
4
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Introduction  
SAFETY AND ENVIRONMENT PROTECTION  
Warning symbols in this guide  
How can you reduce the risk of personal injury to yourself or others? In  
this guide, answers to such questions are contained in comments  
highlighted by the warning triangle symbol. These comments should be  
read and observed.  
Warning symbols on your vehicle  
When you see this symbol, it is  
imperative that you consult the  
relevant section of this guide before  
touching or attempting adjustment  
of any kind.  
Protecting the environment  
We must all play our part in  
protecting the environment. Correct  
vehicle usage and the authorized  
disposal of waste, cleaning and  
lubrication materials are significant  
steps towards this aim. Information in this respect is highlighted in this  
guide with the tree symbol.  
CALIFORNIA Proposition 65 Warning  
WARNING: Engine exhaust, some of its constituents, and  
certain vehicle components contain or emit chemicals known to  
the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects or other  
reproductive harm. In addition, certain fluids contained in vehicles and  
certain products of component wear contain or emit chemicals known  
to the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects or other  
reproductive harm.  
PERCHLORATE MATERIAL  
Certain components of this vehicle such as airbag modules, seat belt  
pretensioners, and button cell batteries may contain Perchlorate Material  
– Special handling may apply for service or vehicle end of life disposal.  
See www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate.  
BREAKING-IN YOUR VEHICLE  
Your vehicle does not need an extensive break-in. Try not to drive  
continuously at the same speed for the first 1,000 miles (1,600 km) of  
5
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
new vehicle operation. Vary your speed frequently in order to give the  
moving parts a chance to break in.  
Drive your new vehicle at least 1,000 miles (1,600 km) before towing a  
trailer. For more detailed information about towing a trailer, refer to  
Trailer towing in the Tires, Wheels and Loading chapter.  
Do not add friction modifier compounds or special break-in oils since  
these additives may prevent piston ring seating. See Engine oil in the  
Maintenance and Specifications chapter for more information on oil  
usage.  
HYBRID OPERATION  
This hybrid vehicle combines electric and gasoline propulsion without  
compromise, to provide breakthrough performance and efficiency. It  
requires no special fuels and never has to be plugged in. Familiarizing  
yourself with these unique characteristics will help ensure optimal  
performance from your new vehicle.  
Normal vehicle operation  
Starting: Turn the ignition key to the start position while your vehicle is  
in P (Park). A green vehicle symbol (called the Ready Indicator Light)  
will appear in the lower right corner of the instrument cluster to indicate  
the vehicle is on. This indicator will remain on while the vehicle is on,  
whether the engine is running or not, to indicate the vehicle is capable of  
movement (using its electric motor, engine, or both). The message  
center on the cluster will also momentarily display ЉReady to DriveЉ  
when the vehicle is successfully started. The vehicle’s computer will  
determine if an engine start is required. Typically, the engine will not  
start unless the vehicle is cold, a climate control change is requested, or  
the accelerator is depressed.  
Note: You may notice higher engine speeds upon start-up. This  
temporary condition is normal and necessary to heat up the cabin and  
minimize emissions.  
Driving: The gas engine automatically starts and stops to provide power  
when it’s needed and to save fuel when it’s not. While coasting at low  
speeds, coming to a stop, or standing, the gas engine normally shuts  
down and the vehicle operates in electric-only mode. Conditions that  
may cause the engine to start up or remain running include:  
Considerable vehicle acceleration  
Vehicle speed above 40 mph (65 km/h)  
Ascending a hill  
6
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
Charge level of high voltage battery is low  
Very high or low outside temperature (to provide system  
cooling/heating)  
Engine not warm enough to provide passenger requested cabin  
temperature  
Stopping: The gas engine may shut off to conserve fuel as you come to  
a stop. Restarting the vehicle is not required. Simply step on the  
accelerator when you are ready to drive.  
Transmission Operation: Due to the technologically advanced,  
electronically-controlled Continuously Variable Transaxle (eCVT) you will  
not feel shift changes like those of a non-hybrid vehicle. Your hybrid’s  
transmission is designed to do its work seamlessly.  
Since engine speed is controlled by the transmission, it may seem  
elevated at times. This is normal hybrid operation and helps  
deliver fuel efficiency and performance.  
Neutral: It is not recommended to idle the vehicle in N (Neutral) for  
extended periods of time because this will discharge your high voltage  
battery and decrease fuel economy. Because of the unique nature of the  
hybrid vehicle, the engine will not start in the N (Neutral) position. Also,  
the engine cannot provide power to the hybrid system in N (Neutral).  
Low Gear: L (Low gear) is designed to mimic the enhanced engine  
braking available in non-hybrid vehicles. L (Low gear) will produce high  
engine speeds to provide necessary engine braking. This is normal and  
will not damage your vehicle.  
Reverse: (R) Reverse Gear vehicle speed is limited to 22 mph  
(35 km/h).  
Unique Hybrid operating characteristics  
Your Hybrid, with its new technology, behaves differently compared to a  
non-hybrid. Here is a description of the major differences:  
Battery: Your Hybrid is equipped with a high voltage battery. A cool  
battery ensures battery life and provides the best possible performance.  
Your hybrid high voltage battery may periodically re-condition itself to  
ensure maximum efficiency. You may notice slight changes in drivability  
during this process, but it’s an important part of your hybrid’s high  
voltage battery optimization features.  
The high voltage battery is cooled by cabin air drawn from vent holes in  
the driver-side cargo trim panel. Avoid placing objects over the vent  
holes which block air flow to the high voltage battery.  
7
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
If the vehicle is left inoperative for over 31 days, it may be necessary to  
jumpstart the vehicle. For more information, refer to Jump starting  
(Low voltage [underhood] battery only) in the Roadside Emergencies  
chapter and also refer to Low and high voltage battery — storage in  
the Maintenance and Specifications chapter.  
Engine: The engine speed in your hybrid is not directly tied to your  
vehicle speed. Your vehicle’s engine and transmission are designed to  
deliver the power you need at the most efficient engine speed. During  
heavy accelerations, your hybrid may reach high engine speeds (up to  
6000 RPM). This is characteristic of the Atkinson cycle engine  
technology helping to maximize your hybrid’s fuel economy.  
In prolonged mountainous driving, you may see the engine tachometer  
changing without your input. This is intentional and maintains the  
battery charge level. You may also notice during extended downhill  
driving that your engine continues to run instead of shutting off.  
During this “engine braking”, the engine stays on, but it’s not using any  
fuel. You may also hear a slight whine or whistle when operating your  
vehicle. This is the normal operation of the electric generator in the  
hybrid system.  
During certain events (such as vehicle servicing) your low voltage  
(underhood) battery may become disconnected or disabled. When this  
occurs, and after reconnecting the low voltage (underhood) battery and  
driving the vehicle, the engine may continue to operate for 3-5 seconds  
after the key is turned to the off position. This is a normal condition, as  
the vehicle’s computers are relearning the operating characteristics of  
your particular engine in order to operate it at maximum efficiency.  
Braking: Your hybrid is equipped with standard hydraulic braking and  
regenerative braking. Regenerative braking is performed by your  
transmission and it captures brake energy and stores it in your high  
voltage battery.  
Driving to optimize fuel economy  
Your fuel economy should improve throughout your hybrid’s break-in  
period. As with any vehicle, fuel economy can be significantly impacted  
by your driving habits and accessory usage. For best results, keep in  
mind these tips:  
Tire Inflation: Keep tires properly inflated and only use recommended  
size.  
Drive Habits: Aggressive driving increases the amount of energy  
required to move your vehicle. In general, better fuel economy is  
8
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
achieved with mild to moderate acceleration and deceleration. Moderate  
braking is particularly important since it allows you to maximize the  
energy captured by the regenerative braking system.  
NOTE: Having your engine running is not always an indication of  
inefficiency – in some cases it is actually more efficient than driving in  
electric mode.  
Additional Tips:  
Do not carry extra loads  
Be mindful of adding external accessories that may increase  
aerodynamic drag  
Observe posted speed limits  
Perform all scheduled maintenance  
There is no need to wait for your engine to “warm up”. The vehicle is  
ready to drive immediately after starting  
Refer to Essentials of good fuel economy in the Maintenance and  
Specifications chapter for more fuel saving tips.  
Frequently asked questions  
Question  
Answer  
What are the series of  
clicks from the cargo area  
The high voltage battery is electrically  
isolated from the rest of the vehicle when  
when I first turn the key in the key is off. When the key is turned to  
the ignition?  
on, high voltage contactors inside the  
battery are closed to make the electricity  
available to the motor/generator and  
enable the vehicle to drive. The clicks are  
the sound of these contactors as they  
close and open during start up and shut  
down.  
Why does the engine  
The vehicle’s computer will determine if  
sometimes start at key-on? an engine start is necessary for cabin  
heating or windshield defrost. The engine  
will also be started when ambient  
temperatures are low.  
9
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
Question  
Answer  
After I start my car in the  
There are several reasons the engine  
morning, why does it take a stays on for an extended amount of time  
long time before the engine when it is first started. One common  
shuts down?  
reason is to ensure that the emissions  
components are warm enough to  
minimize tailpipe emissions. As the  
climate gets cooler, this “engine-ON” time  
is extended.  
Why does my engine never The engine is required to turn on above  
shut down above 40 mph  
(65 km/h)?  
this speed to protect the transaxle  
hardware.  
Why does my engine stay  
ON when it’s extremely  
cold outside?  
In order to ensure that the climate  
control system can begin heating the  
cabin and/or defrosting the windshield as  
soon as a driver requests it, the engine  
coolant temperature has to be kept  
sufficiently hot. Keeping the engine on is  
required to maintain the correct minimum  
temperature.  
Why does my engine rev up Your vehicle’s engine and transmission are  
so high sometimes when I  
accelerate?  
designed to deliver the power you need  
at the most efficient engine speed. This  
may be higher than expected during  
heavy accelerations, and may fluctuate  
during steady state driving. These are  
characteristics of the Atkinson engine  
cycle and the eCVT transaxle technology  
that help maximize your hybrid’s fuel  
economy.  
What does it mean when  
my power assist gauge  
Electricity is coming out of the battery  
when the gauge moves to the right.  
moves to the right? To the Electricity is going into the battery when  
left? the gauge moves to the left.  
10  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
Question  
Answer  
What is the fan noise I hear The fan noise comes from two fans  
from the rear of my hybrid? located inside the high voltage battery.  
These fans turn on when the battery  
requires cooling air. The fan speed, and  
associated noise level, will change  
according to both the amount of cooling  
required and the speed of the vehicle to  
maintain good performance.  
How far can I go in Electric Running out of gas is not recommended.  
Drive if I run out of gas?  
However, you may be able to go about  
one mile, driving at 30 mph (48 km/h), if  
the battery has a normal state of charge.  
The engine oil should be changed every  
10,000 miles (16,000 km) under normal  
operating conditions. See the Scheduled  
Maintenance Guide chapter.  
What is the engine oil  
change service interval?  
Can I put E10 or E85 in my Your hybrid vehicle can use E10 (10%  
vehicle, and how will it  
affect my fuel economy?  
ethanol, 90% gasoline) fuel, but you may  
notice slightly reduced fuel economy  
because ethanol contains less energy per  
gallon than gasoline. Your hybrid vehicle  
is not designed to use E85 (85% ethanol).  
The high voltage battery system is  
How long will my high  
voltage battery last? Does it designed to last the life of the vehicle and  
need maintenance? requires no maintenance.  
Can you charge the battery There are no provisions for charging the  
with a plug into an A/C  
outlet?  
high voltage battery from a power supply  
external to the vehicle.  
Can I tow the hybrid  
behind my motor home  
Yes. Your hybrid vehicle can be  
“flat-towed” without modification. See the  
with all four wheels down? Recreational towing section in the Tires,  
Wheels and Loading chapter for more  
information.  
11  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
SPECIAL NOTICES  
New Vehicle Limited Warranty  
For a detailed description of what is covered and what is not covered by  
your vehicle’s New Vehicle Limited Warranty, refer to the Warranty  
Guide that is provided to you along with your Owner’s Guide.  
Special instructions  
For your added safety, your vehicle is fitted with sophisticated electronic  
controls.  
WARNING: Please read the section Airbag Supplemental  
Restraint System (SRS) in the Seating and Safety Restraints  
chapter. Failure to follow the specific warnings and instructions could  
result in personal injury.  
WARNING: Front seat mounted rear-facing child or infant seats  
should NEVER be placed in front of an active passenger airbag.  
Notice to owners of pickup trucks and utility type vehicles  
WARNING: Utility vehicles have a significantly higher rollover  
rate than other types of vehicles.  
Before you drive your vehicle, please read this Owner’s Guide carefully.  
Your vehicle is not a passenger car. As with other vehicles of this type,  
failure to operate this vehicle correctly may result in loss of vehicle  
control, vehicle rollover, personal injury or death.  
Using your vehicle with a snowplow  
Do not use this vehicle for snowplowing.  
Your vehicle is not equipped with a snowplowing package.  
Using your vehicle as an ambulance  
Do not use this vehicle as an ambulance.  
Your vehicle is not equipped with the Ford Ambulance Preparation  
Package.  
12  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Introduction  
DATA RECORDING  
Service Data Recording  
Service data recorders in your vehicle are capable of collecting and  
storing diagnostic information about your vehicle. This potentially  
includes information about the performance or status of various systems  
and modules in the vehicle, such as engine, throttle, steering or brake  
systems. In order to properly diagnose and service your vehicle, Ford  
Motor Company, Ford of Canada, and service and repair facilities may  
access or share among them vehicle diagnostic information received  
through a direct connection to your vehicle when diagnosing or servicing  
your vehicle. For U.S. only (if equipped), if you choose to use the SYNC௡  
Vehicle Health Report, you consent that certain diagnostic information  
may also be accessed electronically by Ford Motor Company and Ford  
authorized service facilities, and that the diagnostic information may be  
used for any purpose. See your SYNCsupplement for more information.  
Event Data Recording  
This vehicle is equipped with an event data recorder (EDR). The  
main purpose of an EDR is to record, in certain crash or near  
crash-like situations, such as an airbag deployment or hitting a  
road obstacle; this data will assist in understanding how a  
vehicle’s systems performed. The EDR is designed to record data  
related to vehicle dynamics and safety systems for a short period  
of time, typically 30 seconds or less. The EDR in this vehicle is  
designed to record such data as:  
How various systems in your vehicle were operating;  
Whether or not the driver and passenger seatbelts were  
buckled/fastened;  
How far (if at all) the driver was depressing the accelerator  
and/or the brake pedal; and  
How fast the vehicle was travelling; and  
Where the driver was positioning the steering wheel.  
This data can help provide a better understanding of the  
circumstances in which crashes and injuries occur.  
Note: EDR data is recorded by your vehicle only if a non-trivial  
crash situation occurs; no data is recorded by the EDR under  
normal driving conditions and no personal data or information  
(e.g., name, gender, age, and crash location) is recorded (see  
13  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Introduction  
limitations regarding 911 Assist and Traffic, directions and  
Information privacy below). However, parties, such as law  
enforcement, could combine the EDR data with the type of  
personally identifying data routinely acquired during a crash  
investigation.  
To read data recorded by an EDR, special equipment is required,  
and access to the vehicle or the EDR is needed. In addition to the  
vehicle manufacturer, other parties, such as law enforcement,  
that have such special equipment, can read the information if  
they have access to the vehicle or the EDR. Ford Motor Company  
and Ford of Canada do not access event data recorder  
information without obtaining consent, unless pursuant to court  
order or where required by law enforcement, other government  
authorities or other third parties acting with lawful authority.  
Other parties may seek to access the information independently  
of Ford Motor Company and Ford of Canada.  
Note: Including to the extent that any law pertaining to Event  
Data Recorders applies to SYNCor its features, please note the  
following: Once 911 Assist (if equipped) is enabled (set ON), 911  
Assist may, through any paired and connected cell phone, disclose  
to emergency services that the vehicle has been in a crash  
involving the deployment of an airbag or, in certain vehicles, the  
activation of the fuel pump shut-off. Certain versions or updates  
to 911 Assist may also be capable of being used to electronically  
or verbally provide to 911 operators the vehicle location (such as  
latitude and longitude), and/or other details about the vehicle or  
crash or personal information about the occupants to assist 911  
operators to provide the most appropriate emergency services. If  
you do not want to disclose this information, do not activate the  
911 Assist feature. See your SYNCsupplement for more  
information.  
Additionally, when you connect to Traffic, Directions and  
Information (if equipped, U.S. only) the service uses GPS  
technology and advanced vehicle sensors to collect the vehicle’s  
current location, travel direction, and speed (“vehicle travel  
information”) only to help provide you with the directions, traffic  
reports, or business searches your request. If you do not want  
Ford or its vendors to receive this information, do not activate  
the service. Ford Motor Company and the vendors it uses to  
provide you with this information do not store your vehicle travel  
information. For more information, see Traffic, Directions and  
Information, Terms and Conditions. See your SYNCsupplement  
for more information.  
14  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
CELL PHONE USE  
The use of Mobile Communications Equipment has become increasingly  
important in the conduct of business and personal affairs. However,  
drivers must not compromise their own or others’ safety when using  
such equipment. Mobile Communications can enhance personal safety  
and security when appropriately used, particularly in emergency  
situations. Safety must be paramount when using mobile communications  
equipment to avoid negating these benefits.  
Mobile Communication Equipment includes, but is not limited to, cellular  
phones, pagers, portable email devices, text messaging devices and  
portable two-way radios.  
WARNING: Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle  
control, accident and injury. Ford strongly recommends that you  
use extreme caution when using any device or feature that may take  
your focus off the road. Your primary responsibility is the safe  
operation of your vehicle.  
We recommend against the use of any handheld device while driving  
and that you comply with all applicable laws.  
EXPORT UNIQUE (NON–UNITED STATES/CANADA) VEHICLE  
SPECIFIC INFORMATION  
For your particular global region, your vehicle may be equipped with  
features and options that are different from the features and options that  
are described in this Owner’s Guide. A market unique supplement may  
be supplied that complements this book. By referring to the market  
unique supplement, if provided, you can properly identify those features,  
recommendations and specifications that are unique to your vehicle. This  
Owner’s Guide is written primarily for the U.S. and Canadian Markets.  
Features or equipment listed as standard may be different on units built  
for Export. Refer to this Owner’s Guide for all other required  
information and warnings.  
15  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Introduction  
These are some of the symbols you may see on your vehicle.  
Vehicle Symbol Glossary  
Safety Alert  
See Owner’s Guide  
Airbag - Front  
Fasten Safety Belt  
Airbag - Side  
Child Seat Lower  
Anchor  
Child Seat Tether  
Anchor  
Brake System  
Anti-Lock Brake System  
Parking Brake System  
Brake Fluid -  
Non-Petroleum Based  
Parking Aid System  
Speed Control  
Stability Control System  
Master Lighting Switch  
Fog Lamps-Front  
Hazard Warning Flasher  
Fuse Compartment  
Windshield Wash/Wipe  
Fuel Pump Reset  
Windshield  
Rear Window  
Defrost/Demist  
Defrost/Demist  
16  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
Vehicle Symbol Glossary  
Power Window Lockout  
Interior Luggage  
Power Windows  
Front/Rear  
Child Safety Door  
Lock/Unlock  
Compartment Release  
Panic Alarm  
Engine Oil  
Engine Coolant  
Temperature  
Engine Coolant  
Do Not Open When Hot  
Battery  
Avoid Smoking, Flames,  
or Sparks  
Battery Acid  
Fan Warning  
Explosive Gas  
MAX  
MIN  
Maintain Correct Fluid  
Level  
Power Steering Fluid  
Service Engine Soon  
Engine Air Filter  
Jack  
Passenger Compartment  
Air Filter  
Low Tire Pressure  
Warning  
Check Fuel Cap  
17  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
WARNING LIGHTS AND CHIMES  
Shown in standard measure. Metric similar.  
Warning lights and gauges can alert you to a vehicle condition that may  
become serious enough to cause extensive repairs. A warning light may  
illuminate when a problem exists with one of your vehicle’s functions.  
Many lights will illuminate when you start your vehicle to make sure the  
bulbs work. If any light remains on after starting the vehicle, refer to the  
respective system warning light for additional information.  
Service engine soon: The service  
engine soon indicator light  
illuminates when the ignition is first  
turned to the on position to check  
the bulb and to indicate whether the vehicle is ready for  
Inspection/Maintenance (I/M) testing. Normally, the service engine soon  
light will stay on until the engine is cranked, then turn itself off if no  
malfunctions are present. However, if after 15 seconds the service engine  
soon light blinks eight times, it means that the vehicle is not ready for  
I/M testing. See the Readiness for Inspection/Maintenance (I/M)  
testing in the Maintenance and Specifications chapter.  
Solid illumination after the engine is started indicates the on-board  
diagnostics system (OBD-II) has detected a malfunction. Refer to  
On-board diagnostics (OBD-II) in the Maintenance and Specifications  
chapter. If the light is blinking, engine misfire is occurring which could  
damage your catalytic converter. Drive in a moderate fashion (avoid  
heavy acceleration and deceleration) and have your vehicle serviced  
immediately by your authorized dealer.  
18  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Cluster  
WARNING: Under engine misfire conditions, excessive exhaust  
temperatures could damage the catalytic converter, the fuel  
system, interior floor coverings or other vehicle components, possibly  
causing a fire.  
Brake system warning light: To  
confirm the brake system warning  
light is functional, it will  
momentarily illuminate when the  
ignition is turned to the on position  
!
P
BRAKE  
when the engine is not running, or in a position between on and start, or  
by applying the parking brake when the ignition is turned to the on  
position. If the brake system warning light does not illuminate at this  
time, seek service immediately from your authorized dealer. Illumination  
after releasing the parking brake indicates low brake fluid level or a  
brake system malfunction and the brake system should be inspected  
immediately by your authorized dealer.  
WARNING: Driving a vehicle with the brake system warning  
light on is dangerous. A significant decrease in braking  
performance may occur. It will take you longer to stop the vehicle.  
Have the vehicle checked by your authorized dealer. Driving extended  
distances with the parking brake engaged can cause brake failure and  
the risk of personal injury.  
Anti-lock brake system: If the  
ABS light stays illuminated or  
ABS  
continues to flash, a malfunction has  
been detected, have the system  
serviced immediately by your  
authorized dealer. Normal braking is still functional unless the brake  
warning light also is illuminated.  
Airbag readiness: If this light fails  
to illuminate when the ignition is  
turned to the on position, continues  
to flash or remains on, have the  
system serviced immediately by your authorized dealer. A chime will  
sound when there is a malfunction in the indicator light.  
19  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
Safety belt: Reminds you to fasten  
your safety belt. A Belt-Minder௡  
chime will also sound to remind you  
to fasten your safety belt. Refer to  
the Seating and Safety Restraints  
chapter to activate/deactivate the Belt-Minderchime feature.  
Stop safely hazard warning:  
Indicates hybrid component  
fault/failure that will cause the  
vehicle to shutdown, fail to start or  
enter into a limited operating mode. A message may also display in the  
message center.  
Note: If the vehicle is still running, the vehicle may soon  
shutdown without further warning and should be stopped safely.  
If this lamp is lit, stop the vehicle, shift to P (Park), turn the key to the  
off position, and attempt to restart the vehicle. If the fault remains, the  
vehicle may require refueling, jump starting or service. For information  
regarding the low-voltage (12–volt) battery only, please refer to Jump  
starting (low voltage [underhood] battery only) in the Roadside  
Emergencies chapter.  
Ready indicator light: Illuminates  
once the vehicle has successfully  
started. Indicates the vehicle is  
ready to drive even when you don’t  
hear the engine running.  
Charging system: Illuminates when  
the 12–volt battery is not charging  
properly. If it stays on while the  
engine is running, there may be a  
malfunction with the charging system. Contact your authorized dealer as  
soon as possible. This indicates a problem with the electrical system or a  
related component.  
Engine oil pressure: Illuminates  
when the oil pressure falls below the  
normal range. Check the oil level  
and add oil if needed. If the warning  
light stays on, even though the oil level is correct, do not start the  
engine and contact your authorized dealer as soon as possible. This  
indicates a problem with the engine or a related component. Refer to  
Engine oil in the Maintenance and Specifications chapter.  
20  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
High engine or high motor  
electronic coolant temperature:  
Illuminates when the engine coolant  
or motor electronics coolant temperature is high. The message center  
displays HIGH ENGINE TEMPERATURE / HIGH MOTOR  
TEMPERATURE when the engine coolant or motor electronics are  
overheating. Stop the vehicle as soon as safely possible, turn off the  
engine, and let it cool. Check the coolant and coolant level. If the light  
and message stays on or continues to turn on after the vehicle warms  
up, contact your authorized dealer as soon as possible. Continuing to  
drive with an overheated engine can cause serious engine damage. This  
indicates a problem with the engine or a related component. Refer to  
Engine coolant and motor/electronics coolant in the Maintenance  
and Specifications chapter.  
WARNING: Never remove the coolant reservoir cap while the  
engine is running or hot.  
AdvanceTrac: Flashes  
momentarily when the  
AdvanceTrac/traction control is  
active. If the light remains on, have  
the system serviced immediately, refer to the Driving chapter for more  
information.  
AdvanceTracoff: Illuminates solid  
when the traction control has been  
disabled by the driver. Flashes for  
3 seconds and turns solid when  
OFF  
trailer sway is disabled by driver.  
Refer to the Driving chapter for more information.  
Low tire pressure warning:  
Illuminates when your tire pressure  
is low. If the light remains on at  
start up or while driving, the tire  
pressure should be checked. Refer  
to Inflating your tires in the Tires, Wheels and Loading chapter. When  
the ignition is first turned to on, the light will illuminate for three  
seconds to ensure the bulb is working. If the light does not turn on or  
begins to flash, have the system inspected by your authorized dealer. For  
more information on this system, refer to Tire pressure monitoring  
system (TPMS) in the Tires, Wheels and Loading chapter.  
21  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
Low fuel: Illuminates when the fuel  
level in the fuel tank is at or near  
empty (refer to Fuel gauge in this  
chapter).  
Speed control: Illuminates when  
the speed control is engaged. Turns  
off when the speed control system  
is disengaged.  
Anti-theft system: Flashes when  
the SecuriLockpassive anti-theft  
system has been activated.  
Throttle control/Powertrain:  
Illuminates when a powertrain fault  
has been detected. Contact your  
authorized dealer as soon as  
possible.  
Door ajar: Illuminates when the  
ignition is in the on position and any  
door is open.  
Turn signal: Illuminates when the  
left or right turn signal or the  
hazard lights are turned on. If the  
indicators flash faster, check for a burned out bulb.  
High beams: Illuminates when the  
high beam headlamps are turned on.  
Key-in-ignition warning chime: Sounds when the key is left in the  
ignition in the off or accessory position and the driver’s door is opened.  
Headlamps on warning chime: Sounds when the headlamps or parking  
lamps are on, the ignition is off (the key is not in the ignition) and the  
driver’s door is opened.  
Parking brake on chime: Sounds when the parking brake is left on and  
the vehicle is driven. If the warning stays on after the park brake is off,  
contact your authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
22  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
HEV engine off reminder chime: Sounds for 10 seconds when the  
PRNDL is in the P (Park) position and the Driver’s door is ajar (open)  
while ignition is on. Always turn your ignition key to off and remove key  
before leaving your vehicle. (The engine may be off when the vehicle is  
stopped, yet the key is on, and the engine can turn on at any time)  
Message center activation chime: Sounds when a warning message  
(except PARK BRAKE ENGAGED while parked) appears in the message  
center display for the first time.  
GAUGES  
Shown in standard measure. Metric similar.  
Speedometer: Indicates the  
current vehicle speed.  
23  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Cluster  
Battery gauge: Provides  
information about the vehicle’s  
energy usage.  
ASSIST — Battery provides extra  
power to boost the vehicle’s  
acceleration.  
CHARGE — Storing extra energy in the battery when coasting or  
slowing down.  
Odometer: Registers the total miles  
(kilometers) of the vehicle.  
Refer to Message center in this  
chapter on how to switch the  
display from Metric to English.  
Trip odometer: See TRIP A/B  
under Message center in this  
chapter.  
Tachometer: Indicates the engine  
speed in revolutions per minute.  
Driving with your tachometer  
pointer continuously at the top of  
the scale may damage the engine.  
The pointer will indicate engine  
RPMs when the engine is running  
and point at the EV symbol when  
the engine is off and the vehicle is  
running on pure electrical power.  
Fuel gauge: Indicates  
approximately how much fuel is left  
in the fuel tank (when the ignition  
is in the on position). The fuel  
gauge may vary slightly when the  
vehicle is in motion or on a grade.  
Refer to Filling the tank in the  
Maintenance and Specifications  
chapter for more information.  
24  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
MESSAGE CENTER  
Your vehicle’s message center is capable of monitoring many vehicle  
systems and will alert you to potential vehicle problems and various  
conditions with an informational message followed by a long indicator  
chime.  
The message center display is located in the instrument cluster.  
Info  
Press the INFO button repeatedly to  
cycle through the following features:  
TRIP A/B  
Registers the distance of individual trips. Press and release INFO button  
until the A or B trip appears in the display (this represents the trip  
mode). Press and hold the RESET button for two seconds to reset.  
Refer to UNITS later in this section to switch the display from Metric to  
English.  
MYKEY MILES (km) (If programmed)  
For more information, refer to MyKey™ in the Locks and Security  
chapter.  
MILES (km) TO E  
This displays an estimate of approximately how far you can drive with  
the fuel remaining in your tank under normal driving conditions.  
Remember to turn the ignition off when refueling to allow this feature to  
correctly detect the added fuel.  
LOW FUEL LEVEL will display when you have approximately 50 miles  
(80 km), to empty. Press RESET to clear this warning message. It will  
return at approximately 25 miles (40 km), 10 miles (16 km) and 0 miles  
(0 km) miles to empty.  
Distance to empty is calculated using a running average fuel economy,  
which is based on your recent driving history of 500 miles (800 km).  
This value is not the same as the average fuel economy display. The  
running average fuel economy is re-initialized to a factory default value if  
the battery is disconnected.  
25  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Cluster  
AVG MPG (L/100km)  
Average fuel economy displays your average fuel economy in miles/gallon  
or liters/100 km.  
If you calculate your average fuel economy by dividing distance traveled  
by gallons of fuel used (liters of fuel used by 100 kilometers traveled),  
your figure may be different than displayed for the following reasons:  
Your vehicle was not perfectly level during fill-up  
Differences in the automatic shut-off points on the fuel pumps at  
service stations  
Variations in top-off procedure from one fill-up to another  
Rounding of the displayed values to the nearest 0.1 gallon (liter)  
1. Drive the vehicle at least 5 miles (8 km) with the speed control  
system engaged to display a stabilized average.  
2. Record the highway fuel economy for future reference.  
It is important to press the RESET button (press and hold RESET for  
two seconds in order to reset the function) after setting the speed  
control to get accurate highway fuel economy readings.  
For more information refer to Essentials of good fuel economy in the  
Maintenance and Specifications chapter.  
MPG (L/km)  
This displays instantaneous fuel economy as a bar graph ranging from ↓  
poor economy to excellent economy.  
Your vehicle must be moving to calculate instantaneous fuel economy.  
When your vehicle is not moving, this function shows , one or no bars  
illuminated. Instantaneous fuel economy cannot be reset.  
ELECT ENERGY  
Displays the state of charge of the high voltage battery. For normal  
operation ELECT ENERGY OK will be displayed.  
Blank Screen  
The message center display will be blank after cycling through all of the  
Info menu items.  
26  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
System check and vehicle feature customization  
Press the SETUP button repeatedly  
to cycle the message center through  
the following features:  
PRESS RESET FOR ENGLISH  
When entering the setup menu and a non-English language has been  
selected, this message will be displayed to change back to English.  
Press the RESET button to change back to English.  
RESET FOR SYSTEM CHECK  
When this message appears, press the RESET button and the message  
center will begin to cycle through the following systems and provide a  
status of the item if needed.  
1. OIL LIFE  
2. ELEC DRIVE  
3. BRAKE SYSTEM  
4. LIFTGATE AND GLASS  
5. DTE/FUEL LEVEL  
6. MYKEY DISTANCE (if a MyKey™ is programmed)  
7. MYKEY(S) PROGRAMMED  
8. ADMIN KEYS PROGRAMMED  
9. PARK AID (if equipped)  
Note: Some systems show a message only if a condition is present.  
OIL LIFE  
This displays the remaining oil life.  
An oil change is required whenever indicated by the message center and  
according to the recommended maintenance schedule. USE ONLY  
RECOMMENDED ENGINE OILS.  
To reset the oil monitoring system to 100% after each oil change,  
perform the following:  
1. Press and release the SETUP button to display “OIL LIFE XXX%  
HOLD RESET = NEW”.  
2. Press and hold the RESET button for two seconds and release to reset  
the oil life to 100%.  
27  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Cluster  
Note: To change oil life 100% value to another value, proceed to Step 3.  
3. Once “OIL LIFE SET TO XXX%” is displayed, release and press the  
RESET button to change the Oil Life Start Value. Each release and press  
will reduce the value by 10%.  
UNITS  
Displays the current units English or Metric.  
Press the RESET button to change from English to Metric.  
AUTOLAMP (if equipped)  
This feature keeps your headlights on for up to three minutes after the  
ignition is switched off.  
Press the RESET control to select the new Autolamp delay values of 0,  
10, 20, 30, 60, 90, 120 or 180 seconds.  
AUTOLOCK  
This feature automatically locks all vehicle doors when the vehicle is  
shifted into any gear, putting the vehicle in motion.  
Press RESET to turn autolock on or off.  
AUTOUNLOCK  
This feature automatically unlocks all vehicle doors when the driver’s  
door is opened within 10 minutes of the ignition being turned off.  
Press RESET to turn autounlock on or off.  
PARK AID (if equipped)  
This feature sounds a warning tone to warn the driver of obstacles near  
the rear bumper, and functions only when R (Reverse) gear is selected.  
Press RESET to turn it off or on.  
CREATE MYKEY / MYKEY SETUP / CLEAR MYKEY  
For more information refer to MyKey™ in the Locks and Security  
chapter.  
ZONE [XX] RESET = CHANGE  
For more information on the compass and compass set up, refer to  
Electronic compass in the Driver Controls chapter.  
RESET FOR CALIBRATION  
For more information on the compass and compass set up, refer to  
Electronic compass in the Driver Controls chapter.  
28  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
LANGUAGE = ENGLISH / SPANISH / FRENCH  
Allows you to choose which language the message center will display in.  
Selectable languages are English, Spanish, or French.  
Waiting four seconds or pressing the RESET button cycles the message  
center through each of the language choices.  
Press and hold the RESET button for two seconds to set the language  
choice.  
System warnings/information  
System warnings alert you to possible problems or malfunctions in your  
vehicle’s operating systems.  
In the event of a multiple warning situation, the message center will  
cycle the display to show all warnings by displaying each one for four  
seconds.  
The message center will display the last selected feature if there are no  
more warning messages.  
Types of messages and warnings:  
Some messages will appear briefly to inform you of something you  
may need to take action on or be informed of.  
Some messages will appear once and then again when the vehicle is  
restarted.  
Some messages will reappear after clearing or being reset if a problem  
or condition is still present and needs your attention.  
Some messages can be acknowledged and reset by pressing RESET.  
This allows you to use the full message center functionality by clearing  
the message.  
DRIVER DOOR AJAR — Displayed when the driver’s door is not  
completely closed.  
PASSENGER DOOR AJAR — Displayed when the passenger side door  
is not completely closed.  
REAR LEFT DOOR AJAR — Displayed when the rear left door is not  
completely closed.  
REAR RIGHT DOOR AJAR — Displayed when the rear right door is  
not completely closed.  
STOP SAFELY NOW — Displayed when the stop safety hazard warning  
lamp is illuminated. This indicates a hybrid component fault/failure that  
will cause the vehicle to shut down, fail to start or enter into limited  
operating mode.  
29  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Cluster  
Note: If the vehicle is still running, it may soon shut down without  
further warning and should be stopped safely. Contact your authorized  
dealer as soon as possible.  
HIGH ENGINE TEMPERATURE — Displayed when the engine  
coolant is overheating. Engine coolant temperature warning lamp will  
illuminate indicating coolant temperature is high. Stop the vehicle as  
soon as safely possible, turn off the engine and let it cool. Check the  
coolant level. Refer to Engine coolant in the Maintenance and  
Specifications chapter. If the warning stays on or continues to come on,  
contact your authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
WARNING: When the engine and radiator are hot, scalding  
coolant and steam may shoot out under pressure and cause  
serious injury. Do not remove the cooling system cap when the engine  
and radiator are hot.  
HIGH MOTOR TEMPERATURE — Displayed when the motor  
electronics are overheating. Stop the vehicle as soon as safely possible,  
turn off the engine and let it cool. Refer to Engine coolant and  
motor/electronics coolant in the Maintenance and Specifications  
chapter. If the warning stays on or continues to come on, contact your  
authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
READY TO DRIVE — Momentarily displayed once the vehicle has  
successfully started. Indicates the vehicle is ready to drive even when  
you don’t hear the gasoline engine running.  
PARK BRAKE ENGAGED — Displayed when the manual park brake is  
set, the engine is running and the vehicle is driven more than 3 mph  
(5 km/h). If the warning stays on after the park brake is released,  
contact your authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
XXX MILES TO E FUEL LEVEL LOW — Displayed as an early  
reminder of a low fuel condition.  
LIFTGATE / GLASS AJAR — Displayed when the liftgate or liftgate  
glass is not completely closed. Press RESET to reset display.  
CHECK BRAKE SYSTEM — Displayed when the braking system is not  
operating properly. If the warning stays on or continues to come on,  
contact your authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
CHECK FUEL FILL INLET — Displayed when the fuel fill inlet may  
not be properly closed. Refer to Easy Fuel™ “no cap” fuel system in  
the Maintenance and Specifications chapter.  
30  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
BRAKE FLUID LEVEL LOW — Indicates the brake fluid level is low  
and the brake system should be inspected immediately. Refer to Brake  
fluid in the Maintenance and Specifications chapter.  
LOW TIRE PRESSURE — Displayed when one or more tires on your  
vehicle have low tire pressure. Refer to Inflating your tires in the Tires,  
Wheels and Loading chapter.  
TIRE PRESSURE MONITOR FAULT — Displayed when the Tire  
Pressure Monitoring System is malfunctioning. If the warning stays on or  
continues to come on, have the system inspected by your authorized  
dealer.  
TIRE PRESSURE SENSOR FAULT — Displayed when a tire pressure  
sensor is malfunctioning, or your spare tire is in use. For more  
information on how the system operates under these conditions, refer to  
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) in the Tires, Wheels and  
Loading chapter. If the warning stays on or continues to come on, have  
the system inspected by your authorized dealer  
ENGINE OIL CHANGE SOON — Displayed when the engine oil life  
remaining is 10% or less.  
OIL CHANGE REQUIRED — Displayed when the oil life left reaches  
0%.  
MYKEY ACTIVE DRIVE SAFELY — Displayed at startup when  
MyKey™ is in use. Refer to MyKey™ in the Locks and Security chapter  
for more information.  
KEY COULD NOT PROGRAM — Displayed when an attempt is made  
to program a spare key using two existing MyKeys. Refer to MyKey™ in  
the Locks and Security chapter for more information.  
VEHICLE SPEED 80 MPH MAX — Displayed when a MyKey™ is in  
use and the Admin has enabled the MyKey speed limit and the vehicle  
speed is 80 mph (130 km/h). Refer to MyKey™ in the Locks and  
Security chapter for more information.  
SPEED LIMITED TO 80 MPH — Displayed when starting the vehicle  
and MyKey™ is in use and the MyKey speed limit is on. Refer to  
MyKey™ in the Locks and Security chapter for more information.  
CHECK SPEED DRIVE SAFELY — Displayed when a MyKey™ is in  
use and the optional setting is on and the vehicle exceeds a preselected  
speed. Refer to MyKey™ in the Locks and Security chapter for more  
information.  
31  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
VEHICLE NEAR TOP SPEED — Displayed when a MyKey™ is in use  
and the MyKey speed limit is on and the vehicle speed is approaching  
80 mph (130 km/h). Refer to MyKey™ in the Locks and Security  
chapter for more information.  
TOP SPEED MYKEY SETTING — Displayed when a MyKey™ is in  
use and the MyKey speed limit is on and the vehicle speed is 80 mph  
(130 km/h). Refer to MyKey™ in the Locks and Security chapter for  
more information.  
BUCKLE UP TO UNMUTE AUDIO — Displayed when a MyKey™ is in  
use and Belt-Minderis activated. Refer to MyKey™ in the Locks and  
Security chapter for more information.  
ADVTRAC ON MYKEY SETTING — Displayed when a MyKey™ is in  
use when trying to disable the AdvanceTracsystem and the optional  
setting is on. Refer to MyKey™ in the Locks and Security chapter for  
more information.  
ACTIVE PARK FAULT (if equipped) — Displayed when a fault has  
occurred with the active park assist system. Refer to Active park assist  
in the Driving chapter for more information.  
ACTIVE PARK CANCELLED (if equipped) — Displayed when the  
active park assist feature has been canceled when it is in use. Refer to  
Active park assist in the Driving chapter for more information.  
CANCELLED BY OVER SPEED (if equipped)— Displayed when the  
active park assist feature self cancels due to vehicle speed over the  
preset limit allowed by the active park assist system. Refer to Active  
park assist in the Driving chapter for more information.  
CANCELLED BY DRIVER INPUT (if equipped) — Displayed when  
the autopark feature has been canceled due to driver inputs. Refer to  
Active Park in the Driving chapter for more information.  
CANCELLED BY ADV TRAC EVENT (if equipped) — Displayed  
when the active park feature has been canceled due to the AdvanceTrac  
system activating. Refer to Active park assist in the Driving chapter for  
more information.  
CANCELLED BY ABS EVENT (if equipped) — Displayed when the  
active park feature has been canceled due to the ABS system activating.  
Refer to Active park assist in the Driving chapter for more information.  
ACTIVE PARK REDUCE SPEED (if equipped) — May display when  
using the active park assist system. See Active park assist in the  
Driving chapter for more information.  
ACTIVE PARK SEARCHING (if equipped) — May display when  
using the active park assist system. See Active park assist in the  
Driving chapter for more information.  
32  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
SPACE FOUND PULL FORWARD (if equipped) — May display when  
using the active park assist system. See Active park assist in the  
Driving chapter for more information.  
SPACE FOUND STOP (if equipped) — May display when using the  
active park assist system. See Active park assist in the Driving chapter  
for more information.  
PULL FORWARD USE CAUTION (if equipped) — May display when  
using the active park assist system. See Active park assist in the  
Driving chapter for more information.  
BACK UP SLOWLY USE CAUTION (if equipped) — May display  
when using the active park assist system. See Active park assist in the  
Driving chapter for more information.  
BACK UP USE CAUTION (if equipped) — May display when using  
the active park assist system. See Active park assist in the Driving  
chapter for more information.  
ACTIVE PARK FINISHED (if equipped) — May display when using  
the active park assist system. See Active park assist in the Driving  
chapter for more information.  
REMOVE HANDS PUT IN REVERSE (if equipped) — May display  
when using the active park assist system. See Active park assist in the  
Driving chapter for more information.  
ACTIVE PARK NOT AVAILABLE (if equipped) — May display when  
using the active park assist system. See Active park assist in the  
Driving chapter for more information.  
ACTIVE PARK DEACTIVATED (if equipped) — Displayed when the  
active park feature has been turned off. Refer to Active park assist in  
the Driving chapter for more information.  
33  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
AUDIO SYSTEMS  
AM/FM/single CD/MP3 satellite compatible sound system  
WARNING: Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle  
control, accident and injury. Ford strongly recommends that  
drivers use extreme caution when using any device or feature that may  
take their focus off the road. Your primary responsibility is the safe  
operation of the vehicle. We recommend against the use of any  
handheld device while driving and that you comply with all applicable  
laws.  
Accessory delay: Your vehicle is equipped with accessory delay. With  
this feature, the radio and other electrical accessories may be used for  
up to ten minutes after the ignition is turned off or until either front  
door is opened.  
Setting the clock  
To set the time, press CLOCK. The display will read SET TIME. Use the  
memory preset numbers (0–9) to enter in the desired time–hours and  
minutes and press OK. The clock will then begin from that time.  
34  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Entertainment Systems  
AM/FM Radio  
/ VOL (Power/Volume): Press  
to turn the radio on/off. Turn the  
knob to increase/decrease volume.  
If the volume is set above a certain  
level and the ignition is turned off,  
the volume will come back on at a  
nominal listening level when the  
ignition is turned back on.  
AM/FM: Press repeatedly to select AM/FM1/FM2 frequency band.  
TUNE: Turn the knob to go  
up/down the frequency band in  
individual increments.  
DIRECT: Press DIRECT and then select the desired radio frequency  
(i.e. 93.9) using the memory preset numbers (0–9).  
SEEK/TRACK: Press  
SEEK/TRACK  
to access the  
previous/next strong radio station.  
SCAN: Press for a brief sampling of all strong radio stations.  
MEMORY PRESETS (0–9): When  
tuned to any station, press and hold  
a preset button until sound returns  
and PRESET # SAVED appears in  
the display. You can save up to 30  
stations, 10 in AM, 10 in FM1 and  
FM2.  
Saving presets automatically (Autoset)– Autoset allows you to set the  
strongest local radio stations without losing your original manually set  
preset stations for AM/FM1/FM2.  
35  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
To activate the autoset feature: Press MENU repeatedly until AUTO  
PRESET ON/OFF appears in the display. Use  
SEEK/TRACK  
to  
turn AUTO PRESET to ON, and either wait five seconds for the search  
to initiate or press OK to immediately initiate the search. If you press  
another control within those five seconds, the search will not initiate; the  
10 strongest stations will be filled and the station stored in preset 1 will  
begin playing.  
If there are fewer than 10 strong stations, the system will store the last  
one in the remaining presets.  
RDS Radio  
Available only in FM mode. This feature allows you to search  
RDS-equipped stations for a certain category of music format: CLASSIC,  
COUNTRY, JAZZ/RB, ROCK, etc.  
To activate: Press MENU repeatedly until RDS (ON/OFF) appears in the  
display. Use  
SEEK/TRACK  
to turn RDS ON/OFF. When RDS is  
OFF, you will not be able to search for RDS equipped stations or view  
the station name or type.  
CAT/FOLD(Category/Folder): This feature allows you to select from  
various music categories.  
To change RDS categories: Press MENU repeatedly until RBDS ON/OFF  
appears in the display. Use  
PRESS UP OR DOWN TO CHANGE RDS CATEGORY will appear in the  
display. Press to scroll through all possible categories. When the  
desired category appears in the display, press SEEK/TRACK to  
/
to turn RDS to ON. Press CAT.  
/
find the next station playing that selection or press SCAN for a brief  
sampling of all stations playing that category of music.  
CD/MP3 Player  
CD: Press to enter CD/MP3 mode. If a disc is already loaded into the  
system, CD/MP3 play will begin where it ended last. If no CD is loaded,  
NO DISC will appear in the display.  
LOAD: This control is not operational. To load a CD, simply insert the  
disc, label side up, into the CD slot.  
EJECT: Press EJECT to eject the CD.  
36  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
/
Play/Pause: Press to  
play/pause a track when playing a  
CD.  
SEEK/TRACK: Press  
SEEK/TRACK  
to access the  
previous/next track.  
CAT (Category) / FOLD (Folder):  
In MP3 mode only– Press CAT/FOLD and then press  
SEEK/TRACK to access the previous/next folder.  
SCAN: Press for a brief sampling of all tracks on the current disc or  
MP3 folder.  
DIRECT:  
In CD mode– Press DIRECT. The display will read DIRECT TRACK  
MODE SELECT TRACK. Enter the desired track number using the  
memory preset buttons (0–9). The system will then begin playing that  
track.  
In MP3 folder mode– Press DIRECT and the memory preset buttons  
(0–9) of the desired folder. The system will advance to that specific  
folder.  
TEXT:  
In MP3 mode only– Press TEXT repeatedly to view Album (AL), Folder  
(FL), Song (SO) and Artist (AR) in the display, if available.  
In TEXT MODE– Sometimes the display requires additional text to be  
displayed. When the < / > indicator is active, press TEXT and then  
press  
COMPRESSION: Press MENU repeatedly until COMPRESSION ON/OFF  
appears in the display. Use SEEK/TRACK to switch between ON  
SEEK/TRACK  
to view the additional display text.  
and OFF. When COMPRESSION is ON, the system will bring the soft and  
loud CD passages together for a more consistent listening level.  
37  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
SHUFFLE: Press SHUFFLE to turn on and off and begin/stop random  
play. The system will only shuffle the disc currently playing.  
Satellite Radio  
Satellite radio is available only with a valid SIRIUSradio  
subscription. Check with your authorized dealer for availability.  
SIRIUS: Press to access satellite radio mode, if equipped. Press  
repeatedly to cycle through SAT1, SAT2 and SAT3 modes.  
TUNE/OK: Turn the knob to go to  
the next / previous available  
SIRIUSsatellite station.  
DIRECT: Press DIRECT then enter the desired channel (i.e. 002) using  
the memory preset buttons (0–9). If you only enter one digit, press OK  
and the system will go to that satellite channel. If you enter three digits,  
the system will automatically go to that channel, if available. You may  
cancel your entry by pressing DIRECT. If an invalid station number is  
entered, INVALID CHANNEL will appear in the display and the system  
will continue playing the current station.  
SEEK/TRACK: Press  
SEEK/TRACK  
to seek to the  
previous/next channel. If a specific  
category is selected, (Jazz, Rock,  
News, etc.), press  
SEEK/TRACK  
previous/next channel in the selected category. Press and hold  
SEEK/TRACK to fast seek through the previous/next channels.  
to seek to the  
SCAN: Press SCAN for a brief sampling of all available SIRIUS satellite  
channels. If a specific category is selected, (Jazz, Rock, News, etc.) press  
SCAN for a brief sampling of all available SIRIUSsatellite channels  
within the selected category.  
38  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
MEMORY PRESETS (0–9): There  
are 30 available presets, 10 each for  
SAT1, SAT2 and SAT3. To save  
satellite channels in your memory  
presets, tune to the desired channel  
then press and hold a memory  
preset number (0–9) until sound  
returns.  
TEXT: Press and release to display the artist and song title. While in  
TEXT MODE, press again to scroll through the Artist (AR), Song (SO),  
Channel (CH) and Category (CA).  
In TEXT MODE: Sometimes the display requires additional text to be  
displayed. When the < / > indicator is active, press TEXT and then  
press  
SEEK/TRACK  
to view the additional display text.  
CAT (Category) / FOLD (Folder): Press to switch between turning  
the most recently selected satellite radio category on or off. The category  
icon (CAT) will illuminate in the display when a specific category is  
selected (the icon will not illuminate during CATEGORY ALL). If no  
category has ever been selected, NO CATEGORY SELECTED will display.  
Note: Separate categories can be set for SAT1, SAT2 or SAT3.  
Refer to Satellite radio menu for further information on selecting a  
satellite radio category.  
SATELLITE RADIO MENU: Press MENU when satellite radio mode is  
active to access. Press OK to enter into the satellite radio menu.  
Press  
/
to cycle through the following options:  
CATEGORY MENU- Press OK to enter category mode. Press  
/
to scroll through the list of available SIRIUSchannel Categories (Pop,  
Rock, News, etc.) Press OK when the desired category appears in the  
display. After a category is selected, press  
/
to search for that  
specific category of channels only (i.e. ROCK). You may also select  
CATEGORY ALL to seek all available SIRIUScategories and channels.  
Press OK to close and return to the main menu.  
SONG SEEK MENU- Press OK to enter song seek menu.  
Press  
/
to scroll through the following options:  
a. SAVE THIS SONG: Press OK to save the currently playing song’s  
title in the system’s memory. (If you try to save something other than  
a song, CANT SAVE will appear in the display.) When the chosen song  
is playing on any satellite radio channel, the system will alert you with  
39  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
an audible prompt. Press OK while SONG ALERT is in the display and  
the system will take you to the channel playing the desired song. You  
can save up to 20 song titles. If you attempt to save more than 20  
titles, the display will read REPLACE SONG? Press OK to access the  
saved titles and press  
/
to cycle through the saved titles. When  
the song title appears in the display that you would like to replace,  
press OK. SONG REPLACED will appear in the display.  
b. DELETE A SONG: Press OK to delete a song from the system’s  
memory. Press  
/
to cycle through the saved songs. When the  
song appears in the display that you would like to delete, press OK.  
The song will appear in the display for confirmation. Press OK again  
and the display will read SONG DELETED. If you do not want to  
delete the currently listed song, press  
RETURN or CANCEL.  
/
to select either  
Note: If there are no songs presently saved, the display will read NO  
SONGS.  
c. DELETE ALL SONGS: Press OK to delete all song’s from the  
system’s memory. The display will read ARE YOU SURE ? Press OK to  
confirm deletion of all saved songs and the display will read ALL  
DELETED.  
Note: If there are no songs presently saved, the display will read NO  
SONGS.  
d. DISABLE ALERTS/ENABLE ALERTS: Press OK to  
enable/disable the satellite alert status which alerts you when your  
selected songs are playing on a satellite radio channel. (The system  
default is disabled.) SONG ALERTS ENABLED/DISABLED will appear  
in the display. The menu listing will display the opposite state. For  
example, if you have chosen to enable the song alerts, the menu  
listing will read DISABLE as the alerts are currently on, so your other  
option is to turn them off.  
CHANNEL LOCKOUT MENU- Press OK to enter the Channel  
Lockout menu. Press the  
options:  
/
to scroll through the following  
a. LOCK/UNLOCK THIS CHANNEL: Press OK when  
LOCK/UNLOCK THIS CHANNEL is displayed and the display will read  
ENTER PIN. Enter your four-digit PIN number (initial PIN is 1234)  
and the system will lock/unlock the channel and CHANNEL LOCKED  
or UNLOCKED will be displayed.  
Note: you must be tuned to the specific channel you want to  
lock/unlock when using this feature.  
40  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
b. CHANGE PIN: Press OK when CHANGE PIN is displayed. The  
display will read ENTER OLD PIN. Enter your current (old) PIN  
number and when the system accepts your entry it will display  
ENTER NEW PIN. Enter your new four-digit PIN and the system will  
save the new PIN and PIN SAVED will display.  
c. UNLOCK ALL CHANNELS: Press OK when UNLOCK ALL  
CHANNELS is displayed and the display will read ENTER PIN. Enter  
your four-digit PIN and the system will unlock all channels and the  
display will read CHANNEL UNLOCKED.  
d. RESET PIN: Press OK when RESET PIN is displayed. The display  
will read ARE YOU SURE. Press OK again to automatically reset the  
PIN number to its initial password setting (1234). PIN RESET TO  
DEFAULT PIN will be displayed.  
e. RETURN: Press OK when RETURN is displayed and the system  
will exit back to the satellite radio menu.  
Sound Adjustments  
Press SOUND repeatedly to cycle through the following features:  
BASS: Press  
SEEK/TRACK  
SEEK/TRACK  
SEEK/TRACK  
to adjust the level of bass.  
to adjust the level of treble.  
to adjust the audio between  
TREBLE: Press  
BALANCE: Press  
the left (L) and right (R) speakers.  
FADE: Press SEEK/TRACK  
back (B) and front (F) speakers.  
to adjust the audio between the  
SPEED COMPENSATED VOLUME (if equipped): With this feature  
on, radio volume automatically gets louder with increasing vehicle speed  
to compensate for road and wind noise.  
The default setting is off.  
Use  
SEEK/TRACK  
to adjust between SPEED OFF and levels  
1–7: Increasing the level from 1 (lowest setting) to 7 (highest setting)  
allows the radio volume to automatically change slightly with vehicle  
speed to compensate for road and wind noise.  
Recommended level is 1–3; SPEED OFF turns the feature off and level 7  
is the maximum setting.  
ALL SEATS (Occupancy mode, if equipped): Press SOUND  
repeatedly to reach the Occupancy mode setting. Press  
SEEK/TRACK  
to select and optimize sound for ALL SEATS,  
DRIVERS SEAT or REAR SEATS.  
41  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Extra Features  
AUX: Press repeatedly to cycle through LINE IN (auxiliary audio mode),  
and SYNC(if equipped).  
For location and further information on auxiliary audio mode, refer to  
Auxiliary input jack later in this chapter.  
If your vehicle is equipped with SYNC, refer to the SYNCinformation  
included with your vehicle for further information.  
TUNE/OK: Your vehicle may be  
equipped with special phone and  
media features which will require  
you to confirm commands by  
pressing OK. Refer to the SYNC௡  
information included with your  
vehicle for further information.  
(Phone): If your vehicle is equipped with SYNC, press to access  
SYNC PHONE features. Refer to the SYNCinformation included with  
your vehicle for further information.  
If your vehicle is not equipped with SYNC, the display will read NO  
PHONE.  
Auxiliary input jack (Line in)  
WARNING: Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle  
control, accident and injury. Ford strongly recommends that  
drivers use extreme caution when using any device or feature that may  
take their focus off the road. Your primary responsibility is the safe  
operation of the vehicle. We recommend against the use of any  
handheld device while driving and that you comply with all applicable  
laws.  
42  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Entertainment Systems  
Your vehicle is equipped with an  
Auxiliary Input Jack (AIJ). The  
Auxiliary Input Jack provides a way  
to connect your portable music  
player to the in-vehicle audio  
system. This allows the audio from a  
portable music player to be played  
through the vehicle speakers with  
high fidelity. To achieve optimal  
performance, please observe the  
following instructions when  
attaching your portable music  
device to the audio system.  
If your vehicle is equipped with a  
navigation system, refer to  
Auxiliary input jack section in the  
Audio features chapter of your  
Navigation system supplement.  
Required equipment:  
1. Any portable music player designed to be used with headphones  
2. An audio extension cable with stereo male 1/8 in. (3.5 mm)  
connectors at each end  
To play your portable music player using the auxiliary input jack:  
1. Begin with the vehicle parked and the radio turned off.  
2. Ensure that the battery in your portable music player is new or fully  
charged and that the device is turned off.  
3. Attach one end of the audio extension cable to the headphone output  
of your player and the other end of the audio extension cable to the AIJ  
in your vehicle.  
4. Turn the radio on, using either a tuned FM station or a CD loaded into  
the system. Adjust the volume to a comfortable listening level.  
5. Turn the portable music player on and adjust the volume to 1/2 the  
volume.  
6. Press AUX on the vehicle radio repeatedly until LINE, LINE IN or  
SYNC LINE IN appears in the display.  
You should hear audio from your portable music player although it may  
be low.  
43  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
7. Adjust the sound on your portable music player until it reaches the  
level of the FM station or CD by switching back and forth between the  
AUX and FM or CD controls.  
Troubleshooting:  
1. Do not connect the audio input jack to a line level output. Line level  
outputs are intended for connection to a home stereo and are not  
compatible with the AIJ. The AIJ will only work correctly with devices  
that have a headphone output with a volume control.  
2. Do not set the portable music player’s volume level higher than is  
necessary to match the volume of the CD or FM radio in your audio  
system as this will cause distortion and will reduce sound quality. Many  
portable music players have different output levels, so not all players  
should be set at the same levels. Some players will sound best at full  
volume and others will need to be set at a lower volume.  
3. If the music sounds distorted at lower listening levels, turn the  
portable music player volume down. If the problems persists, replace or  
recharge the batteries in the portable music player.  
4. The portable music player must be controlled in the same manner  
when it is used with headphones as the AIJ does not provide control  
(play, pause, etc.) over the attached portable music player.  
5. For safety reasons, connecting or adjusting the settings on your  
portable music player should not be attempted while the vehicle is  
moving. Also, the portable music player should be stored in a secure  
location, such as the center console or the glove box, when the vehicle is  
in motion. The audio extension cable must be long enough to allow the  
portable music player to be safely stored while the vehicle is in motion.  
USB port (if equipped)  
WARNING: Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle  
control, accident and injury. Ford strongly recommends that  
drivers use extreme caution when using any device or feature that may  
take their focus off the road. Your primary responsibility is the safe  
operation of the vehicle. We recommend against the use of any  
handheld device while driving and that you comply with all applicable  
laws.  
44  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Entertainment Systems  
Your vehicle may be equipped with a  
USB port located on the instrument  
panel. This feature allows you to  
plug in media playing devices,  
memory sticks, and also to charge  
devices if they support this feature.  
For further information on this  
feature, refer to Accessing and  
using your USB port in the SYNC௡  
supplement or Navigation System  
supplement.  
GENERAL AUDIO INFORMATION  
Radio frequencies:  
AM and FM frequencies are established by the Federal Communications  
Commission (FCC) and the Canadian Radio and Telecommunications  
Commission (CRTC). Those frequencies are:  
AM: 530, 540–1700, 1710 kHz  
FM: 87.7, 87.9–107.7, 107.9 MHz  
Radio reception factors:  
There are three factors that can affect radio reception:  
Distance/strength: The further you travel from an FM station, the  
weaker the signal and the weaker the reception.  
Terrain: Hills, mountains, tall buildings, power lines, electric fences,  
traffic lights and thunderstorms can interfere with your reception.  
Station overload: When you pass a broadcast tower, a stronger signal  
may overtake a weaker one and play while the weak station frequency  
is displayed.  
45  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
CD/CD player care  
Do:  
Handle discs by their edges only.  
(Never touch the playing  
surface).  
Inspect discs before playing.  
Clean only with an approved CD  
cleaner.  
Wipe discs from the center out.  
Don’t:  
Expose discs to direct sunlight or heat sources for extended periods  
of time.  
Clean using a circular motion.  
CD units are designed to play commercially pressed 4.75 in  
(12 cm) audio compact discs only. Due to technical  
incompatibility, certain recordable and re-recordable compact  
discs may not function correctly when used in Ford CD players.  
Do not use any irregular shaped  
CDs or discs with a scratch  
protection film attached.  
46  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
CDs with homemade paper  
(adhesive) labels should not be  
inserted into the CD player as  
the label may peel and cause the  
CD to become jammed. It is  
recommended that homemade  
CDs be identified with  
permanent felt tip marker rather  
than adhesive labels. Ballpoint pens may damage CDs. Please  
contact your authorized dealer for further information.  
Audio system warranty and service  
Refer to the Warranty Guide for audio system warranty information. If  
service is necessary, see your dealer or qualified technician.  
MP3 track and folder structure  
Your MP3 system recognizes MP3 individual tracks and folder structure  
as follows:  
There are two different modes for MP3 disc playback: MP3 track mode  
(system default) and MP3 folder mode. For more information on track  
and folder mode, refer to Sample MP3 structure in the following  
section.  
MP3 track mode ignores any folder structure on the MP3 disc. The  
player numbers each MP3 track on the disc (noted by the .mp3 file  
extension) from T001 to a maximum of T255.  
Note: The maximum number of playable MP3 files may be less  
depending on the structure of the CD and exact model of radio  
present.  
MP3 folder mode represents a folder structure consisting of one level  
of folders. The CD player numbers all MP3 tracks on the disc (noted  
by the .mp3 file extension) and all folders containing MP3 files, from  
F001 (folder) T001 (track) to F253 T255.  
Creating discs with only one level of folders will help with navigation  
through the disc files.  
47  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Sample MP3 structure  
If you are burning your own MP3  
discs, it is important to understand  
how the system will read the  
structures you create. While various  
files may be present, (files with  
extensions other than mp3), only  
files with the .mp3 extension will be  
played. Other files will be ignored  
by the system. This enables you to  
use the same MP3 disc for a variety  
of tasks on your work computer,  
home computer and your in-vehicle  
system.  
.mp3  
.mp3  
1
1
2
3
.mp3  
2
3
4
5
.mp3  
.mp3  
.mp3  
4
6
7
.mp3  
.doc  
.ppt  
.xls  
In track mode, the system will display and play the structure as if it were  
only one level deep (all .mp3 files will be played, regardless of being in a  
specific folder). In folder mode, the system will only play the .mp3 files  
in the current folder.  
Satellite radio information  
Satellite radio channels: SIRIUSbroadcasts a variety of music, news,  
sports, weather, traffic and entertainment satellite radio channels. For  
more information and a complete list of SIRIUSsatellite radio channels,  
visit www.sirius.com in the United States, www.sirius-canada.ca in  
Canada, or call SIRIUSat 1–888–539–7474.  
Satellite radio reception factors: To receive the satellite signal, your  
vehicle has been equipped with a satellite radio antenna located on the  
roof of your vehicle. The vehicle roof provides the best location for an  
unobstructed, open view of the sky, a requirement of a satellite radio  
system. Like AM/FM, there are several factors that can affect satellite  
radio reception performance:  
Antenna obstructions: For optimal reception performance, keep the  
antenna clear of snow and ice build-up and keep luggage and other  
material as far away from the antenna as possible.  
48  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Entertainment Systems  
Terrain: Hills, mountains, tall buildings, bridges, tunnels, freeway  
overpasses, parking garages, dense tree foliage and thunderstorms can  
interfere with your reception.  
Station overload: When you pass a ground based broadcast repeating  
tower, a stronger signal may overtake a weaker one and result in an  
audio mute.  
Unlike AM/FM audible static, you will hear an audio mute when there is  
a satellite radio signal interference. Your radio display may display NO  
SIGNAL to indicate the interference.  
SIRIUSsatellite radio service: SIRIUSSatellite Radio is a  
subscription based satellite radio service that broadcasts music, sports,  
news and entertainment programming. A service fee is required in order  
to receive SIRIUSservice. Vehicles that are equipped with a factory  
installed SIRIUSsatellite radio system include hardware and a limited  
subscription term, which begins on the date of sale or lease of the  
vehicle.  
For information on extended subscription terms, the online media player  
and other SIRIUSfeatures, please contact SIRIUSat 1–888–539–7474.  
Note: SIRIUSreserves the unrestricted right to change, rearrange, add  
or delete programming including canceling, moving or adding particular  
channels, and its prices, at any time, with or without notice to you. Ford  
Motor Company shall not be responsible for any such programming  
changes.  
Satellite Radio Electronic Serial Number (ESN): This 12–digit  
Satellite Serial Number is needed to activate, modify or track your  
satellite radio account. You will need this number when communicating  
with SIRIUS. While in satellite radio mode, you can view this number on  
the radio display by pressing AUX and preset 1 control simultaneously.  
49  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Radio Display  
ACQUIRING  
Condition  
Action Required  
Radio requires more No action required. This  
than two seconds to message should disappear  
produce audio for  
the selected channel.  
shortly.  
SAT FAULT  
Internal module or  
system failure  
present.  
If this message does not  
clear within a short  
period of time, or with an  
ignition key cycle, your  
receiver may have a fault.  
See your authorized  
dealer for service.  
INVALID CHNL  
Channel no longer  
available.  
This previously available  
channel is no longer  
available. Tune to another  
channel. If the channel  
was one of your presets,  
you may choose another  
channel for that preset  
button.  
UNSUBSCRIBED  
Subscription not  
available for this  
channel.  
Contact SIRIUSat  
1–888–539–7474 to  
subscribe to the channel  
or tune to another  
channel.  
NO TEXT  
NO TEXT  
NO TEXT  
Artist information  
not available.  
Artist information not  
available at this time on  
this channel. The system  
is working properly.  
Song title information not  
available at this time on  
this channel. The system  
is working properly.  
Song title  
information not  
available.  
Category information Category information not  
not available.  
available at this time on  
this channel. The system  
is working properly.  
50  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Radio Display  
NO SIGNAL  
Condition  
Action Required  
Loss of signal from You are in a location that  
the SIRIUSsatellite is blocking the SIRIUS௡  
or SIRIUStower to signal (i.e., tunnel, under  
the vehicle antenna.  
an overpass, dense  
foliage, etc). The system  
is working properly.  
When you move into an  
open area, the signal  
should return.  
UPDATING  
Update of channel  
programming in  
progress.  
No action required. The  
process may take up to  
three minutes.  
CALL SIRIUS௡  
1–888–539–7474  
Satellite service has  
been deactivated by  
SIRIUSSatellite  
Radio.  
Call SIRIUSat  
1–888–539–7474 to  
re-activate or resolve  
subscription issues.  
NAVIGATION SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)  
Your vehicle may be equipped with a navigation system. Refer to the  
Navigation System supplement for further information.  
SYNC(IF EQUIPPED)  
Your vehicle may be equipped with SYNC, a hands-free communications  
and entertainment system with special phone and media features. For  
more information, please refer to the SYNCsupplement or to the  
SYNCsection in the Navigation System supplement (if equipped).  
51  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Climate Controls  
DUAL AUTOMATIC TEMPERATURE CONTROL  
1. AUTO/Driver temperature: Press to engage full automatic  
operation. The system will automatically determine fan speed, airflow  
distribution, A/C on or off, and outside or recirculated air, to heat or cool  
the vehicle to reach the desired temperature. Turn to increase/decrease  
the temperature on the driver side of the vehicle. The control also  
adjusts the passenger side temperature when PASS TEMP is disengaged.  
The recommended initial setting is between 72°F (22°C) and 75°F  
(24°C), then adjust for comfort. The driver side temperature setting will  
appear in the upper left corner of the display.  
R
2.  
Rear defroster: Press to activate/deactivate the rear window  
defroster. Refer to Rear window defroster later in this chapter for more  
information.  
3.  
Defrost: Distributes outside air through the windshield defroster  
vents and demister vents. Can be used to clear the windshield of fog and  
thin ice. The system will automatically provide outside air to reduce  
window fogging. Press this button again to return to the previous air flow  
selection or press AUTO to return to full automatic control.  
4.  
Defrost/Floor: Distributes air through the windshield defroster  
vents, demister vents, floor vents and rear seat floor vents. The system  
will automatically provide outside air to reduce window fogging. To  
return to full automatic control, press AUTO.  
52  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Climate Controls  
5.  
Power/  
: Press to activate/deactivate the climate control  
system. When the system is off, outside air is shut out. Press +  
or  
to manually increase/decrease the fan speed. The manual fan  
speed setting will appear on the left side of the display. Press AUTO to  
return to full automatic control.  
6.  
7.  
Panel: Distributes air through the instrument panel vents.  
Panel/Floor: Distributes air through the instrument panel vents,  
demister vents, floor vents and rear seat floor vents.  
8. Floor: Distributes air through the demister vents, floor vents and  
rear seat floor vents.  
9. Passenger temperature: Press to engage/disengage separate  
passenger side temperature control. Turn to increase/decrease the  
temperature on the passenger side of the vehicle. The recommended  
initial setting is between 72°F (22°C) and 75°F (24°C), then adjust for  
comfort. The passenger side temperature setting will appear in the upper  
right corner of the display.  
Each time the vehicle is started and driven without an occupant in the  
front passenger seat, the climate control system may default to single  
zone operation to improve fuel economy. This smart-zone feature will  
turn off the passenger temperature display and the temperature control  
will be based on the driver’s temperature setting. If dual zone operation  
is desired without a front passenger present, press PASS TEMP or adjust  
the passenger temperature normally. The system will remain in dual zone  
mode.  
To disable the smart-zone feature: Press and hold PASS TEMP for  
more than four seconds. Both temperature displays will begin flashing to  
signify that the feature has been disabled. The system will return to the  
previous mode after PASS TEMP is released.  
To re-enable the smart-zone feature: Press and hold PASS TEMP for  
more than four seconds. The driver’s temperature display will begin  
flashing to signify that the feature has been re-enabled. The system will  
return to the previous mode after PASS TEMP is released.  
10.  
Passenger heated seat control (if equipped): Press to  
activate/deactivate the passenger heated seat. See Heated seats in the  
Seating and Safety Restraints chapter.  
53  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Climate Controls  
11.  
Recirculated air: Press to activate/deactivate air recirculation  
in the vehicle. Recirculated air may reduce the amount of time needed to  
cool down the interior of the vehicle, may reduce the energy needed to  
keep the interior of the vehicle cool, and may also help reduce undesired  
outside odors from reaching the interior of the vehicle. Recirculated air  
is controlled automatically when AUTO is selected or can be engaged  
manually in any airflow mode except  
(defrost). Recirculated air  
may turn off automatically in some airflow modes to reduce window  
fogging potential. When the ignition switch is turned off and back on, the  
climate system will return to the recirculated air mode only if the A/C  
button LED is illuminated and the air distribution selection is either  
AUTO,  
(panel) or  
(panel/floor).  
12. MAX A/C: Activates air conditioning and distributes recirculated,  
conditioned air through the instrument panel vents to provide maximum  
cooling performance. Maximum cooling performance, however, may  
decrease fuel efficiency in order to fully maintain interior cabin comfort.  
13. A/C: Press to activate/deactivate air conditioning. Use with  
recirculated air to improve cooling performance and efficiency. Engages  
automatically in AUTO,  
(defrost) and  
(floor/defrost).  
14. Driver heated seat control (if equipped): Press to  
activate/deactivate the driver heated seat. See Heated seats in the  
Seating and Safety Restraints chapter.  
Outside temperature: The outside temperature will appear in the  
display and is labeled EXT TEMP.  
Temperature conversion: To switch between Fahrenheit and Celsius,  
refer to Message center in the Driver Controls chapter.  
Operating tips  
To reduce fog build-up on the windshield during humid weather,  
select  
(defrost) or  
(floor/defrost).  
To reduce humidity build-up inside the vehicle, do not drive with the  
system OFF or with (recirculated air) engaged and A/C off.  
Do not put objects under the front seats that will interfere with the  
airflow to the back seats.  
Remove any snow, ice or leaves from the air intake area at the base of  
the windshield.  
To improve the A/C cool down, drive with the windows slightly open  
for 2-3 minutes after start up or until the vehicle has been “aired out.”  
54  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Climate Controls  
A small amount of air may be felt from the floor vent regardless of the  
air distribution setting that is selected.  
During extreme high ambient temperatures when idling stationary for  
extended periods of time in gear, it is recommended to run the A/C in  
the MAX A/C position, reduce blower fan speed from the highest setting  
and put the vehicle’s transmission into the P (Park) gear position to  
continue to receive cool air from your A/C system.  
For maximum cooling performance:  
Automatic operation:  
1. Press AUTO for full automatic operation.  
2. Do not override A/C or  
(recirculated air).  
3. Set the temperature to 60°F (16°C).  
Manual operation:  
1. Select A/C.  
2. Select  
3. Select  
or  
.
(recirculated air) to provide colder airflow.  
4. Set the temperature to 60°F (16°C).  
5. Set highest fan setting initially, then adjust to maintain comfort.  
To aid in side window defogging/demisting in cold weather:  
1. Select  
.
2. Select A/C.  
3. Adjust the temperature control to maintain comfort.  
4. Set the fan speed to the highest setting.  
5. Direct the outer instrument panel vents towards the side windows.  
To increase airflow to the outer instrument panel vents, close the vents  
located in the middle of the instrument panel.  
55  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Climate Controls  
R
REAR WINDOW DEFROSTER  
The rear defroster control is located on the climate control panel and  
works to clear the rear window of fog and thin ice.  
The vehicle must be on to operate the rear window defroster.  
R
Press  
to turn the rear window defroster on. An indicator light on the  
button will illuminate when active. The rear window defroster turns off  
automatically after approximately 15 minutes. If a low battery condition  
is detected or the ignition is turned off or to the accessory position, the  
rear window defroster will not function. To manually turn off the rear  
R
window defroster at any time, press  
again.  
If your vehicle is equipped with both rear defroster and heated mirrors,  
the same button will activate both. Refer to Heated outside mirrors in  
the Driver Controls chapter.  
Do not use razor blades or other sharp objects to clean the inside  
of the rear window or to remove decals from the inside or the  
rear window. This may cause damage to the heated grid lines and  
will not be covered by your warranty.  
56  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Lights  
HEADLAMP CONTROL  
Rotate the headlamp control to the  
first position  
to turn on the  
parking lamps.  
Rotate to the second position  
turn on the headlamps.  
to  
Rotate back to  
headlamps off.  
to turn the  
Autolamp control (if equipped)  
The autolamp system provides light  
sensitive automatic on-off control of  
the exterior lights normally  
controlled by the headlamp control.  
The autolamp system is factory  
programmed to keep the lights on  
for 20 seconds after the ignition  
switch is turned to off. This delay  
can be programmed, using the  
procedure listed below, to any value  
up to 180 seconds. If equipped, this  
delay can also be programmed through the message center  
To turn autolamps on, rotate the control counterclockwise.  
To turn autolamps off, rotate the control clockwise to the off position.  
Note: If the vehicle is equipped with autolamps it will have the  
headlamps on with windshield wipers feature. If the windshield  
wipers are turned on for a brief period of time, the exterior lamps will  
turn on with the headlamp control in the autolamp position.  
Autolamp delay system (if equipped)  
If your vehicle is equipped with autolamps, you can set the delay time to  
keep the headlights on for up to three minutes after the key is turned  
off. The delay time is set to 20 seconds at the factory, but the delay time  
may be changed by following the steps below (Steps 1 through 6 must  
be done within 10 seconds):  
1. Turn the vehicle off.  
57  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Lights  
2. Rotate the headlamp control to the autolamp position.  
3. Rotate the headlamp control to the off position.  
4. Turn the vehicle on.  
5. Turn the vehicle off.  
6. Turn the headlamp control to the autolamp position (the headlights  
should turn on).  
7. Turn the headlamp control to the off position when the desired delay  
time (up to three minutes) has been reached.  
Fog lamp control (if equipped)  
The headlamp control also operates  
the fog lamps. The fog lamps can be  
turned on when the headlamp  
control is in the  
,
or  
positions and the high beams are  
not turned on.  
Pull the headlamp control towards  
you to turn the fog lamps on. The  
fog lamp indicator light will  
illuminate.  
High beams  
Push the lever toward the  
instrument panel to activate. Pull  
the lever toward you to deactivate.  
58  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Lights  
Flash-to-pass  
Pull toward you slightly to activate  
and release to deactivate.  
Daytime running lamps (DRL) (if equipped)  
Turns the low beam headlamps on with a reduced output.  
To activate:  
the ignition must be in the on position.  
the headlamp control must be in the off , parking lamps or autolamp  
position.  
the transmission is not in P (Park),  
WARNING: Always remember to turn on your headlamps at  
dusk or during inclement weather. The Daytime Running Lamp  
(DRL) system does not activate the tail lamps and generally may not  
provide adequate lighting during these conditions. Failure to activate  
your headlamps under these conditions may result in a collision.  
PANEL DIMMER CONTROL  
Use to adjust the brightness of the  
instrument panel and all applicable  
switches in the vehicle during  
headlamp and parking lamp  
operation.  
Move the control to the full upright  
position, past detent, to turn on the  
interior lamps.  
Rotate to full down position (past  
detent) to prevent interior lamps  
from illuminating when the doors are opened.  
59  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Lights  
Note: If the battery is disconnected, discharged, or a new battery is  
installed, the dimmer switch requires re-calibration. Rotate the dimmer  
switch from the full dim position to the full dome/on position to reset.  
This will ensure that your displays are visible under all lighting  
conditions.  
AIMING THE HEADLAMPS  
The headlamps on your vehicle are properly aimed at the assembly plant.  
If your vehicle has been in an accident, the alignment of your headlamps  
should be checked by your authorized dealer.  
Vertical aim adjustment  
1. Park the vehicle directly in front of a wall or screen on a level surface,  
approximately 25 feet (7.6 meters) away.  
(1) 8 feet (2.4 meters)  
(2) Center height of lamp to  
ground  
(3) 25 feet (7.6 meters)  
(4) Horizontal reference line  
2. Measure the height from the  
center of your headlamp to the  
ground and mark an 8 foot  
(2.4 meter) horizontal reference line  
on the vertical wall or screen at this  
height (a piece of masking tape works well). The center of the lamp is  
marked by a 3 mm circle on the headlamp lens.  
3. Turn on the low beam headlamps to illuminate the wall or screen and  
open the hood. Cover the left-hand headlamp with an opaque cloth.  
4. On the wall or screen you will  
observe a light pattern with a  
distinct horizontal edge of high  
intensity light towards the right. If  
this edge is not at the horizontal  
reference line, the beam will need to  
be adjusted.  
60  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Lights  
5. Locate the vertical adjuster on  
the headlamp, then use a 4 mm  
socket to turn the adjuster either  
counterclockwise (to adjust up) or  
clockwise (to adjust down) aligning  
the upper edge of the light pattern  
to the horizontal line.  
6. Move the opaque cloth to cover  
the right-hand headlamp and repeat  
Steps 4 and 5 for the left-hand  
headlamp.  
7. Close the hood and turn off the lamps.  
HORIZONTAL AIM IS NOT REQUIRED FOR THIS VEHICLE AND IS  
NON-ADJUSTABLE.  
TURN SIGNAL CONTROL  
Push down to activate the left  
turn signal.  
Push up to activate the right turn  
signal.  
INTERIOR LAMPS  
Dome lamps and map lamps  
The front dome lamp is located overhead between the driver and  
passenger seats.  
The dome lamp is preset to  
illuminate when a door is opened  
and will remain on for 25 seconds  
after the door is closed. To manually  
turn on the dome lamp, rotate the  
panel dimmer control, located on  
the instrument panel, to the full  
upright position past the detent.  
To turn off the dome lamp, rotate the panel dimmer control to the full  
down position past the detent. Note: When manually in the off position,  
the dome lamp will not illuminate when the door(s) are opened.  
61  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Lights  
The map lamp controls (without  
moon roof) are located on the dome  
lamp. Press the button on either  
side of each map lamp to illuminate  
the lamps. Press the button again to  
turn off the lamps.  
For models equipped with a moon  
roof, the map lamps are located on  
the moon roof control panel. Press  
the button on either side of each  
map lamp to illuminate the lamps.  
Press the button again to turn off  
the lamps.  
The map lamps will illuminate  
whenever a door is opened. After  
the door is shut, the lamps will  
remain illuminated for 25 seconds.  
Cargo and dome lamp  
Rear cargo lamp equipped with an  
ON/OFF/DOOR control will light  
when:  
the doors are closed and the  
control is in the ON position.  
the control is in the DOOR  
position and any door is open.  
When the control is in the OFF position, it will not illuminate when you  
open the doors.  
62  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lights  
Ambient lighting (if equipped)  
Illuminates footwells, cupholders,  
the console bin and the console tray  
with a choice of several colors. The  
ambient lighting control switch is  
located on the floor console. To  
activate, press and release the  
control to cycle through the color  
choices plus the off state.  
The lights come on whenever the ignition is in either the on or accessory  
position.  
Note: The ambient lights will stay on until the ignition is placed in the  
off position and either of the front doors are opened or the accessory  
delay timer expires.  
Interior lighting battery saver  
The interior lamps will automatically extinguish after 10 minutes when  
the ignition key is in the off position, a door has been left open or the  
interior lamp controls are in the on position.  
BULB REPLACEMENT  
Lamp assembly condensation  
Exterior lamps are vented to accommodate normal changes in pressure.  
Condensation can be a natural by-product of this design. When moist air  
enters the lamp assembly through the vents, there is a possibility that  
condensation can occur when the temperature is cold. When normal  
condensation occurs, a thin film of mist can form on the interior of the  
lens. The thin mist eventually clears and exits through the vents during  
normal operation. Clearing time may take as long as 48 hours under dry  
weather conditions.  
Examples of acceptable condensation are:  
Presence of thin mist (no streaks, drip marks or droplets)  
Fine mist covers less than 50% of the lens  
Examples of unacceptable moisture (usually caused by a lamp water  
leak) are:  
Water puddle inside the lamp  
Large water droplets, drip marks or streaks present on the interior of  
the lens  
63  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Lights  
Take your vehicle to a dealer for service if any of the above conditions of  
unacceptable moisture are present.  
Using the right bulbs  
Replacement bulbs are specified in the chart below. Headlamp bulbs  
must be marked with an authorized “D.O.T.” for North America and an  
“E” for Europe to ensure lamp performance, light brightness and pattern  
and safe visibility. The correct bulbs will not damage the lamp assembly  
or void the lamp assembly warranty and will provide quality bulb burn  
time.  
Function  
Number of bulbs  
Trade number  
Headlamps  
2
H13  
(high and low beams)  
Park/turn lamps  
(front)  
Side marker (front)  
Rear  
stop/tail/sidemarker  
Backup lamp  
Fog lamp (front)  
Center High-mount  
stop lamp  
2
3457A (amber)  
194  
2
2
3157K / 4157K  
2
2
5
921  
PS24WFF  
W5WL  
168  
Rear license plate  
lamp  
2
All replacement bulbs are clear in color except where noted.  
To replace all instrument panel lights - see your authorized dealer  
Replacing interior bulbs  
Check the operation of all bulbs frequently.  
Replacing exterior bulbs  
Check the operation of all the bulbs frequently.  
64  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Lights  
Replacing headlamp bulbs  
1. Make sure that the headlamp control is in the off position.  
2. Open the hood.  
3. Reach over the front bolster.  
4. Remove the bulb by turning it  
counterclockwise and then pulling it  
straight out.  
5. Disconnect the electrical  
connector from the bulb.  
WARNING: Handle a  
halogen headlamp bulb  
carefully and keep out of  
children’s reach. Grasp the bulb  
only by its plastic base and do not  
touch the glass. The oil from your  
hand could cause the bulb to  
break the next time the  
headlamps are operated.  
6. Connect the electrical connector on the new bulb.  
7. Insert the glass end of the new bulb into the headlamp assembly.  
When the grooves in the plastic base are aligned, turn the new bulb  
clockwise to install.  
Replacing front parking lamp/turn signal bulbs  
1. Make sure that the headlamp control is in the off position.  
2. Open the hood.  
3. Reach over the front bolster.  
4. Rotate the bulb socket  
counterclockwise and remove from  
the lamp assembly.  
65  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Lights  
5. Carefully pull the bulb out of the  
socket and push in the new bulb.  
6. Install the bulb socket into the  
lamp assembly and rotate clockwise.  
Replacing front sidemarker bulbs  
For bulb replacement, see your authorized dealer.  
Replacing tail/stop/turn/sidemarker/backup lamp bulbs  
The tail/stop/turn/sidemarker/backup lamp bulbs are located in the same  
portion of the tail lamp assembly, one just below the other. Follow the  
same steps to replace either bulb:  
1. Make sure the headlamp switch is  
in the off position and then open  
the liftgate to expose the lamp  
assembly screws.  
2. Remove the two screws from the  
lamp assembly.  
3. Carefully remove the lamp  
assembly away from the vehicle by  
pulling the assembly straight out to  
expose the bulb socket.  
4. Rotate the bulb socket counterclockwise and remove from lamp  
assembly.  
5. Pull bulb straight out of socket and push in the new bulb.  
6. Install the bulb socket into the lamp assembly and rotate clockwise.  
7. Carefully install the tail lamp assembly on the vehicle and secure with  
two screws.  
66  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lights  
Replacing license plate lamp bulbs  
1. Make sure the headlamp switch is  
in the off position.  
2. Depress the lever and carefully  
pry the license plate lamp assembly  
(located above the license plate)  
from the liftgate.  
3. Rotate the bulb socket  
counterclockwise and remove from  
lamp assembly.  
4. Pull bulb straight out of socket  
and push in the new bulb.  
5. Install the bulb socket into the  
lamp assembly and rotate clockwise.  
6. To install, carefully press the  
lamp assembly into liftgate.  
Replacing high-mount brake lamp bulbs  
To remove the lamp assembly:  
1. Remove the two screws and move  
the lamp assembly away from the  
liftgate.  
2. Remove the bulb holder from the  
lamp assembly by depressing the  
snaps.  
67  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lights  
3. Pull the bulb straight out of the  
socket and push in the new bulb.  
To complete installation, follow the  
removal procedure in reverse order.  
Replacing fog lamp bulbs (if equipped)  
1. Make sure the fog lamp switch is  
in the off position.  
2. From underneath the vehicle,  
carefully disconnect the electrical  
connector from the bulb.  
3. Remove the bulb from the lamp  
assembly by pulling out on the bulb  
while squeezing on the upper and  
lower snap clips at the same time.  
Install the new bulb in reverse  
order.  
68  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
MULTI-FUNCTION LEVER  
Windshield wiper: Rotate the end  
of the control away from you to  
increase the speed of the wipers;  
rotate towards you to decrease the  
speed of the wipers.  
Windshield washer: Press the end  
of the stalk:  
briefly: causes a single swipe of  
the wipers without washer fluid.  
a quick press and hold: the  
wipers will swipe three times with  
washer fluid.  
a long press and hold: the wipers and washer fluid will be activated for  
up to ten seconds.  
Courtesy wipe feature: One extra wipe will occur a few seconds after  
washing the front window to clear any excess washer fluid remaining on  
the windshield.  
Note: Do not operate the washer when the washer reservoir is empty.  
This may cause the washer pump to overheat. Check the washer fluid  
level frequently. Do not operate the wipers when the windshield is dry.  
This may scratch the glass, damage the wiper blades and cause the wiper  
motor to burn out. Before operating the wiper on a dry windshield,  
always use the windshield washer. In freezing weather, be sure the wiper  
blades are not frozen to the windshield before operating the wipers.  
Windshield wiper rainlamp feature (if equipped with autolamp)  
When the windshield wipers are turned on during daylight, and the  
headlamp control is in the autolamp position, the exterior lamps will turn  
on after a brief delay and will remain on until the wipers are turned off.  
69  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
Rear window wiper/washer controls  
For rear wiper operation, rotate the  
rear window wiper and washer  
control to the desired position.  
Select:  
2 — Normal speed operation of rear  
wiper.  
1 — Intermittent operation of rear  
wiper.  
O (off) — Rear wiper and washer off.  
For rear wash cycle, rotate (and hold as desired) the rear wiper/washer  
control to either  
position.  
From either position, the control will automatically return to the INT 2  
or O (off) position.  
TILT STEERING WHEEL  
To adjust the steering wheel:  
1. Pull down the steering column tilt  
lever.  
2. Move the steering wheel up or  
down until you find the desired  
location.  
3. Push the steering column tilt  
lever up. This will lock the steering  
wheel in position.  
WARNING: Never adjust  
the steering wheel when the  
vehicle is moving.  
70  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
ILLUMINATED VISOR MIRROR  
Lift the mirror cover to turn on the  
visor mirror lamps.  
Slide-on-rod feature  
The visor will slide back and forth  
on the rod for increased sunlight  
coverage. Rotate the visor towards  
the side window and extend it  
rearward for additional sunlight  
coverage.  
Note: To stow the visor back into  
the headliner, visor must be  
retracted before moving it back  
towards the windshield.  
ELECTRONIC COMPASS  
The compass heading is displayed in the center stack display.  
The compass reading may be affected when you drive near large  
buildings, bridges, power lines and powerful broadcast antenna. Magnetic  
or metallic objects placed in, on or near the vehicle may also affect  
compass accuracy.  
Usually, when something affects the compass readings, the compass will  
correct itself after a few days of operating your vehicle in normal  
conditions. If the compass still appears to be inaccurate, a manual  
calibration may be necessary. Refer to Compass calibration  
adjustment.  
Most geographic areas (zones) have a magnetic north compass point that  
varies slightly from the northerly direction on maps. This variation is four  
degrees between adjacent zones and will become noticeable as the  
vehicle crosses multiple zones. A correct zone setting will eliminate this  
error. Refer to Compass zone adjustment.  
71  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
Compass zone adjustment  
1. Determine which magnetic zone  
you are in for your geographic  
location by referring to the zone  
map.  
3 2  
4
1
15  
14  
13  
2. Turn ignition to the on position.  
3. Start the engine.  
5
12  
6
7 8 91011  
4. Press the SETUP control to select  
the Update Zone function and  
display the current ZONE XX in the  
center stack display.  
5. Continue to press the RESET  
control until the correct zone  
appears in the center stack display.  
6. The direction will display after  
the RESET control is released. The  
zone is now updated.  
Compass calibration adjustment  
Perform compass calibration in an open area free from steel structures  
and high voltage lines. For optimum calibration, turn off all electrical  
accessories (heater/air conditioning, wipers, etc.) and make sure all  
vehicle doors are shut.  
1. Start the vehicle.  
72  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
2. To calibrate, press and hold the  
RESET control for approximately  
ten seconds until CAL appears.  
Release the control.  
3. Slowly drive the vehicle in a  
circle (less than 3 mph [5 km/h]) until the CAL display changes to the  
direction value. It may take up to five circles to complete calibration.  
4. The compass is now calibrated.  
CENTER CONSOLE  
Your vehicle is equipped with a variety of console features. These  
include:  
1. Cupholders  
2. Utility compartment console lid  
has a CD holder, a business card  
holder and two pen holders. The  
utility compartment has a removable  
bin with coin holder slots, a sliding  
tray, a cell phone holder and CD  
holders.  
3. Rear power point  
4. Rear cupholders  
5. Small storage trays and (if equipped) an ambient light control switch.  
WARNING: Use only soft cups in the cupholders. Hard objects  
can injure you in a collision.  
73  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
The tray and inside bin can be  
removed to open up space to fit a  
laptop computer, MP3 players, CDs  
or handbags. To remove, open the  
console lid and pull the bin straight  
up and out from the console  
housing.  
The sliding tray and inside bin can  
be hooked on the side or rear of the  
console for extra storage.  
AUXILIARY POWER POINT (12V)  
Power outlets are designed for accessory plugs only. Do not insert  
any other object in the power outlet as this will damage the  
outlet and blow the fuse. Do not hang any type of accessory or  
accessory bracket from the plug. Improper use of the power  
outlet can cause damage not covered by your warranty.  
Auxiliary power points can be found in the following locations:  
On the instrument panel  
On the rear side of the center console  
Do not use the power point for operating the cigarette lighter element (if  
equipped).  
To prevent the fuse from being blown, do not use the power point(s)  
over the vehicle capacity of 12V DC/180W. If the power point or cigar  
lighter socket is not working, a fuse may have blown. Refer to Fuses and  
relays in the Roadside Emergencies chapter for information on  
checking and replacing fuses.  
74  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
To have full capacity usage of your power point, the engine is required to  
be running to avoid unintentional discharge of the battery. To prevent  
the battery from being discharged:  
do not use the power point longer than necessary when the engine is  
not running,  
do not leave battery chargers, video game adapters, computers and  
other devices plugged in overnight or when the vehicle is parked for  
extended periods.  
Always keep the power point caps closed when not being used.  
Power point (110V AC)  
The 110V AC power point outlet is used for powering electrical devices  
that require up to 150W. Exceeding the 150W limit will cause the power  
point to cut off the power temporarily to provide overload protection.  
Note: The 110V AC power point is  
equipped with a safety cap and a  
safety twist tab. They both provide  
protection from inserting any object  
into the power point other than the  
110V AC electrical device plug. The  
safety cap should always be in a  
closed position whenever the power  
point outlet is not in use.  
The 110V AC power point is located  
in the floor console in front of the  
gearshift.  
The power outlet is not designed for the following electric appliances;  
they may not work properly:  
Cathode ray tube type televisions  
Motor loads, such as vacuum cleaners, electric saws and other electric  
power tools, compressor-driven refrigerators, etc.  
Measuring devices, which process precise data, such as medical  
equipment, measuring equipment, etc.  
Other appliances requiring an extremely stable power supply:  
microcomputer-controlled electric blankets, touch sensor lamps, etc.  
Do not keep electrical devices plugged in the power point  
whenever the device is not in use. It is not recommended to use  
any extension cord with the 110V AC power point, since it will  
75  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
defeat the safety protection design provided by the cap and twist  
tab. It will also cause the power point to overload due to  
powering multiple devices that can reach beyond the 150W load  
limit.  
The power point can switch to a fault mode when it is overloaded,  
overheated, or shorted. For overloading and shorting conditions, unplug  
your device and turn the ignition key off then on. For an overheating  
condition, let the system cool off, then turn the ignition key off then on.  
The 110V AC power point can provide power whenever the vehicle  
ignition is on and the power point green indicator light located in the top  
left corner is turned on. Refer to the indicator light code below for the  
power point status.  
Indicator light Code  
Green light is on — Power point is ready to supply power  
Green light is off — Power point power supply is off. Ignition is not on  
Green light is blinking — Power point is in fault mode  
POWER WINDOWS (IF EQUIPPED)  
WARNING: Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle and  
do not let children play with the power windows. They may  
seriously injure themselves.  
WARNING: When closing the power windows, you should verify  
they are free of obstructions and ensure that children and/or  
pets are not in the proximity of the window openings.  
Press and pull the window switches  
to open and close windows.  
Press down (to the first detent)  
and hold the switch to open.  
Pull up and hold the switch to  
close.  
Rear window buffeting: When one or both of the rear windows are  
open, the vehicle may demonstrate a wind throb or buffeting noise; this  
noise can be alleviated by lowering a front window approximately two to  
three inches.  
76  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
One-touch down  
Allows the driver’s window to open fully without holding the control  
down. Press the switch completely down to the second detent and  
release quickly. The window will open fully. Momentarily press the switch  
to any position to stop the window operation.  
Window lock  
The window lock feature allows only  
the driver to operate the power  
windows.  
To lock out all the window controls  
(except for the driver’s) press the  
right side of the control. Press the  
left side to restore the window  
controls.  
Accessory delay  
With accessory delay, the window switches, moon roof (if equipped) and  
audio system may be used for up to 10 minutes after the ignition switch  
is turned to the off position or until either front door is opened.  
INTERIOR MIRROR  
The interior rear view mirror has two pivot points on the support arm  
which lets you adjust the mirror up or down and from side to side.  
WARNING: Do not adjust the mirror while the vehicle is in  
motion.  
Automatic dimming interior rear view mirror  
The interior rear view mirror has an auto-dimming function. The  
electronic day/night mirror will change from the normal (high reflective)  
state to the non-glare (darkened) state when bright lights (glare) reach  
the mirror. When the mirror detects bright light from behind the vehicle,  
it will automatically adjust (darken) to minimize glare.  
The mirror will automatically return to the normal state whenever the  
vehicle is placed in R (Reverse) to ensure a bright clear view when  
backing up.  
Do not block the sensors on the front and back of the interior  
rear view mirror since this may impair proper mirror  
performance.  
77  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
Note: A rear center passenger and/or raised rear center headrest (if  
equipped) may also block the light from reaching the sensor.  
Do not clean the housing or glass of any mirror with harsh  
abrasives, fuel or other petroleum-based cleaning products.  
Note: If equipped with a rearview camera system, a video image will  
display in the mirror or the navigation system display (if equipped) when  
the vehicle is put in R (Reverse). As you shift into any other gear from R  
(Reverse), the image will remain for a few seconds and then turn off.  
Refer to Rearview camera system in the Driving chapter.  
EXTERIOR MIRRORS  
Power side view mirrors  
WARNING: Do not adjust the mirror while the vehicle is in  
motion.  
To adjust your mirrors:  
1. Rotate the control clockwise to  
adjust the right mirror and rotate  
the control counterclockwise to  
adjust the left mirror.  
2. Move the control in the direction  
you wish to tilt the mirror.  
3. Return to the center position to lock mirrors in place.  
Blind spot mirrors  
Your vehicle is equipped with blind spot mirrors. Refer to Blind spot  
mirrors in the Driving chapter.  
Fold-away mirrors  
Fold the side mirrors in carefully  
when driving through a narrow  
space, like an automatic car wash.  
78  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
Heated outside mirrors  
(if equipped)  
Both mirrors are heated  
automatically to remove ice, mist  
and fog when the rear window  
defrost is activated.  
Do not remove ice from the  
mirrors with a scraper or  
attempt to readjust the mirror  
glass if it is frozen in place.  
These actions could cause damage to the glass and mirrors.  
Do not clean the housing or glass of any mirror with harsh  
abrasives, fuel or other petroleum-based cleaning products.  
SPEED CONTROL  
With speed control set, you can maintain a set speed without keeping  
your foot on the accelerator pedal.  
WARNING: Do not use the speed control in heavy traffic or on  
roads that are winding, slippery or unpaved.  
Using speed control  
The speed controls are located on the steering wheel. The following  
buttons work with speed control:  
OFF: Press to turn speed control  
off.  
ON: Press to turn speed control on.  
SET +: Press to set a speed or  
increase a set speed.  
SET –: Press to decrease a set  
speed.  
RES (Resume): Press to resume a  
set speed.  
Setting speed control  
To set speed control:  
1. Press and release ON.  
2. Accelerate to the desired speed.  
79  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
3. Press and release SET +.  
4. Take your foot off the accelerator pedal.  
5. The indicator  
light on the instrument cluster will turn on.  
Note:  
Vehicle speed may vary momentarily when driving up and down a  
steep hill.  
If the vehicle speed increases above the set speed on a downhill, you  
may want to apply the brakes to reduce the speed.  
If the vehicle speed decreases more than 10 mph (16 km/h) below  
your set speed on an uphill, your speed control will disengage.  
Disengaging speed control  
Tap the brake pedal or clutch pedal (if equipped) to disengage the speed  
control. Disengaging the speed control will not erase previous set speed.  
Note: When you use the clutch pedal to disengage the speed control,  
the engine speed may briefly increase, this is normal.  
Resuming a set speed  
Press and release RES. This will automatically return the vehicle to the  
previously set speed.  
Increasing speed while using speed control  
To set a higher speed:  
Press and hold SET + until you get to the desired speed, then release.  
You can also use SET + to operate the tap-up function. Press and  
release SET + to increase the set speed in 1 mph (1.6 km/h)  
increments.  
Use the accelerator pedal to get to the desired speed, then speed  
press and release SET +.  
Reducing speed while using speed control  
To reduce a set speed:  
Press and hold SET– until you get to the desired speed, then release.  
You can also use SET– to operate the tap-down function. Press and  
release SET– to decrease the set speed in 1 mph (1.6 km/h)  
increments.  
Press the brake pedal or the clutch pedal (if equipped) until the  
desired vehicle speed is reached and press and release SET +.  
80  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
Turning off speed control  
To turn off the speed control, press OFF or turn off the ignition.  
Note: When you turn off the speed control or the ignition, your speed  
control set speed memory is erased.  
STEERING WHEEL CONTROLS  
These controls allow you to operate some audio control features.  
Radio control features  
VOL + (Volume): Press to increase  
the volume.  
VOL – (Volume): Press to decrease  
the volume.  
(Seek): Press to select  
the next/previous radio station  
preset, CD track or satellite radio  
preset channel (if equipped)  
depending on which media mode  
you are in.  
MEDIA: Press repeatedly to scroll through available audio modes.  
Navigation system hands-free  
control features (if equipped)  
Press and hold  
until the voice  
control briefly  
icon appears on  
the navigation display to use the  
voice command feature.  
Press  
to complete a voice  
command.  
For further information on the  
navigation system, refer to the Navigation System supplement.  
81  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
SYNCsystem hands-free  
control feature (if equipped)  
Press  
briefly to use the voice  
command feature. You will hear a  
tone and LISTENING will appear in  
the radio display. Press and  
hold  
to exit voice command.  
Press  
to activate phone mode or  
answer a phone call. Press and  
hold  
to end a call or exit phone  
mode.  
Press  
to scroll through various menus and selections. Press  
OK to confirm your selection.  
For further information on the SYNCsystem, refer to the SYNC௡  
supplement.  
Navigation system/SYNC௡  
hands-free control features (if  
equipped)  
Press  
voice  
control briefly until the  
icon appears on the  
Navigation display to use the voice  
command feature.  
Press  
to activate phone mode or  
answer a phone call. Press and  
hold  
to exit phone mode or end  
a call.  
For further information on the Navigation system/SYNCsystem, refer to  
the Navigation System and SYNCsupplements.  
MOON ROOF (IF EQUIPPED)  
You can move the glass panel of the moon roof back to open or tilt up  
(from the closed position) to ventilate the vehicle.  
WARNING: Do not let children play with the moon roof or leave  
children unattended in the vehicle. They may seriously hurt  
themselves.  
82  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
To open the moon roof: The moon  
roof is equipped with an automatic,  
one-touch, opening, closing and  
venting feature. Press and release  
the rear portion of the control. To  
stop motion at any time during the  
one-touch operation, press the  
control a second time.  
WARNING: When closing the moon roof, you should verify that  
it is free of obstructions and ensure that children and/or pets are  
not in the proximity of the moon roof opening.  
To close the moon roof: The moon roof is equipped with an automatic,  
one-touch, closing feature. Press and release the front portion of the  
control. To stop motion at any time during the one-touch closing, press  
the control again.  
Bounce-back: When an obstacle has been detected in the moon roof  
opening as the moon roof is closing, the moon roof will automatically  
open and stop at a prescribed position. This is known as “bounce-back”.  
If the ignition is turned off (without accessory delay being active) during  
bounce-back, the moon roof will move until the bounce-back position is  
reached.  
Bounce-back override: To override bounce-back, press and hold the  
front portion of the control. For example: Bounce-back can be used to  
overcome the resistance of ice on the moon roof or seals. If during a  
bounce-back condition, the control is released to the neutral position,  
then held in the one-touch position within two seconds after the moon  
roof reaches the bounce-back position, the moon roof will travel with  
no bounce-back protection. If the control is released before the moon  
roof reaches fully closed or the ignition is turned off (without accessory  
delay being active), the moon roof will stop.  
To vent:  
The moon roof is equipped with an automatic, one-touch, vent feature.  
To tilt the moon roof into the vent position (when the glass panel is  
closed), press and release the front portion of the control.  
To close the moon roof from the vent position, press and hold the rear  
portion of the control until the glass panel stops moving.  
83  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
The moon roof has a sliding shade that can be opened or closed when  
the glass panel is shut. To close the shade, pull it toward the front of the  
vehicle.  
Accessory delay:  
With accessory delay, the window switches, audio system, and moon roof  
(if equipped) may be used for up to 10 minutes after the ignition switch  
is turned off or until either front door is opened.  
UNIVERSAL GARAGE DOOR OPENER (IF EQUIPPED)  
Your vehicle may be equipped with a universal garage door opener which  
can be used to replace the common hand-held transmitter.  
Car2UHome Automation System (if equipped)  
The Car2UHome Automation  
System is a universal transmitter  
located in the driver’s visor that  
includes two primary features – a  
garage door opener and a platform  
for remote activation of devices  
within the home. The Car2U௡  
system’s garage door opener  
function replaces the common  
hand-held garage door opener with a three-button transmitter that is  
integrated into the interior of your vehicle. After being programmed for  
garage doors, the Car2Usystem transmitter can be programmed to  
operate security devices and home lighting systems.  
WARNING: Make sure that people and objects are clear of the  
garage door or security device you are programming. Do not  
program the Car2Usystem with the vehicle in the garage.  
Do not use the Car2Usystem with any garage door opener that lacks  
safety stop and reverse features as required by U.S. Federal Safety  
Standards (this includes any garage door opener manufactured before  
April 1, 1982).  
Be sure to keep the original remote control transmitter for use in other  
vehicles as well as for future Car2Usystem programming. It is also  
recommended that upon the sale or lease termination of the vehicle, the  
programmed Car2Usystem buttons should be erased for security  
reasons. Refer to Erasing the Car2UHome Automation System  
buttons later in this section.  
84  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
Read the instructions completely before attempting to program the  
Car2Usystem. Because of the steps involved, it may be helpful to have  
another person assist you in programming the transmitter.  
Additional Car2Usystem information can be found on-line at  
www.learcar2U.com or by calling the toll-free Car2Usystem help line at  
1-866-572-2728.  
Types of garage door openers (rolling code and fixed code)  
The Car2UHome Automation System may be programmed to operate  
rolling code and fixed code garage door openers.  
Rolling code garage door openers were produced after 1996 and are  
code protected. Rolling code means the coded signal is changed every  
time your remote control garage door opener is used.  
Fixed code garage door openers were produced prior to 1996. Fixed  
code uses the same coded signal every time. It is manually  
programmed by setting DIP switches for a unique personal code.  
If you do not know if your garage  
door opener is a rolling code or  
O
N
1
2
4
5
9
11  
12  
10  
3
6
7
8
fixed code device, open your garage  
door opener’s remote control battery  
cover. If a panel of DIP switches is  
present your garage door opener is  
a fixed code device. If not, your  
garage door opener is a rolling code  
device.  
CTS 206-12  
T
124  
Rolling code programming  
Note: Programming the rolling code garage door opener involves  
time-sensitive actions. Read the entire procedure prior to beginning so  
you will know which actions are time-sensitive. If you do not follow the  
time-sensitive actions, the device will time out and you will have to  
repeat the procedure.  
Note: Do not program the Car2Usystem with the vehicle in the garage.  
Make sure that your key is on and engine off while programming the  
transmitter.  
85  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
1. Firmly press the two outer  
Car2Usystem buttons for  
1–2 seconds, then release.  
2. Go to the garage to locate the  
garage door opener motor and its  
“learn” button. You may need a  
ladder to reach the unit and you  
may need to remove the unit’s cover  
or light lens to locate the “learn”  
button. Press the “learn” button,  
after which you will have  
10–30 seconds to return to your  
vehicle and complete the following  
steps. If you cannot locate the  
“learn” button, refer to the Owner’s Guide of your garage door opener or  
call the toll-free Car2Usystem help line at 1-866-57Car2U  
(1-866-572-2728).  
3. Return to your vehicle. Press and  
hold the Car2Usystem button you  
would like to use to control the  
garage door. You may need to hold  
the button from 5–20 seconds,  
during which time the selected  
button indicator light will blink  
slowly. Immediately (within  
1 second) release the button once the garage door moves. When the  
button is released, the indicator light will begin to blink rapidly until  
programming is complete.  
4. Press and release the button again. The garage door should move,  
confirming that programming is successful. If your garage door does not  
operate, repeat the previous steps in this section.  
86  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
After successful programming, you will be able to operate your Car2U௡  
system by pressing the button you programmed to activate the opener.  
The indicator light above the selected button will turn on to confirm that  
the Car2Usystem is responding to the button command.  
To program another rolling code device such as an additional garage door  
opener, a security device or home lighting, repeat Steps 1 through 4  
substituting a different function button in Step 3 than what you used for  
the garage door opener. For example, you could assign the left-most  
button to the garage door, the center button to a security device, and  
the right-most button to another garage door opener.  
Note: The Car2Usystem allows for three devices to be programmed. If  
you need to change or replace any of the three devices after it has been  
initially programmed, it is necessary to erase the current settings using  
the Erasing the Car2UHome Automation System buttons procedure  
and then programming all of the devices being used.  
Fixed code programming  
Note: Do not program the Car2Usystem with the vehicle in the garage.  
Make sure that your key is on and engine off while programming the  
transmitter.  
1. To program units with fixed code DIP switches, you will need the  
garage door hand-held transmitter, paper and a pen or pencil.  
2. Open the battery cover and record the switch settings from left to  
right for all 8 to 12 switches. Use the figure below:  
When a switch is in the up, on, or + position, circle “L.”  
When a switch is in the middle, neutral, or 0 position, circle “M.”  
When a switch is in the down, off, or – position, circle “R.”  
87  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
Switch  
position  
Up, on  
or +  
Middle,  
neutral  
or 0  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10 11 12  
L
L
L
L
L
L
L
L
L
L
M
R
L
M
R
L
M
R
M
M
M
M
M
R
M
R
M
R
M
R
M
R
Down,  
off or –  
R
R
R
R
L=left; M=middle; R=right  
3. To input these positions into the  
Car2Usystem, simultaneously  
press all three Car2Usystem  
buttons for a few seconds and then  
release to put the device into  
programming mode. The indicator  
lights will blink slowly. Within  
2.5 minutes enter your  
corresponding DIP switch settings  
from left to right into your Car2Usystem by pressing and releasing the  
buttons corresponding to the settings you circled.  
4. After inputting switch settings, simultaneously press and release all  
three Car2Usystem buttons. The indicator lights will turn on.  
88  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
5. Press and hold the Car2U௡  
system button you would like to use  
to control the garage door.  
Immediately (within 1 second)  
release the button once the garage  
door moves. During this time the  
selected button indicator light will  
blink slowly. Do not release the  
button until you see the garage door move. Most garage doors open  
quickly. You may need to hold the button from 5–55 seconds before  
observing movement of the garage door.  
6. The indicator light will (begin to) blink rapidly until programming is  
complete. If your garage door opener does not operate following these  
steps, repeat Steps 2 through 6. Otherwise, call the toll-free Car2Uhelp  
line at 1-866-57Car2U (1-866-572-2728).  
After successful programming, you will be able to operate your Car2U௡  
system by pressing the button you programmed to activate the opener.  
The indicator light above the selected button will turn on to confirm that  
the Car2Usystem is responding to the button command.  
Erasing the Car2UHome Automation System buttons  
Note: The system allows for three devices to be programmed. If you  
need to change or replace any of the three devices after it has been  
initially programmed, it will be necessary to erase the current settings  
using the procedure below and then reprogramming all of the devices  
being used.  
To erase programming on the Car2Usystem (individual buttons cannot  
be erased), use the following procedure:  
1. Firmly press the two outside  
Car2Usystem buttons  
simultaneously for approximately  
20 seconds until the indicator lights  
begin to blink rapidly. The indicator  
lights are located directly above the  
buttons.  
2. Once the indicator lights begin to  
blink, release your fingers from the  
buttons. The codes for all buttons  
are erased.  
If you sell your vehicle equipped with the Car2Usystem, it is  
recommended that you erase the programming for security reasons.  
89  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
FCC and RSS-210 Industry Canada Compliance  
The Car2Usystem complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules and with  
RSS-210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the following two  
conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2)  
This device must accept any interference received including interference  
that may cause undesired operation.  
Changes and modifications to the Car2Usystem transmitter by other  
than an authorized service facility could void authorization to use the  
equipment.  
POSITIVE RETENTION FLOOR MAT  
WARNING: Do not install additional floor mats on top of the  
factory installed floor mats as they may interfere with the  
accelerator or the brake pedals.  
Position the floor mat so that the  
eyelet is over the pointed end of the  
retention post and rotate forward to  
lock in. Make sure that the mat does  
not interfere with the operation of  
the accelerator or the brake pedal.  
To remove the floor mat, reverse the  
installation procedure.  
LIFTGATE  
To open the liftgate window,  
unlock the liftgate (with the  
power door locks or the remote  
entry) and press the right side  
control button located under the  
license plate lamp shield.  
To open the liftgate, unlock the  
liftgate (with the power door  
locks or the remote entry) and  
press the middle control button  
within the pull handle, located  
below the license plate.  
To lock the liftgate and the liftgate window, use the power door locks.  
90  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
Do not open the liftgate or liftgate window in a garage or other enclosed  
area with a low ceiling. If the liftgate window is raised and the liftgate is  
also opened, both liftgate and window could be damaged against a low  
ceiling.  
Do not leave the liftgate or liftgate window open while driving. Doing so  
could cause serious damage to the liftgate and its components as well as  
allowing carbon monoxide to enter the vehicle.  
WARNING: Make sure that the liftgate door and/or window are  
closed to prevent exhaust fumes from being drawn into the  
vehicle. Exhaust fumes contain carbon monoxide which can injure your  
lungs and cause drowsiness and even death. This will also prevent  
passengers and cargo from falling out. If you must drive with the  
liftgate door or window open, keep the vents open so outside air comes  
into the vehicle.  
CARGO AREA FEATURES  
Cargo shade (if equipped)  
If your vehicle has a cargo shade, you can use it to cover items in the  
cargo area of your vehicle.  
To install the shade:  
Insert the ends of the cargo  
shade into the mounting features  
located behind the rear seat on  
the rear trim panels.  
To operate the shade:  
1. Grasp the rear edge of the cargo  
shade and pull rearward.  
2. Secure both ends of the support  
rod into the retention slots located  
on the rear quarter trim panels.  
WARNING: Ensure that the posts are properly latched in  
mounting features. The cover may cause injury in a sudden stop  
or accident if it is not securely installed.  
91  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
WARNING: Do not place any objects on the cargo area shade.  
They may obstruct your vision or strike occupants of vehicle in  
the case of a sudden stop or collision.  
ROOF RACK SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)  
Loads should never be placed directly on the roof panel. For proper  
function of the roof rack system, loads must be placed directly on  
crossbars affixed to the roof rack side rails. Your vehicle may be  
equipped with factory-installed crossbars. Ford Genuine Accessory  
crossbars, designed specifically for your vehicle, are also recommended  
for use with your roof rack system.  
The vehicle’s roof panel is NOT designed to directly carry a load. The  
maximum recommended load is 100 lb (45 kg), evenly distributed  
on the crossbars. Ensure that the load is securely fastened. When the  
rail system is loaded, check the tightness of the load, including the  
thumbwheels before driving and at each fuel stop.  
WARNING: When loading the roof rail crossbars, it is  
recommended to evenly distribute the load, as well as maintain a  
low center of gravity. Loaded vehicles, with higher centers of gravity,  
may handle differently than unloaded vehicles. Extra precautions, such  
as slower speeds and increased stopping distance, should be taken  
when driving a heavily loaded vehicle.  
To adjust the cross-bar (if equipped) position:  
1. Loosen the thumbwheel at both  
ends of the cross-bar (both  
cross-bars are adjustable).  
2. Slide the cross-bar to the desired  
location.  
3. Tighten the thumbwheel at both  
ends of the cross-bar.  
92  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
To remove the cross-bar assembly (if equipped) from the roof rack  
side rails:  
1. Loosen the thumbwheel at both  
ends of the cross-bar (both  
cross-bars are adjustable).  
2. Slide the cross-bar to the end of  
the rail.  
3. Use a long, flat object to depress  
the tongue in the endcaps on both  
sides of the cross-bar.  
4. Slide the cross-bar assembly off  
the end of the rail.  
Be sure to check that the thumbwheels are tight each time load is  
added, or removed from the roof rack, and periodically while traveling.  
Always ensure the load is secure before traveling.  
Note: When the cross bars are installed and unloaded, noise can be  
minimized by removing, or re-positioning the cross bars. Position the  
forward cross bar rearward of the center of the roof rail system by 2.5 in  
(63.5 mm) and space the second cross bar 2.5 in (63.5 mm) from the  
forward cross bar.  
93  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
To reinstall the cross-bar assembly (if equipped) to the roof rack  
side rails:  
1. Ensure that both cross-bar  
assemblies are installed with the F  
(front) arrow facing towards the  
front of the vehicle.  
2. Use a long, flat object to press  
the tongue in the endcaps on both  
sides of the cross-bar.  
3. Slide the cross-bar assemblies  
over the end cap tongue and into  
the side rails.  
4. Tighten thumbwheel at both ends  
of the cross-bar.  
94  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Locks and Security  
KEYS  
Your vehicle is equipped with two  
Integrated Keyhead Transmitters  
(IKTs). The key blade functions as a  
programmed key which starts the  
vehicle and unlocks/locks all the  
doors. The transmitter portion  
functions as the remote entry  
transmitter.  
Your IKTs are programmed to your vehicle; using a non-programmed key  
will not permit your vehicle to start. If you lose your authorized dealer  
supplied IKTs, replacement IKTs are available through your authorized  
dealer. Standard SecuriLockkeys without remote entry transmitter  
functionality can also be purchased from your authorized dealer if  
desired.  
Always carry a spare key with you in case of an emergency.  
For more information regarding programming replacement IKTs, refer to  
the SecuriLockpassive anti-theft system section later in this chapter.  
Note: Your vehicle’s IKTs were  
issued with a security label that  
provides important vehicle key cut  
information. It is recommended that  
you keep the label in a safe place  
for future reference.  
95  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
MYKEY™  
The MyKey™ feature allows you to program a restricted driving mode to  
promote good driving habits. All but one of the keys programmed to the  
vehicle can be activated as a MyKey™. The key will remain restricted  
until MyKey™ is cleared. Any remaining keys are referred to as an  
“administrator key” or admin key. The admin key can be used to create a  
MyKey™, program optional MyKey™ settings, and clear the MyKey™  
feature. When the MyKey™ feature is enabled the user can use system  
check in the message center to see how many MyKeys™ and admin keys  
are programmed to the vehicle, and how many total miles have been  
driven with the MyKey™ active.  
MyKey™ restricted features  
Standard settings – These settings cannot be changed  
The audio system will be muted whenever Belt-Minderis activated  
until the safety belts are buckled. Refer to the Seating and Safety  
Restraints chapter for a detailed description of Belt-Minder௡  
operation.  
Low fuel warnings are displayed in the message center followed by a  
chime when the distance to empty value reaches 75 miles (120 km).  
The reverse sensing system cannot be turned off.  
Optional settings – These settings can be changed  
Vehicle speed is limited to 80 mph (130 km/h). Visual warnings are  
displayed followed by a chime when the vehicle speed has reached  
80 mph (130 km/h).  
Visual warnings are displayed followed by a chime when a preselected  
vehicle speed of 45, 55 or 65 mph (75, 90, or 105 km/h) is exceeded  
The maximum volume of the audio system is limited to 45%. MYKEY  
VOLUME LIMITED will be displayed in the radio or (if equipped)  
navigation screen when attempting to exceed the limited volume  
The AdvanceTracsystem cannot be turned off. When this optional  
setting is on, the MyKey™ user will not be able to deactivate the  
system. Note: It may be beneficial to deactivate the AdvanceTrac௡  
system if the vehicle is stuck in snow, mud, or sand.  
96  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
Create a MyKey™  
To program MyKey™ on one of the keys programmed to the vehicle,  
insert the key that you want to make a MyKey™ into the ignition. Turn  
the ignition on. Use the message center buttons to do the following:  
1. Press SETUP until PRESS RESET TO CREATE MYKEY is displayed.  
2. Press and release the RESET button. HOLD RESET TO CONFIRM  
MYKEY will be displayed.  
3. Press and hold the RESET button for two seconds until MARK THIS  
AS RESTRICTED is displayed.  
4. Wait until KEY RESTRICTED AT NEXT START is displayed.  
MyKey™ is successfully programmed. Make sure you label it so you can  
distinguish it from the admin keys. Note: To program the optional  
settings go to Step 2 in the Programming MyKey™ optional settings  
section. If your vehicle is equipped with remote start, see the Using  
MyKey™ with remote start systems section.  
Note: The MyKey™ can be cleared within the same key cycle that it was  
created, otherwise a standard key (administrator key) is required to  
clear the MyKey™ programming. To clear all MyKeys™ go to Step 2 in  
the Clear MyKey™ section.  
Programming MyKey™ optional settings  
Turn the ignition on using an admin key. To program the optional  
settings, use the message center buttons to do the following:  
1. Press SETUP until RESET FOR MYKEY SETTINGS is displayed.  
2. Press and release the RESET button to display MyKey™ setup menus.  
The first menu shown is:  
MYKEY MAX MPH <80 MPH> OFF  
3. If you don’t want to change the maximum speed setting, press the  
SETUP button to display the next menu. The remaining menus appear as  
follows with the default settings shown:  
MYKEY MPH TONES 45 55 65 <OFF>  
MYKEY VOLUME LIMIT <ON> OFF  
MYKEY ADVTRAC CTRL ON <OFF>.  
4. On any of the menus press RESET to highlight your choice with the  
<…>.  
5. Press SETUP to enter your choice. The next optional setting will be  
displayed.  
6. Repeat Steps 4 and 5 until you are done changing the optional  
settings.  
97  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Locks and Security  
Clear MyKey™  
To reset all MyKeys™ as admin keys do the following:  
1. Turn the vehicle on using the admin key.  
2. Press SETUP until PRESS RESET TO CLEAR MYKEY is displayed.  
3. Press and release the RESET button. HOLD RESET TO CONFIRM  
CLEAR is displayed.  
4. Press and hold the RESET button for two seconds until ALL MYKEYS  
CLEARED is displayed.  
Check MyKey™ system status  
The vehicle system check will provide the status of the following  
MyKey™ parameters:  
MYKEY MILES — This odometer only tracks mileage when a MyKey™  
is used. If mileage does not accumulate as expected, then the  
MyKey™ is not being used by the intended user. The only way to  
reset this odometer to zero is by clearing MyKey™. If this odometer is  
lower than the last time you checked, then the MyKey™ system has  
been recently cleared.  
# MYKEY(S) PROGRAMMED — Indicates how many MyKeys™ are  
programmed to the vehicle. Can be used to detect deletion of a  
MyKey™.  
# ADMIN KEYS PROGRAMMED — Indicates how many admin keys  
are programmed to the vehicle. Can be used to detect if an additional  
spare key has been programmed to the vehicle  
Refer to Message center in the Instrument Cluster chapter for MyKey™  
system warnings displays.  
Using MyKey™ with remote start systems  
MyKey™ is not compatible with non-Ford approved aftermarket remote  
start systems. If you choose to install a remote start system please see  
your authorized dealer for a Ford approved remote start system.  
When using a Ford-approved remote start system, the default settings  
will recognize the remote start system as an additional admin key with  
its associated privileges. You should program the remote start system as  
a MyKey™ in addition to the key that you have already programmed as a  
MyKey™. To program the remote start system as MyKey™, do the  
following:  
1. Enter the vehicle and close all doors.  
2. Remote start the vehicle using a remote start fob.  
98  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Locks and Security  
3. Follow Steps 1-4 in the Create a MyKey™ section.  
Note: For all vehicles, the number of MYKEY(S) PROGRAMMED or  
ADMIN KEYS PROGRAMMED that is displayed in the MyKey™ system  
status menus will include the remote start system as an additional key in  
the total count. See the Check MyKey™ system status section.  
Note: For all vehicles with remote start installed, it is possible to  
program all original vehicle keys as MyKeys™, in which case, you will  
need to use your remote start system to reset all MyKeys™ as admin  
keys by doing the following:  
1. Enter the vehicle, close all doors.  
2. Remote start the vehicle using your remote start fob.  
3. Follow Steps 1-4 in the Clear MyKey™ section.  
Troubleshooting  
Condition  
Potential Causes  
Can’t create a MyKey™ Key in the ignition is already a MyKey™  
Key in the ignition is the last remaining  
admin key (there always has to be at least  
one admin key)  
SecuriLockpassive anti-theft system is  
disabled or in unlimited mode  
Vehicle has been started using a remote  
start system that is programmed as MyKey™.  
Refer to Using MyKey™ with remote start  
systems section.  
Cannot program the  
MyKey™ optional  
settings  
Key in the ignition is a MyKey™  
No MyKeys™ are programmed to the  
vehicle. Refer to Create a MyKey™ section  
Vehicle has been started using a remote  
start system that is programmed as MyKey™.  
Refer to Using MyKey™ with remote start  
systems section.  
99  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Locks and Security  
Condition  
Potential Causes  
Cannot clear MyKey™  
Key in the ignition is a MyKey™  
No MyKeys™ are programmed to the  
vehicle. Refer to Create a MyKey™ section  
Vehicle has been started using a remote  
start system that is programmed as MyKey™.  
Refer to Using MyKey™ with remote start  
systems section.  
Lost the only admin key Purchase a new key from your authorized  
dealer  
Lost any key  
For programming spare keys, refer to the  
Programming spare keys section in this  
chapter.  
I accidentally  
Vehicle has a remote start system that is  
programmed all keys as recognized as an admin key. Refer to the  
MyKeys™  
Using MyKey™ with remote start systems  
section to reset all MyKeys™ as admin keys.  
Unknown key has been programmed to the  
vehicle as a MyKey™.  
Vehicle is equipped with a remote start  
system. Refer to Using MyKey™ with  
remote start systems section.  
MyKey™ Programmed  
total includes one  
additional key  
Admin Keys  
Programmed total  
Unknown key has been programmed to the  
vehicle as admin key.  
includes one additional Vehicle is equipped with a remote start  
key  
system. Refer to Using MyKey™ with  
remote start systems section.  
MyKey™ miles do not  
accumulate  
MyKey™ is not being used by the intended  
user.  
MyKey™ system has been recently cleared.  
100  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Locks and Security  
POWER DOOR LOCKS  
Press the  
control to unlock all  
doors.  
Press the  
control to lock all  
doors.  
Door key unlocking/locking  
Unlocking the doors  
Turn the key in the door cylinder to unlock the driver’s door only. All  
other doors will remain locked.  
Locking the doors  
Turn the key in the door cylinder to lock the driver’s door only.  
Autolock  
The autolock feature will lock all the doors, liftgate and liftgate window  
when:  
all doors are closed,  
the ignition is in the on position,  
you shift into any gear putting the vehicle in motion, and  
the vehicle attains a speed greater than 12 mph (20 km/h).  
The autolock feature repeats when:  
any door is opened then closed while the ignition is in the on position  
and the vehicle speed is 9 mph (15 km/h) or lower, and  
the vehicle attains a speed greater than 12 mph (20 km/h).  
Deactivating/activating autolock  
Your vehicle comes with the autolock feature enabled. There are four  
methods to enable/disable this feature:  
Through your authorized dealer, or  
Performing the power door lock control procedure, or  
Performing the keyless entry keypad procedure, or  
Performing the message center procedure.  
101  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
Note: The autolock feature can be activated/deactivated independently  
of the autounlock feature.  
Before following the activation or deactivation procedures, make sure  
that the anti-theft system is not armed, ignition is in the off position, and  
all vehicle doors, liftgate and liftgate window are closed.  
Power door unlock/lock procedure  
You must complete Steps 1-5 within 30 seconds or the procedure will  
have to be repeated. If the procedure needs to be repeated, you must  
wait 30 seconds.  
Note: All doors must be closed and remain closed throughout the  
configuration process.  
1. The ignition must be off to begin  
sequence.  
2. Turn the ignition to the on  
position.  
3. Press the power door unlock  
control three times.  
4. Turn the ignition from the on to  
the off position.  
5. Press the power door unlock control three times.  
6. Turn the ignition back to the on position. The horn will chirp.  
7. Press the unlock control, then press the lock control. The horn will  
chirp once if autolock was deactivated or twice (one short and one long  
chirp) if autolock was activated.  
8. Turn the ignition to the off position. The horn will chirp once to  
confirm the procedure is complete.  
Keyless entry keypad procedure  
1. Turn the ignition to the off position.  
2. Close all doors, the liftgate and liftgate window.  
3. Enter 5–digit entry code  
4. Press and hold the 3 4. While holding the 3 4 press the 7 8.  
5. Release the 7 8.  
6. Release the 3 4.  
The user should receive a horn chirp to indicate the system has been  
disabled or a chirp followed by a honk to indicate the system has been  
enabled.  
102  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Locks and Security  
Message center procedure  
For information on activating/deactivating the autolock feature using the  
vehicle’s message center, refer to Message center information in the  
Instrument Cluster chapter.  
Autounlock  
The autounlock feature will unlock all the doors when:  
the ignition is in the on position, all the doors are closed, and the  
vehicle has been in motion at a speed greater than 12 mph (20 km/h);  
the vehicle has then come to a stop and the ignition is turned to the  
off or accessory position; and  
the driver door is opened within 10 minutes of the ignition being  
transitioned to the off or accessory position.  
Note: The doors will not autounlock if the vehicle has been  
electronically locked before the driver door is opened.  
Deactivating/activating autounlock  
Your vehicle comes with the autounlock feature activated. There are four  
methods to enable/disable this feature:  
Through your authorized dealer, or  
by using the power door unlock/lock sequence,  
Performing the keyless entry keypad procedure (if equipped), or  
Performing the message center procedure.  
Note: The autounlock feature can be activated/deactivated  
independently of the autolock feature.  
Power door lock switch autounlock enable/disable procedure  
Before starting, ensure the ignition is in the off position and all vehicle  
doors are closed. You must complete Steps 1–5 within 30 seconds or the  
procedure will have to be repeated. If the procedure needs to be  
repeated, wait a minimum of 30 seconds before beginning again.  
103  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
1. Place the key in the ignition and  
turn the ignition to the on position.  
2. Press the power door unlock  
control on the door panel three  
times.  
3. Turn the ignition from the on  
position to the off position.  
4. Press the power door unlock control on the door panel three times.  
5. Turn the ignition back to the on position. The horn will chirp one time  
to confirm programming mode has been entered and is active.  
6. To enable/disable the autounlock feature, press the lock control, then  
press the unlock control. The horn will chirp once if autounlock was  
deactivated or twice (one short and one long chirp) if autounlock was  
activated.  
7. Turn the ignition to the off position. The horn will chirp once to  
confirm the procedure is complete.  
Keyless entry keypad autounlock enable/disable procedure  
1. Turn the ignition to the off position.  
2. Close all doors.  
3. Enter factory–set 5–digit entry code.  
4. Press and hold the 3 4. While holding the 3 4, press and release  
the 7 8. While still holding the 3 4, press and release the 7 8 a  
second time.  
5. Release the 3 4.  
The user should receive a horn chirp to indicate the system has been  
disabled or a chirp followed by a honk to indicate the system has been  
enabled.  
Message center procedure  
For information on activating/deactivating the autounlock feature using  
the vehicle’s message center, refer to Message center information in the  
Instrument Cluster chapter.  
Smart unlocking feature  
The smart unlocking feature helps prevent you from locking yourself out  
of the vehicle. With the key in any ignition position, the driver’s door will  
automatically unlock if it is locked using the power lock control on the  
driver’s door panel while the driver’s door is open.  
104  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Locks and Security  
CHILDPROOF DOOR LOCKS  
When these locks are set, the rear  
doors cannot be opened from the  
inside. The rear doors can be  
opened from the outside when the  
childproof door locks are set, but  
the doors are unlocked.  
The childproof locks are located on  
the rear edge of each rear door and  
must be set separately for each  
door.  
Note: Setting the lock for one door  
will not automatically set the lock  
for both doors so you must set each  
child lock on each door separately.  
Insert the key and turn in the direction of arrow shown on the door to  
engage the child proof lock. Turn in the opposite direction to disengage  
childproof locks.  
REMOTE ENTRY SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)  
The Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) complies with part 15 of the  
FCC rules and with RSS-210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to  
the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful  
interference, and (2) This device must accept any interference received,  
including interference that may cause undesired operation.  
Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party  
responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to  
operate the equipment.  
The typical operating range for your IKT is approximately 33 feet  
(10 meters). A decrease in operating range could be caused by:  
weather conditions,  
nearby radio towers,  
structures around the vehicle, or  
other vehicles parked next to your vehicle.  
105  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
The IKT allows you to:  
remotely unlock the vehicle  
doors.  
remotely lock all the vehicle  
doors.  
remotely open the power liftgate  
glass.  
activate the personal alarm.  
operate the illuminated entry  
feature.  
The remote entry lock/unlock  
feature operates in any ignition  
position except while the key is held  
in the start position. The panic  
feature operates with the key in the off position.  
If there are problems with the remote entry system, make sure to take  
ALL Integrated Keyhead Transmitters with you to the authorized  
dealer in order to aid in troubleshooting the problem.  
Two step door unlocking  
1. Press  
and release to unlock the driver’s door. Note: The interior  
lamps will illuminate if the lamp is in the DOOR position.  
2. Press and release again within three seconds to unlock the  
passenger doors, the liftgate and liftgate glass.  
The battery saver feature will turn off the interior lamps 10 minutes after  
the ignition is turned to the off position.  
One step door unlocking  
If the one step door unlocking feature is activated, press  
and release  
once to unlock all of the doors, the liftgate and liftgate glass. Note: The  
interior lamps will illuminate (refer to Illuminated entry information  
later in this section), if the control on the overhead lamp is in the DOOR  
position.  
Switching from two step to one step door unlocking  
Unlocking can be switched between two step and one step door  
unlocking by pressing and holding both  
and  
buttons  
simultaneously on the remote entry transmitter for approximately  
106  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
4 seconds. The turn signal will flash twice to indicate that the vehicle has  
switched to one step unlocking. Repeat the procedure to switch back to  
two step unlocking.  
Locking the doors  
1. Press  
and release to lock all the doors. Assuming all vehicle doors  
and the liftgate are properly closed and the parking lamps will flash  
once.  
2. Press  
and release again within three seconds to confirm that all  
the doors and liftgate are closed and locked. Note: The doors will lock  
again and the horn will chirp once.  
If any of the doors or the hood are not properly closed, the horn will  
chirp twice and parking lamps will not flash when the  
pressed.  
control is  
Opening the liftgate glass (if equipped)  
Press  
twice within three seconds to open the liftgate glass.  
Car finder  
Press  
twice within three seconds. The horn will chirp and the turn  
lamps will flash. It is recommended that this method be used to locate  
your vehicle, rather than using the panic alarm.  
Sounding a panic alarm  
Press  
to activate the alarm. To deactivate the feature, press the  
control again, turn the ignition to the on or start position, or wait for the  
alarm to time out in approximately three minutes.  
Note: The panic alarm will only operate when the ignition is in the off  
position.  
Replacing the battery  
The integrated keyhead transmitter uses one coin type three-volt lithium  
battery CR2032 or equivalent.  
107  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
To replace the battery:  
1. Twist a thin coin in the slot of the  
IKT near the key ring in order to  
remove the battery cover.  
Note: Do not wipe off any grease on  
the battery terminals on the back  
surface of the circuit board.  
2. Remove the old battery.  
Note: Please refer to local  
regulations when disposing of  
transmitter batteries.  
3. Insert the new battery. Refer to  
the instructions inside the IKT for  
the correct orientation of the  
battery. Press the battery down to  
ensure that the battery is fully  
seated in the battery housing cavity.  
4. Snap the battery cover back onto  
the key.  
Note: Replacement of the battery will not cause the IKT to become  
deprogrammed from your vehicle. The IKT should operate normally after  
battery replacement.  
Replacing lost Integrated Keyhead Transmitters (IKTs)  
If you would like to have your Integrated Keyhead Transmitters  
reprogrammed because you lost one, or would like to buy additional  
IKTs, you can either reprogram them yourself, or take all IKTs to your  
authorized dealer for reprogramming.  
How to reprogram your Integrated Keyhead Transmitters (IKTs)  
To program a new Integrated Keyhead Transmitter yourself, refer to  
Programming spare keys in the SecuriLockpassive anti-theft section  
of this chapter. Note: At least two IKTs are required to perform this  
procedure yourself.  
Illuminated entry  
The interior lamps, parking lamps and puddle lamps (if equipped)  
illuminate when the Integrated Keyhead Transmitter or the keyless entry  
system keypad is used to unlock the door(s).  
108  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
The illuminated entry system will turn off the lights if:  
the ignition is turned to the on position, or  
the integrated keyhead transmitter lock control is pressed, or  
the vehicle is locked using the keyless entry keypad (if equipped), or  
after 25 seconds of illumination.  
The lights will not turn off if:  
they have been turned on with the dimmer control, or  
any door is open.  
Illuminated exit  
The lamps will illuminate when the key is removed from the ignition.  
The lamps automatically turn off after 25 seconds. The dome and cargo  
lamp controls must not be set to the off position for the illuminated exit  
system to operate.  
SECURICODE™ KEYLESS ENTRY SYSTEM  
You can use the keyless entry keypad to:  
lock or unlock the doors without using a key,  
activate or deactivate the Autolock and Autounlock feature if  
equipped  
release the liftgate glass,  
The keypad can be operated with the factory set 5–digit entry code; this  
code is located on the owner’s wallet card in the glove box and is  
available from your authorized dealer. You can also create your own  
5–digit personal entry code.  
When pressing the controls on the keyless entry keypad, press the  
middle of the controls to ensure a good activation.  
Programming your own personal entry code  
To create your own personal entry code:  
1. Enter the factory set code.  
109  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
2. Within five seconds press the 1 2 on the keypad. The doors will lock  
and then unlock to confirm that the system is in programming mode.  
3. Enter your personal 5–digit code.  
Each number must be entered  
within five seconds of each other.  
4. Press 1 2 on the keypad to  
assign the Driver 1 setting. The  
doors will lock and then unlock to confirm that your personal entry code  
has been programmed.  
You can store up to three personal entry codes. The above procedure  
shows how to set the Driver 1 setting. To assign the additional settings,  
repeat Steps 1 through 3, then for Step 4, do one of the following:  
Press 3 4 to assign the Driver 2 setting.  
Press 5 6, 7 8, or 9 0 to assign the Driver 3 setting.  
Tips  
Do not use five numbers in sequential order.  
The factory set code will work even if you have set your own personal  
code.  
Erasing personal code  
1. Enter the factory set 5–digit code.  
2. Within five seconds, press the 1 2 on the keypad and release.  
3. Press and hold the 1 2 for two seconds. This must be done within  
five seconds of completing Step 2.  
Your personal code is now erased and only the factory set 5–digit code  
will work.  
Anti-scan feature  
If the wrong code has been entered seven times (35 consecutive button  
presses), the keypad will go into an anti-scan mode. This mode disables  
the keypad for one minute and the keypad lamp will flash.  
The anti-scan feature will turn off after:  
one minute of keypad inactivity,  
pressing the  
control on the remote entry transmitter,  
or the ignition position changes.  
Unlocking and locking the doors and liftgate using keyless entry  
To unlock the driver’s door, enter the factory set 5-digit code or your  
personal code. Each number must be pressed within five seconds of each  
other. The interior lamps will illuminate.  
110  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
To unlock all doors and liftgate, press the 3 4 control within five  
seconds of entering the factory set 5-digit code or your personal code.  
To lock all doors and liftgate, press the 7 8 and the 9 0 at the  
same time. Note: The driver’s door must be closed. You do not need to  
enter the keypad code first.  
To open the liftgate glass, press the 5 6 after entering the factory  
set 5-digit code or your personal code.  
SECURILOCKPASSIVE ANTI-THEFT SYSTEM  
SecuriLockpassive anti-theft system is an engine immobilization  
system. This system is designed to help prevent the engine from being  
started unless a coded integrated keyhead transmitter (IKT)  
programmed to your vehicle is used. The use of the wrong type of  
coded key may lead to a “no-start” condition.  
Your vehicle comes with two coded integrated keyhead transmitters;  
additional coded IKTs may be purchased from your authorized dealer.  
Standard SecuriLockkeys without remote entry transmitter  
functionality can also be purchased from your authorized dealer if  
desired. The authorized dealer can program your spare IKTs to your  
vehicle or you can program the IKTs yourself. Refer to Programming  
spare keys for instructions on how to program the coded key.  
Note: The SecuriLockpassive anti-theft system is not compatible with  
non-Ford aftermarket remote start systems. Use of these systems may  
result in vehicle starting problems and a loss of security protection.  
Note: Large metallic objects, electronic devices that are used to  
purchase gasoline or similar items, or a second coded key on the same  
key chain may cause vehicle starting issues. You need to prevent these  
objects from touching the coded IKT while starting the engine. These  
objects will not cause damage to the coded IKT, but may cause a  
momentary issue if they are too close to the IKT when starting the  
engine. If a problem occurs, turn the ignition off, remove all objects on  
the key chain away from the coded IKT and restart the engine.  
Note: Do not leave a duplicate coded key in the vehicle. Always  
take your keys and lock all doors when leaving the vehicle.  
111  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
Anti-theft indicator  
The anti-theft indicator is located in the instrument panel cluster.  
When the ignition is in the off  
position, the indicator will flash  
once every two seconds to  
indicate the SecuriLocksystem  
is functioning as a theft  
deterrent.  
When the ignition is in the on position, the indicator will glow for  
three seconds to indicate normal system functionality.  
If a problem occurs with the SecuriLocksystem, the indicator will flash  
rapidly or glow steadily when the ignition is in the on position. If this  
occurs, turn the ignition off then back to on to make sure there was no  
electronic interference with the programmed key. If the vehicle doesn’t  
start, try to start it with the 2nd programmed key and if successful  
contact your authorized dealership for key replacement. If the indicator  
still flashes rapidly or glows steadily, the vehicle will not start, contact  
your authorized dealer as soon as possible for service.  
Automatic arming  
The vehicle is armed immediately after switching the ignition to the off  
position.  
The theft indicator will flash every  
two seconds to act as a theft  
deterrent when the vehicle is  
armed.  
Automatic disarming  
The vehicle is disarmed immediately after the ignition is turned to the on  
position.  
The theft indicator will illuminate for three seconds and then go out. If  
the theft indicator stays on for an extended period of time or flashes  
rapidly, contact your authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
Replacement of integrated keyhead transmitters (IKT) and coded  
keys  
Note: Your vehicle comes equipped with two integrated keyhead  
transmitters (IKTs). The IKT functions as both a programmed ignition  
key that operates all the locks and starts the vehicle, as well as a remote  
112  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
keyless entry transmitter. A maximum of eight coded keys can be  
programmed to your vehicle; only four of these eight keys can be IKTs  
with remote entry functionality.  
If your IKTs or standard SecuriLockcoded keys are lost or stolen and  
you don’t have an extra coded key, you will need to have your vehicle  
towed to an authorized dealer. The key codes need to be erased from  
your vehicle and new coded keys will need to be programmed.  
Replacing coded keys can be very costly. Store an extra programmed key  
away from the vehicle in a safe place to help prevent any  
inconveniences. Please visit an authorized dealer to purchase additional  
spare or replacement keys.  
Programming spare keys  
You can program your own integrated keyhead transmitters or standard  
SecuriLockcoded keys to your vehicle. This procedure will program  
both the engine immobilizer keycode and the remote entry transmitter  
portion of the IKT to your vehicle. Note: A maximum of eight coded  
keys can be programmed to your vehicle; only four of these eight can be  
IKTs with remote entry functionality.  
Tips:  
Only use integrated keyhead transmitters (IKTs) or standard  
SecuriLockkeys.  
You must have two previously programmed coded keys (keys that  
already operate your vehicle’s engine) and the new unprogrammed  
key(s) readily accessible.  
If two previously programmed coded keys are not available, you must  
take your vehicle to your authorized dealer to have the spare key(s)  
programmed.  
Please read and understand the  
entire procedure before you begin.  
1. Insert the first previously  
programmed coded key into the  
ignition.  
2. Turn the ignition from the 1 (off)  
position to the 3 (on) position. Keep  
the ignition in the 3 (on) position  
for at least three seconds, but no  
more than 10 seconds.  
3. Turn the ignition to the 1 (off) position and remove the first coded  
key from the ignition.  
113  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Locks and Security  
4. After three seconds but within 10 seconds of turning the ignition to  
the 1 (off) position, insert the second previously coded key into the  
ignition.  
5. Turn the ignition from the 1 (off) position to the 3 (on) position. Keep  
the ignition in the 3 (on) position for at least three seconds, but no more  
than 10 seconds.  
6. Turn the ignition to the 1 (off) position and remove the second  
previously programmed coded key from the ignition.  
7. After three seconds but within 20 seconds of turning the ignition to  
the 1 (off) position and removing the previously programmed coded  
key, insert the new unprogrammed key (new key/valet key) into the  
ignition.  
8. Turn the ignition from the 1 (off) position to the 3 (on) position. Keep  
the ignition in the 3 (on) position for at least six seconds.  
9. Remove the newly programmed coded key from the ignition.  
If the key has been successfully programmed it will start the vehicle’s  
engine and will operate the remote entry system (if the new key is an  
integrated keyhead transmitter). The theft indicator light will illuminate  
for three seconds and then go out to indicate successful programming.  
If the key was not successfully programmed, it will not start your  
vehicle’s engine and/or will not operate the remote entry features. The  
theft indicator light may flash on and off. Wait 20 seconds and you may  
repeat Steps 1 through 8. If failure repeats, bring your vehicle to your  
authorized dealer to have the new key(s) programmed.  
To program additional new unprogrammed key(s), wait 20 seconds and  
then repeat this procedure from Step 1.  
Note: To program MyKey™ features, refer to MyKey™ in this chapter.  
114  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
FRONT SEATS  
WARNING: Reclining the seatback can cause an occupant to  
slide under the seat’s safety belt, resulting in severe personal  
injuries in the event of a collision.  
WARNING: Do not pile cargo higher than the seatbacks to  
reduce the risk of injury in a collision or sudden stop.  
WARNING: Before returning the seatback to its original  
position, make sure that cargo or any objects are not trapped  
behind the seatback. After returning the seatback to its original  
position, pull on the seatback to ensure that it has fully latched. An  
unlatched seat may become dangerous in the event of a sudden stop or  
collision.  
Adjustable head restraints  
Your vehicle is equipped with front row outboard head restraints that are  
vertically adjustable.  
WARNING: To minimize the risk of neck injury in the event of a  
crash, the driver and passenger occupants should not sit in  
and/or operate the vehicle, until the head restraint is placed in its  
proper position. The driver should never adjust the head restraint  
while the vehicle is in motion.  
The adjustable head restraints  
consist of:  
a trimmed energy absorbing foam  
and structure (1),  
two steel stems (2),  
a guide sleeve adjust/release  
button (3),  
and a guide sleeve unlock/remove  
button (4).  
115  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
To adjust the head restraint, do the following:  
1. Adjust the seatback to an upright driving/riding position.  
2. Raise the head restraint by  
pulling up on the head restraint.  
3. Lower the head restraint by  
pressing and holding the guide  
sleeve adjust/release button and  
pushing down on the head restraint.  
Properly adjust the head restraint so that the top of the head restraint is  
even with the top of your head and positioned as close as possible to the  
back of your head. For occupants of extremely tall stature, adjust the  
head restraint to its full up position.  
WARNING: The adjustable head restraint is a safety device.  
Whenever possible it should be installed and properly adjusted  
when the seat is occupied.  
116  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
To remove the adjustable head restraint, do the following:  
1. Pull up the head restraint until it  
reaches the highest adjustment  
position.  
2. Simultaneously press and hold  
both the adjust/release button and  
the unlock/remove button, then pull  
up on the head restraint.  
To reinstall the adjustable head restraint, do the following:  
1. Insert the two stems into the  
guide sleeve collars.  
2. Push the head restraint down  
until it locks.  
Properly adjust the head restraint so that the top of the head restraint is  
even with the top of your head and positioned as close as possible to the  
back of your head. For occupants of extremely tall stature, adjust the  
head restraint to its full up position.  
117  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: To minimize the risk of neck injury in the event of a  
crash, head restraints must be installed properly.  
Adjusting the front manual seat (if equipped)  
Lift handle to move seat forward or  
backward.  
Pull lever up to adjust seatback.  
Adjusting the front power seat (if equipped)  
WARNING: Never adjust the driver’s seat or seatback when the  
vehicle is moving.  
WARNING: Do not pile cargo higher than the seatbacks to avoid  
injuring people in a collision or sudden stop.  
WARNING: Always drive and ride with your seatback upright  
and the lap belt snug and low across the hips.  
118  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: Reclining the seatback can cause an occupant to  
slide under the seat’s safety belt, resulting in severe personal  
injuries in the event of a collision.  
WARNING: Sitting improperly out of position or with the seat  
back reclined too far can take off weight from the seat cushion  
and affect the decision of the passenger sensing system, resulting in  
serious injury or death in a crash. Always sit upright against your  
seatback, with your feet on the floor.  
WARNING: To reduce the risk of possible serious injury: Do not  
hang objects off seat back or stow objects in the seatback map  
pocket (if equipped) when a child is in the front passenger seat. Do  
not place objects underneath the front passenger seat or between the  
seat and the center console (if equipped). Check the “passenger airbag  
off” or “pass airbag off” indicator lamp for proper airbag status. Refer  
to Front passenger sensing system in the Airbag supplemental  
restraint system (SRS) section for additional details. Failure to follow  
these instructions may interfere with the front passenger seat sensing  
system.  
The control is located on the outboard side of the seat cushion.  
Press to raise or lower the front  
portion of the seat cushion.  
Press to raise or lower the rear  
portion of the seat cushion.  
119  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Press the control to move the seat  
forward, backward, up or down.  
Heated seats (if equipped)  
WARNING: Persons who are unable to feel pain to the skin  
because of advanced age, chronic illness, diabetes, spinal cord  
injury, medication, alcohol use, exhaustion, or other physical  
conditions, must exercise care when using the seat heater. The seat  
heater may cause burns even at low temperatures, especially if used  
for long periods of time. Do not place anything on the seat that  
insulates against heat, such as a blanket or cushion, because this may  
cause the seat heater to overheat. Do not puncture the seat with pins,  
needles, or other pointed objects because this may damage the heating  
element which may cause the seat heater to overheat. An overheated  
seat may cause serious personal injury.  
Note: Do not do the following:  
Place heavy objects on the seat  
Operate the seat heater if water or any other liquid is spilled on the  
seat. Allow the seat to dry thoroughly.  
To operate the heated seats:  
Press the button located on the  
instrument panel to activate.  
Press again to deactivate.  
The heated seats will activate when the ignition is in the on position.  
REAR SEATS  
Second row adjustable head restraints  
Your vehicle is equipped with second row outboard and center head  
restraints that are vertically adjustable.  
120  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: To minimize the risk of neck injury in the event of a  
crash, the driver and passenger occupants should not sit in  
and/or operate the vehicle, until the head restraint is placed in its  
proper position. The driver should never adjust the head restraint  
while the vehicle is in motion.  
The adjustable head restraints  
consist of :  
a trimmed energy absorbing foam  
and structure (1),  
two steel stems (2),  
a guide sleeve adjust/remove  
button (3),  
To adjust the head restraint, do the following:  
1. Adjust the seatback to an upright driving/riding position.  
2. Raise the head restraint by  
pulling up on the head restraint.  
3. Lower the head restraint by  
pressing and holding the guide  
sleeve adjust/remove button and  
pushing down on the head restraint.  
121  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Properly adjust the head restraint so that the top of the head restraint is  
even with the top of your head and positioned as close as possible to the  
back of your head. For occupants of extremely tall stature, adjust the  
head restraint to its full up position.  
WARNING: The adjustable head restraint is a safety device.  
Whenever possible it should be installed and properly adjusted  
when the seat is occupied.  
To remove the adjustable head restraint, do the following:  
1. Pull up the head restraint until it  
reaches the highest adjustment  
position.  
2. Press and hold the adjust/remove  
button, then pull up on the head  
restraint.  
122  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
To reinstall the adjustable head restraint, do the following:  
1. Insert the two stems into the  
guide sleeve collars.  
2. Push the head restraint down  
until it locks.  
Properly adjust the head restraint so that the top of the head restraint is  
even with the top of your head and positioned as close as possible to the  
back of your head. For occupants of extremely tall stature, adjust the  
head restraint to its full up position.  
WARNING: To minimize the risk of neck injury in the event of a  
crash, head restraints must be installed properly.  
Folding down second row seats  
1. Remove the second row head restraint. See Second row adjustable  
head restraints in this chapter.  
Note: Place the head restraint underneath the back of the front seat  
for storage.  
2. Pull the seat release strap.  
Note: Make sure the floor is clear of all objects before folding the seat.  
123  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
3. Flip seat forward.  
Attach the safety belt web snap  
button to the quarter trim panel  
snap button. This will ensure that  
safety belt does not get caught by  
staying out of the seat back folding  
path.  
4. To release seatback, pull the  
seatback release lever (on top of  
seat) toward the front seat. This is  
common for both 60% and 40%  
seatbacks.  
Note: When the seatback release  
lever is pulled, slowly lower  
seatback to the flat position.  
124  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
5. Rotate seatback down into load  
floor position.  
Returning the second row seats to upright position  
1. Pull seatback up and into upright  
position making sure seatback locks  
into place and the red seat  
unlatched indicator on release  
paddle is not visible.  
2. Rotate seat cushion down into the  
seating position making sure that  
the seat cushion is locked into place  
and that the safety belt buckles are  
exposed.  
125  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: Make sure safety belt buckle heads are through  
elastic holders on seat backs. Safety belt buckles may break if  
they are trapped underneath the seatback as the seatback is rotated  
down.  
WARNING: Before returning the seatback to its original  
position, make sure that cargo or any objects are not trapped  
behind the seatback. After returning the seatback to its original  
position, reinstall the head restraints, and pull on the seatback to  
ensure that it has fully latched. An unlatched seat may become  
dangerous in the event of a sudden stop or collision.  
3. Unsnap the safety belt webbing from the quarter trim panel.  
4. Remove the second row head restraint from underneath the front seat  
and reinstall. See Second row adjustable head restraints in this  
chapter.  
To remove the second row cushion  
1. Lift the yellow tab to release the  
hinges.  
2. Pull the cushion to the outboard  
side of the vehicle.  
126  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
To install the second row cushion  
1. Push the cushion to the inboard  
side of the vehicle.  
2. Make sure that the hinges are  
locked into place.  
SAFETY RESTRAINTS  
Personal Safety System™  
The Personal Safety System provides an improved overall level of frontal  
crash protection to front seat occupants and is designed to help further  
reduce the risk of airbag-related injuries. The system is able to analyze  
different occupant conditions and crash severity before activating the  
appropriate safety devices to help better protect a range of occupants in  
a variety of frontal crash situations.  
Your vehicle’s Personal Safety System consists of:  
Driver and passenger dual-stage airbag supplemental restraints.  
Front safety belts with pretensioners, energy management retractors,  
and safety belt usage sensors.  
Driver’s seat position sensor  
Front passenger sensing system  
“Passenger airbag off” or “pass airbag off” indicator lamp  
Front crash severity sensor.  
Restraints Control Module (RCM) with impact and safing sensors.  
Restraint system warning light and back-up tone.  
The electrical wiring for the airbags, crash sensor(s), safety belt  
pretensioners, front safety belt usage sensors, driver seat position  
sensor, front passenger sensing system, and indicator lights.  
127  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
How does the Personal Safety System™ work?  
The Personal Safety System can adapt the deployment strategy of your  
vehicle’s safety devices according to crash severity and occupant  
conditions. A collection of crash and occupant sensors provides  
information to the Restraints control module (RCM). During a crash, the  
RCM may activate the safety belt pretensioners and/or either one or both  
stages of the dual-stage airbag supplemental restraints based on crash  
severity and occupant conditions.  
The fact that the pretensioners or airbags did not activate for both front  
seat occupants in a collision does not mean that something is wrong with  
the system. Rather, it means the Personal Safety System determined the  
accident conditions (crash severity, belt usage, etc.) were not  
appropriate to activate these safety devices. Front airbags are designed  
to activate only in frontal and near-frontal collisions (not rollovers, side  
impacts or rear impacts) unless the collision causes sufficient  
longitudinal deceleration. The pretensioners are designed to activate in  
frontal, and in side collisions and rollovers.  
Driver and passenger dual-stage airbag supplemental restraints  
The dual-stage airbags offer the capability to tailor the level of airbag  
inflation energy. A lower, less forceful energy level is provided for more  
common, moderate-severity impacts. A higher energy level is used for  
the most severe impacts. Refer to Airbag supplemental restraints  
section in this chapter.  
Front crash severity sensor  
The front crash severity sensor enhances the ability to detect the  
severity of an impact. Positioned up front, it provides valuable  
information early in the crash event on the severity of the impact. This  
allows your Personal Safety System to distinguish between different  
levels of crash severity and modify the deployment strategy of the  
dual-stage airbags and safety belt pretensioners.  
Driver’s seat position sensor  
The driver’s seat position sensor allows your Personal Safety System to  
tailor the deployment level of the driver dual-stage airbag based on seat  
position. The system is designed to help protect smaller drivers sitting  
close to the driver airbag by providing a lower airbag output level.  
128  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Front passenger sensing system  
For airbags to do their job they must inflate with great force, and this  
force can pose a potentially deadly risk to occupants that are very close  
to the airbag when it begins to inflate. For some occupants, like infants  
in rear-facing child seats, this occurs because they are initially sitting  
very close to the airbag. For other occupants, this occurs when the  
occupant is not properly restrained by safety belts or child safety seats  
and they move forward during pre-crash braking. The most effective way  
to reduce the risk of unnecessary injuries is to make sure all occupants  
are properly restrained. Accident statistics suggest that children are  
much safer when properly restrained in the rear seating positions than in  
the front.  
WARNING: Air bags can kill or injure a child in a child seat.  
NEVER place a rear-facing child seat in front of an active air  
bag. If you must use a forward-facing child seat in the front seat, move  
the seat all the way back.  
WARNING: When possible, all children 12 years old and under  
should be properly restrained in a rear seating position.  
The front passenger sensing system can automatically turn off the  
passenger front airbag. The system is designed to help protect small  
(child size) occupants from airbag deployments when they are  
improperly seated or restrained in the front passenger seat contrary to  
proper child-seating or restraint usage recommendations. Even with this  
technology, parents are STRONGLY encouraged to always properly  
restrain children in the rear seat. The sensor also turns off the passenger  
front airbag and passenger seat-mounted side airbag when the passenger  
seat is empty.  
When the front passenger seat is occupied and the sensing system has  
turned off the passenger’s frontal airbag, the “pass airbag off” indicator  
will light and stay lit to remind you that the front passenger frontal  
airbag is off. See Front passenger sensing system in the airbags section  
of this chapter.  
Front safety belt usage sensors  
The front safety belt usage sensors detect whether or not the driver and  
front outboard passenger safety belts are fastened. This information  
allows your Personal Safety System to tailor the airbag deployment and  
safety belt pretensioner activation depending upon safety belt usage.  
Refer to Safety restraints section in this chapter.  
129  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Front safety belt pretensioners  
The safety belt pretensioners at the front outboard seating positions are  
designed to tighten the safety belts firmly against the occupant’s body  
during frontal collisions, and in side collisions and rollovers. This helps  
increase the effectiveness of the safety belts. In frontal collisions, the  
safety belt pretensioners can be activated alone or, if the collision is of  
sufficient severity, together with the front airbags.  
Safety belt energy management retractors  
The front and rear outboard safety belt energy management retractors  
allow webbing to be pulled out of the retractor in a gradual and  
controlled manner in response to the occupant’s forward momentum.  
This helps reduce the risk of force-related injuries to the occupant’s  
chest by limiting the load on the occupant. Refer to Energy  
management feature in this chapter.  
Determining if the Personal Safety System is operational  
The Personal Safety System uses a warning light in the instrument  
cluster or a back-up tone to indicate the condition of the system. Refer  
to the Warning lights and chimes section in the Instrument Cluster  
chapter. Routine maintenance of the Personal Safety System is not  
required.  
The restraints control module (RCM) monitors its own internal circuits  
and the circuits for the airbag supplemental restraints, crash sensor(s),  
safety belt pretensioners, front safety belt buckle sensors, driver seat  
position sensor, and front passenger sensing system. In addition, the  
RCM also monitors the restraints warning light in the instrument cluster.  
A difficulty with the system is indicated by one or more of the following.  
The warning light will either flash or stay lit.  
The warning light will not illuminate immediately after ignition is  
turned on.  
A series of five beeps will be heard. The tone pattern will repeat  
periodically until the problem and warning light are repaired.  
If any of these things happen, even intermittently, have the Personal  
Safety System serviced at an authorized dealer immediately. Unless  
serviced, the system may not function properly in the event of a  
collision.  
130  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Safety restraints precautions  
WARNING: Always drive and ride with your seatback upright  
and the lap belt snug and low across the hips.  
WARNING: To reduce the risk of injury, make sure children sit  
where they can be properly restrained.  
WARNING: Never let a passenger hold a child on his or her lap  
while the vehicle is moving. The passenger cannot protect the  
child from injury in a collision.  
WARNING: All occupants of the vehicle, including the driver,  
should always properly wear their safety belts, even when an  
airbag supplemental restraint system (SRS) is provided.  
WARNING: It is extremely dangerous to ride in a cargo area,  
inside or outside of a vehicle. In a collision, people riding in  
these areas are more likely to be seriously injured or killed. Do not  
allow people to ride in any area of your vehicle that is not equipped  
with seats and safety belts. Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a  
seat and using a safety belt properly.  
WARNING: In a rollover crash, an unbelted person is  
significantly more likely to die than a person wearing a safety  
belt.  
WARNING: Each seating position in your vehicle has a specific  
safety belt assembly which is made up of one buckle and one  
tongue that are designed to be used as a pair. 1) Use the shoulder belt  
on the outside shoulder only. Never wear the shoulder belt under the  
arm. 2) Never swing the safety belt around your neck over the inside  
shoulder. 3) Never use a single belt for more than one person.  
WARNING: When possible, all children 12 years old and under  
should be properly restrained in a rear seating position.  
131  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: Safety belts and seats can become hot in a vehicle  
that has been closed up in sunny weather; they could burn a  
small child. Check seat covers and buckles before you place a child  
anywhere near them.  
Combination lap and shoulder belts  
1. Insert the belt tongue into the  
proper buckle (the buckle closest to  
the direction the tongue is coming  
from) until you hear a snap and feel  
it latch. Make sure the tongue is  
securely fastened in the buckle.  
2. To unfasten, press the release  
button and remove the tongue from  
the buckle.  
Restraint of pregnant women  
WARNING: Always ride and drive with your seatback upright  
and the safety belt properly fastened. The lap portion of the  
safety belt should fit snug and be positioned low across the hips. The  
shoulder portion of the safety belt should be positioned across the  
chest. Pregnant women should also follow this practice. See figure  
below.  
132  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Pregnant women should always  
wear their safety belt. The lap belt  
portion of a combination lap and  
shoulder belt should be positioned  
low across the hips below the belly  
and worn as tight as comfort will  
allow. The shoulder belt should be  
positioned to cross the middle of  
the shoulder and the center of the  
chest.  
Energy Management Feature  
This vehicle has a safety belt system with an energy management  
feature at the front and rear outboard seating positions to help further  
reduce the risk of injury in the event of a head-on collision.  
The front and rear outboard safety belt system has a retractor  
assembly that is designed to extend the safety belt webbing in a  
controlled manner. This helps reduce the belt force acting on the  
user’s chest.  
Safety belt locking modes  
All safety restraints in the vehicle are combination lap and shoulder  
belts. The driver safety belt has the first locking mode and the front  
outboard passenger and rear seat safety belts have both types of locking  
modes described as follows:  
Vehicle sensitive mode  
This is the normal retractor mode, which allows free shoulder belt length  
adjustment to your movements and locking in response to vehicle  
movement. For example, if the driver brakes suddenly or turns a corner  
sharply, or the vehicle receives an impact of approximately 5 mph  
(8 km/h) or more, the combination safety belts will lock to help reduce  
forward movement of the driver and passengers.  
In addition, the retractor is designed to lock if the webbing is pulled out  
too quickly. If this occurs, let the belt retract slightly and pull webbing  
out again in a slow and controlled manner.  
Automatic locking mode  
In this mode, the shoulder belt is automatically pre-locked. The belt will  
still retract to remove any slack in the shoulder belt. The automatic  
locking mode is not available on the driver safety belt.  
133  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
When to use the automatic locking mode  
This mode should be used any time a child safety seat, except a  
booster, is installed in passenger front or rear seating positions. Children  
12 years old and under should be properly restrained in a rear seating  
position whenever possible. Refer to Safety restraints for children or  
Safety seats for children later in this chapter.  
How to use the automatic locking mode  
Buckle the combination lap and  
shoulder belt.  
Grasp the shoulder portion and  
pull downward until the entire  
belt is pulled out.  
Allow the belt to retract. As the belt retracts, you will hear a clicking  
sound. This indicates the safety belt is now in the automatic locking  
mode.  
How to disengage the automatic locking mode  
Disconnect the combination lap/shoulder belt and allow it to retract  
completely to disengage the automatic locking mode and activate the  
vehicle sensitive (emergency) locking mode.  
134  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: After any vehicle collision, the safety belt system at  
all passenger seating positions must be checked by an authorized  
dealer to verify that the “automatic locking retractor” feature for child  
seats is still functioning properly. In addition, all safety belts should be  
checked for proper function.  
WARNING: BELT AND RETRACTOR ASSEMBLY MUST BE  
REPLACED if the safety belt assembly “automatic locking  
retractor” feature or any other safety belt function is not operating  
properly when checked by an authorized dealer. Failure to replace the  
belt and retractor assembly could increase the risk of injury in  
collisions.  
Safety belt height adjustment  
Your vehicle has safety belt height  
adjustments at the front outboard  
seating positions. Adjust the height  
of the shoulder belt so the belt rests  
across the middle of your shoulder.  
To adjust the shoulder belt height,  
squeeze and hold the buttons on the  
side and slide the height adjuster up  
or down. Release the buttons and  
pull down on the height adjuster to  
make sure it is locked in place.  
WARNING: Position the safety belt height adjusters so that the  
belt rests across the middle of your shoulder. Failure to adjust  
the safety belt properly could reduce the effectiveness of the safety  
belt and increase the risk of injury in a collision.  
Safety belt pretensioner  
Your vehicle is equipped with safety belt pretensioners at the driver and  
front passenger seating positions.  
The safety belt pretensioners activate during frontal collisions, and in  
side collisions and rollovers. A safety belt pretensioner is a device which  
tightens the webbing of the lap and shoulder belts in such a way that  
they fit more snugly against the body.  
135  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: The driver and front passenger safety belt system  
(including retractors, buckles and height adjusters) must be  
replaced if the vehicle is involved in a collision that results in  
deployment of front airbags, seat-mounted side airbags and Safety  
CanopySystem and safety belt pretensioners.  
WARNING: Failure to replace the safety belt assembly under  
the above conditions could result in severe personal injuries in  
the event of a collision.  
Safety belt extension assembly  
If the safety belt is too short when fully extended, a 9 inch (23 cm) or  
12 inch (31 cm) safety belt extension assembly can be added (part  
numbers 611C22–A and 611C22–B respectively). These assemblies can  
be obtained from an authorized dealer.  
Use only extensions manufactured by the same supplier as the safety  
belt. Manufacturer identification is located at the end of the webbing on  
the label. Also, use the safety belt extension only if the safety belt is too  
short for you when fully extended.  
WARNING: Do not use extensions to change the fit of the  
shoulder belt across the torso.  
Safety belt warning light and indicator chime  
The safety belt warning light illuminates in the instrument cluster and a  
chime sounds to remind the occupants to fasten their safety belts.  
136  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Conditions of operation  
If...  
Then...  
The driver’s safety belt is not  
buckled before the ignition  
switch is turned to the on  
position...  
The safety belt warning light  
illuminates 1 minute and the warning  
chime sounds 6 seconds.  
The driver’s safety belt is  
buckled while the indicator  
light is illuminated and the  
warning chime is sounding...  
The driver’s safety belt is  
buckled before the ignition  
switch is turned to the on  
position...  
The safety belt warning light and  
warning chime turn off.  
The safety belt warning light and  
indicator chime remain off.  
Belt-Minderா  
The Belt-Minderfeature is a supplemental warning to the safety belt  
warning function. This feature provides additional reminders by  
intermittently sounding a chime and illuminating the safety belt warning  
lamp in the instrument cluster when the driver’s and front passenger’s  
safety belt is unbuckled.  
The Belt-Minderfeature uses information from the front passenger  
sensing system to determine if a front seat passenger is present and  
therefore potentially in need of a warning. To avoid activating the  
Belt-Minderfeature for objects placed in the front passenger seat,  
warnings will only be given to large front seat occupants as determined  
by the front passenger sensing system.  
Both the driver’s and passenger’s safety belt usages are monitored and  
either may activate the Belt-Minderfeature. The warnings are the same  
for the driver and the front passenger. If the Belt-Minderwarnings have  
expired (warnings for approximately five minutes) for one occupant  
(driver or front passenger), the other occupant can still activate the  
Belt-Minderfeature.  
Note: If you are using MyKey™, the Belt-Minderwarning will not  
expire. Refer to MyKey™ in the Locks and security chapter.  
137  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
If...  
Then...  
The driver’s and front  
The Belt-Minderfeature will not  
passenger’s safety belts are  
buckled before the ignition  
switch is turned to the on  
position or less than  
activate.  
1-2 minutes have elapsed since  
the ignition switch has been  
turned to on...  
The driver’s or front  
The Belt-Minderfeature is activated  
- the safety belt warning light  
illuminates and the warning chime  
sounds for six seconds every  
passenger’s safety belt is not  
buckled when the vehicle has  
reached at least 3 mph  
(5 km/h) and 1-2 minutes have 30 seconds, repeating for  
elapsed since the ignition  
approximately five minutes or until  
switch has been turned to on... the safety belts are buckled.  
The driver’s or front  
The Belt-Minderfeature is activated  
passenger’s safety belt becomes - the safety belt warning light  
unbuckled for approximately  
1 minute while the vehicle is  
traveling at least 3 mph  
illuminates and the warning chime  
sounds for six seconds every  
30 seconds, repeating for  
(5 km/h) and more than  
approximately five minutes or until  
1-2 minutes have elapsed since the safety belts are buckled.  
the ignition switch has been  
turned to on...  
138  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
The following are reasons most often given for not wearing safety belts  
(All statistics based on U.S. data):  
Reasons given...  
Consider...  
ЉCrashes are rare  
eventsЉ  
36700 crashes occur every day. The more we  
drive, the more we are exposed to ЉrareЉ events,  
even for good drivers. 1 in 4 of us will be  
seriously injured in a crash during our  
lifetime.  
ЉI’m not going farЉ  
3 of 4 fatal crashes occur within 25 miles  
(40 km) of home.  
ЉBelts are  
uncomfortableЉ  
Your Ford safety belts are designed to enhance  
comfort. If you are uncomfortable - try different  
positions for the safety belt upper anchorage and  
seatback which should be as upright as possible;  
this can improve comfort.  
ЉI was in a hurryЉ  
Prime time for an accident. Belt-Minder௡  
reminds us to take a few seconds to buckle up.  
ЉSafety belts don’t  
workЉ  
Safety belts, when used properly, reduce risk  
of death to front seat occupants by 45% in  
cars, and by 60% in light trucks.  
ЉTraffic is lightЉ  
Nearly 1 of 2 deaths occur in single-vehicle  
crashes, many when no other vehicles are  
around.  
ЉBelts wrinkle my  
clothesЉ  
Possibly, but a serious crash can do much more  
than wrinkle your clothes, particularly if you are  
unbelted.  
ЉThe people I’m with Set the example, teen deaths occur 4 times more  
don’t wear beltsЉ  
ЉI have an airbagЉ  
often in vehicles with TWO or MORE people.  
Children and younger brothers/sisters imitate  
behavior they see.  
Airbags offer greater protection when used with  
safety belts. Frontal airbags are not designed to  
inflate in rear and side crashes or rollovers.  
ЉI’d rather be thrown Not a good idea. People who are ejected are  
clearЉ  
40 times more likely to DIE. Safety belts help  
prevent ejection, WE CAN’T ЉPICK OUR  
CRASHЉ.  
139  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: Do not sit on top of a buckled safety belt or insert a  
latchplate into the buckle to avoid the Belt-Minderchime. To  
do so may adversely affect the performance of the vehicle’s air bag  
system.  
Deactivating/activating the Belt-Minderfeature  
The driver and front passenger Belt-Minderare  
deactivated/activated independently. When deactivating/activating  
one seating position, do not buckle the other position as this will  
terminate the process.  
Read Steps 1 - 4 thoroughly before proceeding with the  
deactivation/activation programming procedure.  
Note: If you are using MyKey™, the Belt-Mindercannot be disabled.  
Also, if the Belt-Minderhas been previously disabled, it will be  
re-enabled after the use of MyKey™. Refer to MyKey™ in the Locks  
and security chapter.  
The driver and front passenger Belt-Minderfeatures can be  
deactivated/activated by performing the following procedure:  
Before following the procedure, make sure that:  
The parking brake is set  
The gearshift is in P (Park)  
The ignition switch is in the off position  
The driver and front passenger safety belts are unbuckled  
WARNING: While the design allows you to deactivate your  
Belt-Minder, this system is designed to improve your chances of  
being safely belted and surviving an accident. We recommend you  
leave the Belt-Mindersystem activated for yourself and others who  
may use the vehicle. To reduce the risk of injury, do not  
deactivate/activate the Belt-Minderfeature.  
140  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
1. Turn the ignition switch to the on position. DO NOT START THE  
ENGINE.  
2. Wait until the safety belt warning light turns off (Approximately  
1 minute).  
Step 3 must be completed within 30 seconds after the safety belt  
warning light turns off.  
3. For the seating position being disabled, buckle then unbuckle the  
safety belt three times at a moderate speed, ending in the unbuckled  
state.  
After Step 3, the safety belt warning light will be turned on for three  
seconds.  
4. Within approximately seven seconds of the light turning off, buckle  
then unbuckle the safety belt.  
This will disable the Belt-Minderfeature for that seating position if it  
is currently enabled. As confirmation, the safety belt warning light will  
flash four times per second for three seconds.  
This will enable the Belt-Minderfeature for that seating position if it  
is currently disabled. As confirmation, the safety belt warning light will  
flash four times per second for three seconds, followed by three  
seconds with the light off, then followed by the safety belt warning  
light flashing four times per second for three seconds again.  
After receiving confirmation, the deactivation/activation procedure is  
complete.  
141  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
AIRBAG SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS)  
4X4  
Important SRS precautions  
The SRS is designed to work with  
the safety belt to help protect the  
driver and right front passenger  
from certain upper body injuries.  
Airbags DO NOT inflate slowly;  
there is a risk of injury from a  
deploying airbag.  
142  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: All occupants of the vehicle, including the driver,  
should always properly wear their safety belts, even when an air  
bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) is provided.  
WARNING: When possible, all children 12 years old and under  
should be properly restrained in a rear seating position.  
WARNING: The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration  
(NHTSA) recommends a minimum distance of at least 10 inches  
(25 cm) between an occupant’s chest and the driver airbag module.  
WARNING: Never place your arm over the airbag module as a  
deploying airbag can result in serious arm fractures or other  
injuries.  
To properly position yourself away from the airbag:  
Move your seat to the rear as far as you can while still reaching the  
pedals comfortably.  
Recline the seat slightly one or two degrees from the upright position.  
WARNING: Do not put anything on or over the airbag module.  
Placing objects on or over the airbag inflation area may cause  
those objects to be propelled by the airbag into your face and torso  
causing serious injury.  
WARNING: Do not attempt to service, repair, or modify the  
airbag supplemental restraint systems or its fuses. Contact your  
authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
WARNING: Modifications to the front end of the vehicle,  
including frame, bumper, front end body structure, tow hooks  
and B-pillar surrounding parts may affect the performance of the  
airbag sensors increasing the risk of injury. Do not modify the front  
end of the vehicle.  
WARNING: Additional equipment may affect the performance of  
the airbag sensors increasing the risk of injury.  
143  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Children and airbags  
Children must always be properly  
restrained. Accident statistics  
suggest that children are safer when  
properly restrained in the rear  
seating positions than in the front  
seating position. Failure to follow  
these instructions may increase the  
risk of injury in a collision.  
WARNING: Airbags can kill  
or injure a child in a child  
seat. NEVER place a rear-facing  
child seat in front of an active  
airbag. If you must use a  
forward-facing child seat in the  
front seat, move the seat all the  
way back.  
How does the airbag supplemental restraint system work?  
The airbag SRS is designed to  
activate when the vehicle sustains a  
longitudinal deceleration sufficient  
to cause the airbag sensors to close  
an electrical circuit that initiates  
airbag inflation. The fact that the  
airbags did not inflate in a collision  
does not mean that something is  
wrong with the system. Rather, it  
means the forces were not sufficient  
enough to cause activation. Front  
airbags are designed to inflate in  
frontal and near-frontal collisions, not rollover, side-impact, or  
rear-impacts unless the collision causes sufficient longitudinal  
deceleration.  
144  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
The airbags inflate and deflate  
rapidly upon activation. After airbag  
deployment, it is normal to notice a  
smoke-like, powdery residue or  
smell the burnt propellant. This may  
consist of cornstarch, talcum  
powder or sodium compounds which  
may irritate the skin and eyes, but  
none of the residue is toxic.  
While the SRS is designed to help  
reduce serious injuries, contact with  
a deploying airbag may also cause  
abrasions, swelling or temporary  
hearing loss. Because airbags must  
inflate rapidly and with considerable  
force, there is the risk of death or  
serious injuries such as fractures, facial and eye injuries or internal  
injuries, particularly to occupants who are not properly restrained or are  
otherwise out of position at the time of airbag deployment. It is  
extremely important that occupants be properly restrained as far away  
from the airbag module as possible while maintaining vehicle control.  
The SRS consists of:  
driver and passenger airbag modules (which include the inflators and  
airbags).  
seat-mounted side airbags. Refer to Seat-mounted side airbag system  
later in this chapter  
Safety CanopySystem. Refer to Safety CanopySystem later in this  
chapter.  
one or more impact and safing sensors.  
Safety belt pretensioners  
a readiness light and tone.  
diagnostic module.  
and the electrical wiring which connects the components.  
Front passenger sensing system. Refer to Front passenger sensing  
system later in this chapter.  
“Passenger airbag off” or “pass airbag off” indicator lamp. Refer to  
Front passenger sensing system later in this chapter.  
The RCM (restraints control module) monitors its own internal circuits  
and the supplemental airbag electrical system wiring (including the  
145  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
impact sensors, the system wiring, the airbag system readiness light, the  
airbag backup power and the airbag ignitors).  
WARNING: Several air bag system components get hot after  
inflation. Do not touch them after inflation.  
WARNING: If the airbag has deployed, the airbag will not  
function again and must be replaced immediately. If the  
airbag is not replaced, the unrepaired area will increase the risk of  
injury in a collision.  
Front passenger sensing system  
The front passenger sensing system is designed to meet the regulatory  
requirements of Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard (FMVSS) 208  
and is designed to disable (will not inflate) the front passenger’s frontal  
airbag under certain conditions.  
The front passenger sensing system works with sensors that are part of  
the front passenger’s seat and safety belt. The sensors are designed to  
detect the presence of a properly seated occupant and determine if the  
front passenger’s frontal airbag should be enabled (may inflate) or  
disabled (will not inflate).  
The front passenger sensing system will disable (will not inflate) the  
front passenger’s frontal airbag if:  
the front passenger seat is unoccupied, or has small/medium objects in  
the front seat,  
the system determines that an infant is present in a rear-facing infant  
seat that is installed according to the manufacturer’s instructions,  
the system determines that a small child is present in a forward-facing  
child restraint that is installed according to the manufacturer’s  
instructions,  
the system determines that a small child is present in a booster seat,  
a front passenger takes his/her weight off of the seat for a period of  
time,  
Note: When the passenger airbag off light is illuminated, the passenger  
(seat mounted) side airbag may be disabled to avoid the risk of airbag  
deployment injuries.  
146  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
The front passenger sensing system  
uses a Љpassenger airbag offЉ or  
Љpass airbag offЉ indicator which will  
illuminate and stay lit to remind you  
that the front passenger frontal airbag is off. The indicator lamp is  
located in the center stack of the instrument panel just above the air  
vents.  
Note: The indicator lamp will illuminate for a short period of time when  
the ignition is turned to the on position to confirm it is functional.  
When the front passenger seat is not occupied (empty seat) or in the  
event that the front passenger frontal airbag is enabled (may inflate), the  
indicator lamp will be unlit.  
The front passenger sensing system is designed to disable (will not  
inflate) the front passenger’s frontal airbag when a rear facing infant  
seat, a forward-facing child restraint, or a booster seat is detected.  
When the front passenger sensing system disables (will not inflate)  
the front passenger frontal airbag, the indicator lamp will illuminate  
and stay lit to remind you that the front passenger frontal airbag is  
disabled.  
If the child restraint has been installed and the indicator lamp is not  
lit, then turn the vehicle off, remove the child restraint from the  
vehicle and reinstall the restraint following the child restraint  
manufacturer’s instructions.  
The front passenger sensing system is designed to enable (may inflate)  
the front passenger’s frontal airbag anytime the system senses that a  
person of adult size is sitting properly in the front passenger seat.  
When the front passenger sensing system enables the front passenger  
frontal airbag (may inflate), the indicator will be unlit and stay unlit.  
If a person of adult size is sitting in the front passenger’s seat, but the  
Љpassenger airbag offЉ or Љpass airbag offЉ indicator lamp is lit, it is  
possible that the person isn’t sitting properly in the seat. If this happens:  
Turn the vehicle off and ask the person to place the seatback in the  
full upright position.  
Have the person sit upright in the seat, centered on the seat cushion,  
with the person’s legs comfortably extended.  
Restart the vehicle and have the person remain in this position for  
about two minutes. This will allow the system to detect that person  
and enable the passenger’s frontal airbag.  
147  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
If the indicator lamp remains lit even after this, the person should be  
advised to ride in the rear seat.  
Pass Airbag Off  
Indicator Lamp  
Occupant  
Passenger Airbag  
Empty seat  
Small child in child  
safety seat or booster  
Unlit  
Lit  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Small child with safety Lit  
belt buckled or  
unbuckled  
Disabled  
Enabled  
Adult  
Unlit  
WARNING: Even with Advanced Restraints Systems, children  
12 and under should be properly restrained in a rear seating  
position.  
After all occupants have adjusted their seats and put on safety belts, it’s  
very important that they continue to sit properly. A properly seated  
occupant sits upright, leaning against the seat back, and centered on the  
seat cushion, with their feet comfortably extended on the floor. Sitting  
improperly can increase the chance of injury in a crash event. For  
example, if an occupant slouches, lies down, turns sideways, sits forward,  
leans forward or sideways, or puts one or both feet up, the chance of  
injury during a crash is greatly increased.  
WARNING: Sitting improperly out of position or with the seat  
back reclined too far can take off weight from the seat cushion  
and affect the decision of the front passenger sensing system, resulting  
in serious injury or death in a crash.  
Always sit upright against your seatback, with your feet on the floor.  
The front passenger sensing system may detect small or medium objects  
placed on the seat cushion. For most objects that are in the front  
passenger seat, the passenger airbag will be disabled. Even though the  
passenger airbag is disabled, the Љpass airbag offЉ lamp may or may not  
be illuminated according to the table below.  
148  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Pass Airbag Off  
Passenger Airbag  
Indicator Lamp  
Objects  
Small (i.e. three-ring  
binder, small purse,  
bottled water)  
Medium (i.e. heavy  
briefcase, fully packed  
luggage)  
Empty seat, or small  
to medium object with  
safety belt buckled  
Unlit  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Lit  
Lit  
If you think that the status of the passenger airbag off indicator lamp is  
incorrect, check for the following:  
Objects lodged underneath the seat  
Objects between the seat cushion and the center console (if  
equipped)  
Objects hanging off the seat back  
Objects stowed in the seatback map pocket (if equipped)  
Objects placed on the occupant’s lap  
Cargo interference with the seat  
Other passengers pushing or pulling on the seat  
Rear passenger feet and knees resting or pushing on the seat  
The conditions listed above may cause the weight of a properly seated  
occupant to be incorrectly interpreted by the front passenger sensing  
system. The person in the front passenger seat may appear heavier or  
lighter due to the conditions described in the list above.  
WARNING: To reduce the risk of possible serious injury:  
Do not stow objects in seat back map pocket (if equipped) or  
hang objects off seat back if a child is in the front passenger seat.  
Do not place objects underneath the front passenger seat or between  
the seat and the center console (if equipped).  
Check the “passenger airbag off” or “pass airbag off” indicator lamp for  
proper airbag Status.  
Failure to follow these instructions may interfere with the front  
passenger seat sensing system.  
149  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
In case there is a problem with the  
front passenger sensing system, the  
airbag readiness lamp in the  
instrument cluster will stay lit.  
If the airbag readiness lamp is lit, do the following:  
The driver and/or adult passengers should check for any objects that  
may be lodged underneath the front passenger seat or cargo interfering  
with the seat.  
If objects are lodged and/or cargo is interfering with the seat; please take  
the following steps to remove the obstruction:  
Pull the vehicle over.  
Turn the vehicle off.  
Driver and/or adult passengers should check for any objects lodged  
underneath the front passenger seat or cargo interfering with the seat.  
Remove the obstruction(s) (if found).  
Restart the vehicle.  
Wait at least two minutes and verify that the airbag readiness lamp is  
no longer illuminated  
If the airbag readiness lamp remains illuminated, this may or may/not  
be a problem due to the front passenger sensing system.  
DO NOT attempt to repair or service the system; take your vehicle  
immediately to an authorized dealer.  
If it is necessary to modify an advanced front airbag system to  
accommodate a person with disabilities, contact the Ford Customer  
Relationship Center at the phone number shown in the Customer  
Assistance chapter of this Owner’s Guide.  
WARNING: Any alteration/modification to the front passenger  
seat may affect the performance of the front passenger sensing  
system.  
Determining if the system is operational  
The SRS uses a readiness light in the instrument cluster or a tone to  
indicate the status of the system. Refer to Airbag readiness section in  
the Instrument Cluster chapter. Routine maintenance of the airbag is  
not required.  
150  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
A difficulty with the system is indicated by one or more of the following:  
The readiness light will either  
flash or stay lit.  
The readiness light will not  
illuminate immediately after  
ignition is turned on.  
A series of five beeps will be heard. The tone pattern will repeat  
periodically until the problem and/or light are repaired.  
If any of these things happen, even intermittently, have the SRS serviced  
at an authorized dealer immediately. Unless serviced, the system may not  
function properly in the event of a collision.  
Seat-mounted side airbag system  
WARNING: Do not place objects or mount equipment on or  
near the airbag cover on the side of the seatbacks of the front  
seats or in front seat areas that may come into contact with a  
deploying airbag. Failure to follow these instructions may increase the  
risk of personal injury in the event of a collision.  
WARNING: Do not use accessory seat covers. The use of  
accessory seat covers may prevent the deployment of the side  
airbags and increase the risk of injury in an accident.  
WARNING: Do not lean your head on the door. The side airbag  
could injure you as it deploys from the side of the seatback.  
WARNING: Do not attempt to service, repair, or modify the  
airbag SRS, its fuses or the seat cover on a seat containing an  
airbag. See an authorized dealer.  
WARNING: All occupants of the vehicle should always wear  
their safety belts even when an airbag SRS is provided.  
151  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
How does the side airbag system work?  
The design and development of the  
side airbag system included  
recommended testing procedures  
that were developed by a group of  
automotive safety experts known as  
the Side Airbag Technical Working  
Group. These recommended testing  
procedures help reduce the risk of  
injuries related to the deployment of  
side airbags.  
The side airbag system consists of  
the following:  
An inflatable bag (airbag) with a  
gas generator concealed behind  
the outboard bolster of the driver  
and front passenger seatbacks.  
A special seat cover designed to  
allow airbag deployment.  
The same warning light, electronic control and diagnostic unit as used  
for the front airbags.  
Two crash sensors located on the lower portion of the b-pillar (one on  
each side of the vehicle).  
Side airbags, in combination with safety belts, can help reduce the risk of  
severe injuries in the event of a significant side impact collision.  
The side airbags are fitted on the outboard side of the seatbacks of the  
front seats. In certain lateral collisions, the airbag on the side affected by  
the collision will be inflated. The airbag was designed to inflate between  
the door panel and occupant to further enhance the protection provided  
occupants in side impact collisions.  
The airbag SRS is designed to activate when the vehicle sustains lateral  
deceleration sufficient to cause the sensors to close an electrical circuit  
that initiates airbag inflation.  
The fact that the airbags did not inflate in a collision does not mean that  
something is wrong with the system. Rather, it means the forces were  
not of the type sufficient to cause activation. Side airbags are designed  
to inflate in side-impact collisions, not roll-over, rear-impact, frontal or  
near-frontal collisions, unless the collision causes sufficient lateral  
deceleration.  
152  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: Several airbag system components get hot after  
inflation. Do not touch them after inflation.  
WARNING: If the side  
airbag has deployed, the  
airbag will not function again.  
The side airbag system  
(including the seat) must be  
inspected and serviced by an  
authorized dealer. If the airbag  
is not replaced, the unrepaired  
area will increase the risk of injury  
in a collision.  
Determining if the system is operational  
The SRS uses a readiness light in the instrument cluster or a tone to  
indicate the condition of the system. Refer to Warning lights and  
chimes in the Instrument Cluster chapter. Routine maintenance of the  
side airbag is not required.  
A difficulty with the system is indicated by one or more of the following:  
The readiness light (same light as for front airbag system) will either  
flash or stay lit.  
The readiness light will not illuminate immediately after ignition is  
turned on.  
A series of five beeps will be heard. The tone pattern will repeat  
periodically until the problem and/or light are repaired.  
If any of these things happen, even intermittently, have the SRS serviced  
at your authorized dealer immediately. Unless serviced, the system may  
not function properly in the event of a collision.  
153  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Safety CanopySystem  
WARNING: Do not place  
objects or mount equipment  
on or near the headliner at the  
siderail that may come into  
contact with a deploying Safety  
Canopy. Failure to follow these  
instructions may increase the risk  
of personal injury in the event of a  
collision.  
WARNING: Do not lean your head on the door. The Safety  
Canopycould injure you as it deploys from the headliner.  
WARNING: Do not attempt to service, repair, or modify the  
Safety CanopySystem, its fuses, the A, B, or C pillar trim, or  
the headliner on a vehicle containing a Safety Canopy. Contact your  
authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
WARNING: All occupants of the vehicle including the driver  
should always wear their safety belts even when an airbag SRS  
and Safety CanopySystem is provided.  
WARNING: To reduce risk of injury, do not obstruct or place  
objects in the deployment path of the inflatable Safety Canopy.  
154  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
How does the Safety CanopySystem work?  
The design and development of the  
Safety Canopy System included  
recommended testing procedures  
that were developed by a group of  
automotive safety experts known as  
the Side Airbag Technical Working  
Group. These recommended testing  
procedures help reduce the risk of  
injuries related to the deployment of  
side airbags (including the Safety  
Canopy).  
The Safety Canopy System consists  
of the following:  
An inflatable curtain with a gas  
generator concealed behind the  
headliner and above the doors  
(one on each side of vehicle).  
A headliner designed to flex open  
above the side doors to allow safety canopy deployment.  
The same warning light, electronic control and diagnostic unit as used  
for the front airbags.  
Two crash sensors mounted at lower B-Pillar (one on each side).  
Two crash sensors located at the C-pillar behind the rear doors (one  
on each side).  
Rollover sensor in the restraints control module (RCM).  
The Safety Canopy System, in combination with safety belts, can help  
reduce the risk of severe injuries in the event of a significant side impact  
collision or rollover event.  
Children 12 years old and under should always be properly restrained in  
the second or third row seats. The safety canopy will not interfere with  
children restrained using a properly installed child or booster seat  
because it is designed to inflate downward from the headliner above the  
doors along the side window opening.  
155  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
The Safety Canopy System is designed to active when the vehicle  
sustains lateral deceleration sufficient to cause the RCM to initiate safety  
canopy inflation or when a certain likelihood of a rollover event is  
detected by the rollover sensor.  
The safety canopy is mounted to roof side-rail sheet metal, behind the  
headliner, above the first and second row seats. The safety canopy is  
designed to inflate between the side window area and occupants to  
further enhance protection provided in side impact collisions and rollover  
events.  
The fact that the safety canopy did not activate in a collision does not  
mean that something is wrong with the system. Rather, it means the  
forces were not of the type sufficient to cause activation. The safety  
canopy is designed to inflate in certain side impact collisions or rollover  
events, not in rear impact, frontal or near-frontal collisions, unless the  
collision causes sufficient lateral deceleration or rollover likelihood.  
WARNING: Several Safety  
Canopy System components  
get hot after inflation. Do not  
touch them after inflation.  
WARNING: If the Safety Canopy System has deployed, the  
safety canopy will not function again unless replaced. The Safety  
Canopy System (including the A, B, C, and D pillar trim and headliner)  
must be inspected and serviced by an authorized dealer. If the safety  
canopy is not replaced, it will not function again, which will increase  
the risk of injury in a future collision.  
Determining if the system is operational  
The SRS uses a readiness light in the instrument cluster or a tone to  
indicate the condition of the system. Refer to Warning lights and  
chimes in the Instrument Cluster chapter. Routine maintenance of the  
side airbag is not required.  
156  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
A difficulty with the system is indicated by one or more of the following:  
The readiness light (same light as for front airbag system) will either  
flash or stay lit.  
The readiness light will not illuminate immediately after ignition is  
turned on.  
A series of five beeps will be heard. The tone pattern will repeat  
periodically until the problem and/or light are repaired.  
If any of these things happen, even intermittently, have the SRS serviced  
at your authorized dealer immediately. Unless serviced, the system may  
not function properly in the event of a collision.  
SOS Post-Crash Alert System™  
The system automatically flashes the turn signal lamps and sounds the  
horn three times at four second intervals in the event of a serious impact  
that deploys an airbag (front, side, side curtain or Safety Canopy) or  
the safety belt pretensioners.  
The system can be turned off when any one of the following actions are  
taken by the driver or any other person:  
pressing the hazard control button,  
or pressing the panic button on the remote entry transmitter.  
The feature will continue to operate until the vehicle runs out of power.  
Disposal of airbags and airbag equipped vehicles  
(including pretensioners)  
Contact your authorized dealer as soon as possible. Airbags MUST BE  
disposed of by qualified personnel.  
SAFETY RESTRAINTS FOR CHILDREN  
See the following sections for directions on how to properly use safety  
restraints for children. Also see Airbag supplemental restraint system  
(SRS) in this chapter for special instructions about using airbags.  
157  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Important child restraint precautions  
WARNING: Always make sure your child is secured properly in  
a device that is appropriate for their height, age and weight.  
Child safety restraints must be purchased separately from the vehicle.  
Failure to follow these instructions and guidelines may result in an  
increased risk of serious injury or death to your child.  
WARNING: All children are shaped differently. The  
Recommendations for Safety Restraints are based on probable  
child height, age and weight thresholds from NHTSA and other safety  
organizations or are the minimum requirements of law. Ford  
recommends checking with a NHTSA Certified Child Passenger Safety  
Technician (CPST) and consult your pediatrician to make sure your  
child seat is appropriate for your child, and is compatible with and  
properly installed in the vehicle. To locate a child seat fitting station  
and CPST contact the NHTSA toll free at 1-888-327-4236 or on the  
internet at http://www.nhtsa.dot.gov. In Canada, check with your local  
St. John Ambulance office for referral to a CPST or for further  
information, contact your provincial ministry of transportation, your  
local St. John Ambulance office at http://www.sfa.ca, or Transport  
Canada at 1–800–333–0371 (http://www.tc.gc.ca). Failure to properly  
restrain children in safety seats made especially for their height, age,  
and weight may result in an increased risk of serious injury or death to  
your child.  
158  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Recommendations for Safety Restraints for Children  
Recommended  
Child size, height, weight, or age  
restraint type  
Infants Children weighing 40 lb (18 kg) or less  
or tod- (generally age four or younger)  
dlers  
Use a child safety  
seat (sometimes  
called an infant  
carrier, convertible  
seat, or toddler  
seat).  
Small  
chil-  
dren  
Children who have outgrown or no longer Use a belt-  
properly fit in a child safety seat (gener- positioning booster  
ally children who are less than 4 feet  
9 inches (1.45 meters) tall, are greater  
than age four (4) and less than age  
twelve (12), and between 40 lb (18 kg)  
and 80 lb (36 kg) and upward to 100 lb  
(45 kg) if recommended by your child  
restraint manufacturer)  
seat.  
Larger Children who have outgrown or no longer Use a vehicle  
chil-  
dren  
properly fit in a belt-positioning booster  
safety belt having  
seat (generally children who are at least the lap belt snug  
4 feet 9 inches (1.45 meters) tall or  
greater than 80 lb (36 kg) or 100 lb  
(45 kg) if recommended by child re-  
straint manufacturer)  
and low across the  
hips, shoulder belt  
centered across  
the shoulder and  
chest, and seat-  
back upright.  
You are required by law to properly use safety seats for infants and  
toddlers in the U.S. and Canada.  
Many states and provinces require that small children use approved  
booster seats until they reach age eight, a height of 4 ft 9 in.  
(1.45 meters) tall, or 80 lb (36 kg). Check your local and state or  
provincial laws for specific requirements regarding the safety of  
children in your vehicle.  
When possible, always properly restrain children twelve (12) years of  
age and under in a rear seating position of your vehicle. Accident  
statistics suggest that children are safer when properly restrained in  
the rear seating positions than in a front seating position.  
159  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Recommendations for attaching child safety restraints for children  
Use any attachment method as indicated  
below by “X”  
LATCH LATCH Safety Safety  
(lower (lower belt belt and belt  
anchors anchors and  
Safety  
Restraint Child  
LATCH  
(lower  
only  
Type  
Weight  
and  
only)  
top  
top  
tether  
anchor)  
tether anchors  
anchor and top  
tether  
anchor)  
Rear  
facing  
Up to  
48 lb  
X
X
child seat (21 kg)  
Forward Up to  
facing  
child seat (21 kg)  
Forward Over  
facing  
48 lb  
X
X
X
X
X
48 lb  
child seat (21 kg)  
WARNING: Airbags can kill or injure a child in a child seat.  
NEVER place a rear-facing child seat in front of an active airbag.  
If you must use a forward-facing child seat in the front seat, move the  
vehicle seat all the way back. When possible, all children age 12 and  
under should be properly restrained in a rear seating position. If all  
children cannot be seated and restrained properly in a rear seating  
position, properly restrain the largest child in the front seat.  
160  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: Always carefully follow the instructions and  
warnings provided by the manufacturer of any child restraint to  
determine if the restraint device is appropriate for your child’s size,  
height, weight, or age. Follow the child restraint manufacturer’s  
instructions and warnings provided for installation and use in  
conjunction with the instructions and warnings provided by the vehicle  
manufacturer. A safety seat that is improperly installed or utilized, is  
inappropriate for your child’s height, age, or weight or does not  
properly fit the child may increase the risk of serious injury or death.  
WARNING: Never let a passenger hold a child on his or her lap  
while the vehicle is moving. The passenger cannot protect the  
child from injury in a collision, which may result in serious injury or  
death.  
WARNING: Never use pillows, books, or towels to boost a child.  
They can slide around and increase the likelihood of injury or  
death in a collision.  
WARNING: Always restrain an unoccupied child seat or booster  
seat. These objects may become projectiles in a collision or  
sudden stop, which may increase the risk of serious injury.  
WARNING: Never place, or allow a child to place, the shoulder  
belt under a child’s arm or behind the back because it reduces  
the protection for the upper part of the body and may increase the risk  
of injury or death in a collision.  
WARNING: Do not leave children, unreliable adults, or pets  
unattended in your vehicle.  
Transporting children  
Always make sure your child is secured properly in a device that is  
appropriate for their age, height and weight. All children are shaped  
differently. The child height, age and weight thresholds provided are  
recommendations or the minimum requirements of law. The National  
Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) provides education and  
161  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
training to ensure that all children ages 0 to 16 are properly restrained in  
the correct restraint system. Ford recommends checking with a NHTSA  
Certified Child Passenger Safety Technician (CPST) and your  
pediatrician to make sure your seat is appropriate for your child and  
properly installed in the vehicle. To locate a child seat fitting station and  
CPST contact the NHTSA toll free at 1-888-327-4236 or on the internet  
at http://www.nhtsa.dot.gov. In Canada, check with your local St. John  
Ambulance office for referral to a CPST or for further information,  
contact your provincial ministry of transportation, your local St. John  
Ambulance office at http://www.sfa.ca, or Transport Canada at  
1–800–333–0371 (http://www.tc.gc.ca).  
Follow all the safety restraint and airbag precautions that apply to adult  
passengers in your vehicle.  
If the child is the proper height, age, and weight (as specified by your  
child safety seat or booster manufacturer), fits the restraint and can be  
restrained properly, then restrain the child in the child safety seat or  
with the belt-positioning booster. Remember that child seats and  
belt-positioning boosters vary and may be designed to fit children of  
different heights, ages and weights. Children who are too large for child  
safety seats or belt-positioning boosters (as specified by your child safety  
seat manufacturer) should always properly wear safety belts.  
SAFETY SEATS FOR CHILDREN  
Infant and/or toddler seats  
Use a safety seat that is recommended for the size and weight of the  
child.  
When installing a child safety seat:  
Review and follow the information  
presented in the Airbag  
supplemental restraint system  
(SRS) section in this chapter.  
Carefully follow all of the  
manufacturer’s instructions  
included with the safety seat you  
put in your vehicle. If you do not  
install and use the safety seat  
properly, the child may be injured  
in a sudden stop or collision.  
162  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Airbags can kill or injure a child in a child seat. NEVER place a  
rear-facing child seat in front of an active airbag. If you must use a  
forward-facing child seat in the front seat, move the vehicle seat all the  
way back.  
Children 12 and under should be properly restrained in a rear seating  
position whenever possible. If all children cannot be seated and  
restrained properly in a rear seating position, properly restrain the  
largest child in the front seat.  
Installing child safety seats with combination lap and shoulder  
belts  
The rear seat head restraints must be removed when using a child  
seat that utilizes the top tether anchor.  
Check to make sure the child seat is properly secured before each use.  
Children 12 and under should be properly restrained in a rear seating  
position whenever possible. If all children cannot be seated and  
restrained properly in a rear seating position, properly restrain the  
largest child in the front seat.  
When installing a child safety seat with combination lap/shoulder belts:  
Use the correct safety belt buckle for that seating position.  
Insert the belt tongue into the proper buckle until you hear a snap  
and feel it latch. Make sure the tongue is securely fastened in the  
buckle.  
Keep the buckle release button pointing up and away from the safety  
seat, with the tongue between the child seat and the release button,  
to help prevent accidental unbuckling.  
Place vehicle seat back in upright position.  
Put the safety belt in the automatic locking mode. Refer to step 5  
below. This vehicle does not require the use of a locking clip.  
WARNING: Depending on where you secure a child restraint,  
and depending on the child restraint design, you may block  
access to certain safety belt buckle assemblies and/or LATCH lower  
anchors, rendering those features potentially unusable. To avoid risk of  
injury, occupants should only use seating positions where they are able  
to be properly restrained.  
163  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Perform the following steps when installing the child seat with  
combination lap/shoulder belts:  
Note: Although the child seat illustrated is a forward facing child seat,  
the steps are the same for installing a rear facing child seat.  
1. Position the child safety seat in a  
seat with a combination lap and  
shoulder belt.  
2. Pull down on the shoulder belt  
and then grasp the shoulder belt  
and lap belt together.  
164  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
3. While holding the shoulder and  
lap belt portions together, route the  
tongue through the child seat  
according to the child seat  
manufacturer’s instructions. Be sure  
the belt webbing is not twisted.  
4. Insert the belt tongue into the  
proper buckle (the buckle closest to  
the direction the tongue is coming  
from) for that seating position until  
you hear a snap and feel the latch  
engage. Make sure the tongue is  
latched securely by pulling on it.  
5. To put the retractor in the  
automatic locking mode, grasp the  
shoulder portion of the belt and pull  
downward until all of the belt is  
pulled out.  
6. Allow the belt to retract to remove slack. The belt will click as it  
retracts to indicate it is in the automatic locking mode.  
7. Try to pull the belt out of the retractor to make sure the retractor is  
in the automatic locking mode (you should not be able to pull more belt  
out). If the retractor is not locked, repeat Steps 5 and 6.  
165  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
8. Remove remaining slack from the  
belt. Force the seat down with extra  
weight, e.g., by pressing down or  
kneeling on the child restraint while  
pulling up on the shoulder belt in  
order to force slack from the belt.  
This is necessary to remove the  
remaining slack that will exist once  
the additional weight of the child is  
added to the child restraint. It also  
helps to achieve the proper  
snugness of the child seat to the  
vehicle. Sometimes, a slight lean  
towards the buckle will additionally  
help to remove remaining slack from the belt.  
9. Attach the tether strap (if the  
child seat is equipped). Refer to  
Attaching child safety seats with  
tether straps later in this chapter.  
10. Before placing the child in the  
seat, forcibly move the seat forward  
and back to make sure the seat is  
securely held in place. To check  
this, grab the seat at the belt path  
and attempt to move it side to side  
and forward and back. There should  
be no more than 1 inch (2.5 cm) of movement for proper installation.  
11. Ford recommends checking with a NHTSA Certified Child Passenger  
Safety Technician (CPST) to make certain the child restraint is properly  
installed. In Canada, check with your local St. John Ambulance office for  
referral to a CPST.  
Attaching child safety seats with LATCH (Lower Anchors and  
Tethers for CHildren) attachments  
The LATCH system is composed of three vehicle anchor points: two (2)  
lower anchors located where the vehicle seat back and seat cushion meet  
(called the “seat bight”) and one (1) top tether anchor located behind  
that seating position.  
166  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
LATCH compatible child safety seats have two rigid or webbing mounted  
attachments that connect to the two lower anchors at the LATCH  
equipped seating positions in your vehicle. This type of attachment  
method eliminates the need to use safety belts to attach the child seat,  
however the safety belt can still be used to attach the child seat. For  
forward-facing child seats, the top tether strap must also be attached to  
the proper top tether anchor, if a top tether strap has been provided  
with your child seat. Ford Motor Company recommends the use of a  
child safety seat having a top tether strap. See Attaching child safety  
seats with tether straps and Recommendations for attaching safety  
restraints for children in this chapter for more information.  
Your vehicle has LATCH lower anchors for child seat installation at the  
seating positions marked with the child seat symbol.  
The LATCH anchors are located at  
the rear section of the rear seat  
between the cushion and seatback.  
Follow the child seat manufacturer’s  
instructions to properly install a  
child seat with LATCH attachments.  
Follow the instructions on attaching  
child safety seats with tether straps.  
Refer to Attaching child safety  
seats with tether straps later in this  
chapter.  
Attach LATCH lower attachments of  
the child seat only to the anchors  
shown.  
WARNING: Never attach two child safety seats to the same  
anchor. In a crash, one anchor may not be strong enough to hold  
two child safety seat attachments and may break, causing serious  
injury or death.  
167  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: Depending on where you secure a child restraint,  
and depending on the child restraint design, you may block  
access to certain safety belt buckle assemblies and/or LATCH lower  
anchors, rendering those features potentially unusable. To avoid risk of  
injury, occupants should only use seating positions where they are able  
to be properly restrained.  
Use of inboard lower anchors from the outboard seating positions  
(center seating use)  
The lower anchors at the center of the second row rear seat are spaced  
400 mm (16 inches) apart. The standardized spacing for LATCH lower  
anchors is 280 mm (11 inches) center to center. A child seat with rigid  
LATCH attachments cannot be installed at the center seating position.  
LATCH compatible child seats (with attachments on belt webbing) can  
only be used at this seating position provided that the child seat  
manufacturer’s instructions permit use with the anchor spacing stated.  
Do not attach a child seat to any lower anchor if an adjacent child seat is  
attached to that anchor.  
WARNING: The standardized spacing for LATCH lower anchors  
is 280 mm (11 inches) center to center. Do not use LATCH  
lower anchors for the center seating position unless the child seat  
manufacturer’s instructions permit and specify using anchors spaced at  
least as far apart as those of this vehicle.  
Each time you use the safety seat, check that the seat is properly  
attached to the lower anchors and tether anchor, if applicable. Tug the  
child seat from side to side and forward and back where it is secured to  
the vehicle. The seat should move less than one inch when you do this  
for a proper installation.  
If the safety seat is not anchored properly, the risk of a child being  
injured in a crash greatly increases.  
Combining safety belt and LATCH lower anchors for attaching  
child safety seats  
When used in combination, either the safety belt or the LATCH lower  
anchors may be attached first, provided a proper installation is achieved.  
Attach the tether strap afterward, if included with the child seat. Refer  
to Recommendations for attaching child safety restraints for children  
in this chapter.  
168  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Attaching child safety seats with tether straps  
Many forward-facing child safety seats include a tether strap which  
extends from the back of the child safety seat and hooks to an anchoring  
point called the top tether anchor. Tether straps are available as an  
accessory for many older safety seats. Contact the manufacturer of your  
child seat for information about ordering a tether strap, or to obtain a  
longer tether strap if the tether strap on your safety seat does not reach  
the appropriate top tether anchor in the vehicle.  
The rear seating positions of your vehicle are equipped with built-in  
tether strap anchors located behind the seats on the roof panel in the  
cargo area.  
The tether strap anchors in your  
vehicle are in the following positions  
(shown from top view):  
Attach the tether strap only to the appropriate tether anchor as shown.  
The tether strap may not work properly if attached somewhere other  
than the correct tether anchor.  
Once the child safety seat has been installed, using either the safety belt  
or the lower anchors of the LATCH system, you can attach the top tether  
strap.  
If you install a child seat with rigid LATCH attachments, do not tighten  
the tether strap enough to lift the child seat off the vehicle seat cushion  
when the child is seated in it. Keep the tether strap just snug without  
lifting the front of the child seat. Keeping the child seat just touching the  
vehicle seat gives the best protection in a severe crash.  
Perform the following steps to install a child safety seat with tether  
anchors:  
1. Route the child safety seat tether strap over the back of the seat.  
For vehicles with adjustable head restraints, remove the head restraint  
first, place under the front seat for storage, and then route the tether  
strap over the top of the seatback.  
169  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
2. Locate the correct anchor for the  
selected seating position.  
There are three tether anchors  
located on the headliner at the rear  
of the vehicle.  
3. Clip the tether strap to the  
anchor as shown.  
The arrow in the above graphic  
points toward the front of the  
vehicle.  
If the tether strap is clipped  
incorrectly, the child safety seat may  
not be retained properly in the  
event of a collision.  
4. Tighten the child safety seat  
tether strap according to the  
manufacturer’s instructions.  
If the safety seat is not anchored properly, the risk of a child being  
injured in a collision greatly increases.  
If your child restraint system is equipped with a tether strap, and the  
child restraint manufacturer recommends its use, Ford also recommends  
its use.  
Child booster seats  
The belt-positioning booster (booster seat) is used to improve the fit of  
the vehicle safety belt. Children outgrow a typical child seat (e.g.,  
convertible or toddler seat) when they weigh about 40 lb (18 kg) and are  
170  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
around four (4) years of age. Consult your child safety seat owner guide  
for the weight, height, and age limits specific to your child safety seat.  
Keep your child in the child safety seat if it properly fits the child,  
remains appropriate for their weight, height and age AND if properly  
secured to the vehicle.  
Although the lap/shoulder belt will provide some protection, children  
who have outgrown a typical child seat are still too small for lap/shoulder  
belts to fit properly, and wearing an improperly fitted vehicle safety belt  
could increase the risk of serious injury in a crash. To improve the fit of  
both the lap and shoulder belt on children who have outgrown child  
safety seats, Ford Motor Company recommends use of a belt-positioning  
booster.  
Booster seats position a child so that vehicle lap/shoulder safety belts fit  
better. They lift the child up so that the lap belt rests low across the hips  
and the knees bend comfortably at the edge of the cushion, while  
minimizing slouching. Booster seats may also make the shoulder belt fit  
better and more comfortably. Try to keep the belt near the middle of the  
shoulder and across the center of the chest. Moving the child closer (a  
few centimeters or inches) to the center of the vehicle, but remaining in  
the same seating position, may help provide a good shoulder belt fit.  
When children should use booster seats  
Children need to use booster seats from the time they outgrow the  
toddler seat until they are big enough for the vehicle seat and  
lap/shoulder belt to fit properly. Generally this is when they reach a  
height of at least 4 feet 9 inches (1.45 meters) tall (around age eight to  
age twelve and between 40 lb (18 kg) and 80 lb (36 kg) or upward to  
100 lb (45 kg) if recommended by your child restraint manufacturer).  
Many state and provincial laws require that children use approved  
booster seats until they reach age eight, a height of 4 feet 9 inches  
(1.45 meters) tall, or 80 lb (36 kg).  
Booster seats should be used until you can answer YES to ALL of these  
questions when seated without a booster seat:  
Can the child sit all the way back  
against the vehicle seat back with  
knees bent comfortably at the  
edge of the seat cushion?  
Can the child sit without  
slouching?  
Does the lap belt rest low across the hips?  
171  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Is the shoulder belt centered on the shoulder and chest?  
Can the child stay seated like this for the whole trip?  
Types of booster seats  
There are generally two types of belt-positioning booster seats: backless  
and high back. Always use booster seats in conjunction with the vehicle  
lap/shoulder belt.  
Backless booster seats  
If your backless booster seat has a  
removable shield, remove the  
shield. If a vehicle seating position  
has a low seat back or no head  
restraint, a backless booster seat  
may place your child’s head (as  
measured at the tops of the ears)  
above the top of the seat. In this  
case, move the backless booster  
to another seating position with a  
higher seat back or head restraint and lap/shoulder belts, or consider  
using a high back booster seat.  
High back booster seats  
If, with a backless booster seat,  
you cannot find a seating position  
that adequately supports your  
child’s head, a high back booster  
seat would be a better choice.  
172  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Children and booster seats vary in size and shape. Choose a booster that  
keeps the lap belt low and snug across the hips, never up across the  
stomach, and lets you adjust the shoulder belt to cross the chest and  
rest snugly near the center of the shoulder. The drawings below compare  
the ideal fit (center) to a shoulder belt uncomfortably close to the neck  
and a shoulder belt that could slip off the shoulder. The drawings below  
also show how the lap belt should be low and snug across the child’s  
hips.  
If the booster seat slides on the vehicle seat, placing a rubberized mesh  
sold as shelf or carpet liner under the booster seat may improve this  
condition. Do not introduce any item thicker than this under the booster  
seat. Check with the booster seat manufacturer’s instructions.  
The importance of shoulder belts  
Using a booster without a shoulder belt increases the risk of a child’s  
head hitting a hard surface in a collision. For this reason, you should  
never use a booster seat with a lap belt only. It is generally best to use a  
booster seat with lap/shoulder belts in the back seat.  
Move a child to a different seating location if the shoulder belt does not  
stay positioned on the shoulder during use.  
173  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Follow all instructions provided by the manufacturer of the booster seat.  
WARNING: Never place, or allow a child to place, the shoulder  
belt under a child’s arm or behind the back because it reduces  
the protection for the upper part of the body and may increase the risk  
of injury or death in a collision.  
Child restraint and safety belt maintenance  
Inspect the vehicle safety belts and child safety seat systems periodically  
to make sure they work properly and are not damaged. Inspect the  
vehicle and child seat safety belts to make sure there are no nicks, tears  
or cuts. Replace if necessary. All vehicle safety belt assemblies, including  
retractors, buckles, front safety belt buckle assemblies, buckle support  
assemblies (slide bar-if equipped), shoulder belt height adjusters (if  
equipped), shoulder belt guide on seatback (if equipped), child safety  
seat LATCH and tether anchors, and attaching hardware, should be  
inspected after a collision. Refer to the child restraint manufacturer’s  
instructions for additional inspection and maintenance information  
specific to the child restraint. Ford Motor Company recommends that all  
safety belt assemblies in use in vehicles involved in a collision be  
replaced. However, if the collision was minor and an authorized dealer  
finds that the belts do not show damage and continue to operate  
properly, they do not need to be replaced. Safety belt assemblies not in  
use during a collision should also be inspected and replaced if either  
damage or improper operation is noted.  
For proper care of soiled safety belts, refer to Interior in the Cleaning  
chapter.  
WARNING: Failure to inspect and if necessary replace the  
safety belt assembly or child restraint system under the above  
conditions could result in severe personal injuries in the event of a  
collision.  
174  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
NOTICE TO UTILITY VEHICLE AND TRUCK OWNERS  
Utility vehicles and trucks handle  
differently than passenger cars in  
the various driving conditions that  
are encountered on streets,  
highways and off-road. Utility  
vehicles and trucks are not designed  
for cornering at speeds as high as  
passenger cars any more than  
low-slung sports cars are designed  
to perform satisfactorily under  
off-road conditions.  
WARNING: Utility vehicles have a significantly higher rollover  
rate than other types of vehicles. To reduce the risk of serious  
injury or death from a rollover or other crash you must:  
Avoid sharp turns and abrupt maneuvers;  
Drive at safe speeds for the conditions;  
Keep tires properly inflated;  
Never overload or improperly load your vehicle; and  
Make sure every passenger is properly restrained.  
WARNING: In a rollover crash, an unbelted person is  
significantly more likely to die than a person wearing a seat belt.  
All occupants must wear seat belts and children/infants must use  
appropriate restraints to minimize the risk of injury or ejection.  
Study your owner’s guide and any supplements for specific information  
about equipment features, instructions for safe driving and additional  
precautions to reduce the risk of an accident or serious injury.  
175  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
VEHICLE CHARACTERISTICS  
4WD system (if equipped)  
Your vehicle may be equipped with a four-wheel drive (4WD) system.  
With the 4WD option, power will be delivered to the front wheels and  
distributed to the rear wheels as needed. This increases traction which  
may enable you to safely drive over terrain and road conditions that a  
conventional two-wheel drive vehicle cannot. The 4WD system is active  
all the time and requires no input from the operator.  
For 4WD vehicles, a spare tire of a different size other than the tire  
provided should never be used. A dissimilar spare tire size (other than  
the spare tire provided) or major dissimilar tire sized between the front  
and rear axles could cause the 4WD system to stop functioning and  
default to front-wheel drive.  
WARNING: Do not become overconfident in the ability of 4WD  
vehicles. Although a 4WD vehicle may accelerate better than a  
two-wheel drive vehicle in low traction situations, it won’t stop any  
faster than two-wheel drive vehicles. Always drive at a safe speed.  
How your vehicle differs from other vehicles  
SUVs and trucks can differ from  
some other vehicles in a few  
noticeable ways. Your vehicle may  
be:  
Higher – to allow higher load  
carrying capacity and to allow it  
to travel over rough terrain  
without getting hung up or  
damaging underbody components.  
Shorter – to give it the capability  
to approach inclines and drive  
over the crest of a hill without  
getting hung up or damaging  
underbody components. All other  
things held equal, a shorter  
wheelbase may make your vehicle  
quicker to respond to steering inputs than a vehicle with a longer  
wheelbase.  
176  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Narrower — to provide greater  
maneuverability in tight spaces,  
particularly in off-road use.  
As a result of the above dimensional  
differences, SUVs and trucks often  
will have a higher center of gravity  
and a greater difference in center of  
gravity between the loaded and  
unloaded condition.  
These differences that make your  
vehicle so versatile also make it  
handle differently than an ordinary  
passenger car.  
INFORMATION ABOUT UNIFORM TIRE QUALITY GRADING  
Tire Quality Grades apply to new  
pneumatic passenger car tires. The  
Quality grades can be found where  
applicable on the tire sidewall  
between tread shoulder and  
maximum section width. For  
example:  
Treadwear 200 Traction AA Temperature A  
These Tire Quality Grades are determined by standards that the United  
States Department of Transportation has set.  
Tire Quality Grades apply to new pneumatic passenger car tires. They do  
not apply to deep tread, winter-type snow tires, space-saver or  
temporary use spare tires, light truck or “LT” type tires, tires with  
nominal rim diameters of 10 to 12 inches or limited production tires as  
defined in Title 49 Code of Federal Regulations Part 575.104(c)(2).  
U.S. Department of Transportation-Tire quality grades: The U.S.  
Department of Transportation requires Ford Motor Company to give you  
the following information about tire grades exactly as the government  
has written it.  
Treadwear  
The treadwear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear rate of  
the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a specified  
177  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
government test course. For example, a tire graded 150 would wear one  
and one-half (112) times as well on the government course as a tire  
graded 100. The relative performance of tires depends upon the actual  
conditions of their use, however, and may depart significantly from the  
norm due to variations in driving habits, service practices, and  
differences in road characteristics and climate.  
Traction AA A B C  
The traction grades, from highest to lowest are AA, A, B, and C. The  
grades represent the tire’s ability to stop on wet pavement as measured  
under controlled conditions on specified government test surfaces of  
asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C may have poor traction  
performance.  
WARNING: The traction grade assigned to this tire is based on  
straight-ahead braking traction tests, and does not include  
acceleration, cornering, hydroplaning or peak traction characteristics.  
Temperature A B C  
The temperature grades are A (the highest), B and C, representing the  
tire’s resistance to the generation of heat and its ability to dissipate heat  
when tested under controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory  
test wheel. Sustained high temperature can cause the material of the tire  
to degenerate and reduce tire life, and excessive temperature can lead to  
sudden tire failure. The grade C corresponds to a level of performance  
which all passenger car tires must meet under the Federal Motor Vehicle  
Safety Standard No. 139. Grades B and A represent higher levels of  
performance on the laboratory test wheel than the minimum required by  
law.  
WARNING: The temperature grade for this tire is established  
for a tire that is properly inflated and not overloaded. Excessive  
speed, underinflation, or excessive loading, either separately or in  
combination, can cause heat buildup and possible tire failure.  
TIRES  
Tires are designed to give many thousands of miles of service, but they  
must be maintained in order to get the maximum benefit from them.  
Glossary of tire terminology  
Tire label: A label showing the OE (Original Equipment) tire sizes,  
recommended inflation pressure and the maximum weight the vehicle  
can carry.  
178  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Tire Identification Number (TIN): A number on the sidewall of  
each tire providing information about the tire brand and  
manufacturing plant, tire size and date of manufacture. Also referred  
to as DOT code.  
Inflation pressure: A measure of the amount of air in a tire.  
Standard load: A class of P-metric or Metric tires designed to carry a  
maximum load at 35 psi [37 psi (2.5 bar) for Metric tires]. Increasing  
the inflation pressure beyond this pressure will not increase the tire’s  
load carrying capability.  
Extra load: A class of P-metric or Metric tires designed to carry a  
heavier maximum load at 41 psi [43 psi (2.9 bar) for Metric tires].  
Increasing the inflation pressure beyond this pressure will not increase  
the tire’s load carrying capability.  
kPa: Kilopascal, a metric unit of air pressure.  
PSI: Pounds per square inch, a standard unit of air pressure.  
Cold inflation pressure: The tire pressure when the vehicle has  
been stationary and out of direct sunlight for an hour or more and  
prior to the vehicle being driven for 1 mile (1.6 km).  
Recommended inflation pressure: The cold inflation pressure found  
on the Safety Compliance Certification Label or Tire Label located on  
the B-Pillar or the edge of the driver’s door.  
B-pillar: The structural member at the side of the vehicle behind the  
front door.  
Bead area of the tire: Area of the tire next to the rim.  
Sidewall of the tire: Area between the bead area and the tread.  
Tread area of the tire: Area of the perimeter of the tire that  
contacts the road when mounted on the vehicle.  
Rim: The metal support (wheel) for a tire or a tire and tube assembly  
upon which the tire beads are seated.  
INFLATING YOUR TIRES  
Safe operation of your vehicle requires that your tires are properly  
inflated. Remember that a tire can lose up to half of its air pressure  
without appearing flat.  
Every day before you drive, check your tires. If one looks lower than the  
others, use a tire gauge to check pressure of all tires and adjust if  
required.  
179  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
At least once a month and before long trips, inspect each tire and check  
the tire pressure with a tire gauge (including spare, if equipped). Inflate  
all tires to the inflation pressure recommended by Ford Motor Company.  
You are strongly urged to buy a reliable tire pressure gauge, as automatic  
service station gauges may be inaccurate. Ford recommends the use of a  
digital or dial-type tire pressure gauge rather than a stick-type tire  
pressure gauge.  
Use the recommended cold inflation pressure for optimum tire  
performance and wear. Under-inflation or over-inflation may cause  
uneven treadwear patterns.  
WARNING: Under-inflation is the most common cause of tire  
failures and may result in severe tire cracking, tread separation  
or “blowout”, with unexpected loss of vehicle control and increased  
risk of injury. Under-inflation increases sidewall flexing and rolling  
resistance, resulting in heat buildup and internal damage to the tire. It  
also may result in unnecessary tire stress, irregular wear, loss of  
vehicle control and accidents. A tire can lose up to half of its air  
pressure and not appear to be flat!  
Always inflate your tires to the Ford recommended inflation pressure  
even if it is less than the maximum inflation pressure information found  
on the tire. The Ford recommended tire inflation pressure is found on  
the Safety Compliance Certification Label or Tire Label which is located  
on the B-Pillar or the edge of the driver’s door. Failure to follow the tire  
pressure recommendations can cause uneven treadwear patterns and  
adversely affect the way your vehicle handles.  
Maximum Permissible Inflation Pressure is the tire manufacturer’s  
maximum permissible pressure and/or the pressure at which the  
maximum load can be carried by the tire. This pressure is normally  
higher than the manufacturer’s recommended cold inflation pressure  
which can be found on the Safety Compliance Certification Label or Tire  
Label which is located on the B-Pillar or the edge of the driver’s door.  
The cold inflation pressure should never be set lower than the  
recommended pressure on the Safety Compliance Certification Label or  
Tire Label.  
When weather temperature changes occur, tire inflation pressures also  
change. A 10°F (6°C) temperature drop can cause a corresponding drop  
of 1 psi (7 kPa) in inflation pressure. Check your tire pressures  
frequently and adjust them to the proper pressure which can be found  
on the Safety Compliance Certification Label or Tire Label.  
180  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
To check the pressure in your tire(s):  
1. Make sure the tires are cool, meaning they are not hot from driving  
even a mile.  
If you are checking tire pressure when the tire is hot, (i.e. driven more  
than 1 mile [1.6 km]), never “bleed” or reduce air pressure. The tires are  
hot from driving and it is normal for pressures to increase above  
recommended cold pressures. A hot tire at or below recommended cold  
inflation pressure could be significantly under-inflated.  
Note: If you have to drive a distance to get air for your tire(s), check  
and record the tire pressure first and add the appropriate air pressure  
when you get to the pump. It is normal for tires to heat up and the air  
pressure inside to go up as you drive.  
2. Remove the cap from the valve on one tire, then firmly press the tire  
gauge onto the valve and measure the pressure.  
3. Add enough air to reach the recommended air pressure.  
Note: If you overfill the tire, release air by pressing on the metal stem in  
the center of the valve. Then recheck the pressure with your tire gauge.  
4. Replace the valve cap.  
5. Repeat this procedure for each tire, including the spare.  
Note: Some spare tires operate at a higher inflation pressure than the  
other tires. For T-type/mini-spare tires (see the Dissimilar spare  
tire/wheel information section for description): Store and maintain at  
60 psi (4.15 bar). For full-size and dissimilar spare tires (see the  
Dissimilar spare tire/wheel information section for description): Store  
and maintain at the higher of the front and rear inflation pressure as  
shown on the Tire Label.  
6. Visually inspect the tires to make sure there are no nails or other  
objects embedded that could poke a hole in the tire and cause an air  
leak.  
7. Check the sidewalls to make sure there are no gouges, cuts or bulges.  
TIRE CARE  
Inspecting your tires and wheel valve stems  
Periodically inspect the tire treads for uneven or excessive wear and  
remove objects such as stones, nails or glass that may be wedged in the  
tread grooves. Check the tire and valve stems for holes, cracks, or cuts  
that may permit air leakage and repair or replace the tire and replace  
181  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
the valve stem. Inspect the tire sidewalls for cracking, cuts, bruises and  
other signs of damage or excessive wear. If internal damage to the tire is  
suspected, have the tire demounted and inspected in case it needs to be  
repaired or replaced. For your safety, tires that are damaged or show  
signs of excessive wear should not be used because they are more likely  
to blow out or fail.  
Improper or inadequate vehicle maintenance can cause tires to wear  
abnormally. Inspect all your tires, including the spare, frequently, and  
replace them if one or more of the following conditions exist:  
Tire wear  
When the tread is worn down to  
1/16th of an inch (2 mm), tires must  
be replaced to help prevent your  
vehicle from skidding and  
hydroplaning. Built-in treadwear  
indicators, or “wear bars”, which  
look like narrow strips of smooth  
rubber across the tread will appear  
on the tire when the tread is worn  
down to 1/16th of an inch (2 mm).  
When the tire tread wears down to  
the same height as these “wear bars”, the tire is worn out and must be  
replaced.  
Damage  
Periodically inspect the tire treads and sidewalls for damage (such as  
bulges in the tread or sidewalls, cracks in the tread groove and  
separation in the tread or sidewall). If damage is observed or suspected  
have the tire inspected by a tire professional. Tires can be damaged  
during off-road use, so inspection after off-road use is also  
recommended.  
WARNING: Age  
Tires degrade over time depending on many factors such as  
weather, storage conditions, and conditions of use (load, speed,  
inflation pressure, etc.) the tires experience throughout their lives.  
In general, tires should be replaced after six years regardless of tread  
wear. However, heat caused by hot climates or frequent high loading  
conditions can accelerate the aging process and may require tires to be  
replaced more frequently.  
You should replace your spare tire when you replace the road tires or  
after six years due to aging even if it has not been used.  
182  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
U.S. DOT Tire Identification Number (TIN)  
Both U.S. and Canada Federal regulations require tire manufacturers to  
place standardized information on the sidewall of all tires. This  
information identifies and describes the fundamental characteristics of  
the tire and also provides a U.S. DOT Tire Identification Number for  
safety standard certification and in case of a recall.  
This begins with the letters “DOT” and indicates that the tire meets all  
federal standards. The next two numbers or letters are the plant code  
designating where it was manufactured, the next two are the tire size  
code and the last four numbers represent the week and year the tire was  
built. For example, the numbers 317 mean the 31st week of 1997. After  
2000 the numbers go to four digits. For example, 2501 means the 25th  
week of 2001. The numbers in between are identification codes used for  
traceability. This information is used to contact customers if a tire defect  
requires a recall.  
Tire replacement requirements  
Your vehicle is equipped with tires designed to provide a safe ride and  
handling capability.  
WARNING: Only use replacement tires and wheels that are the  
same size, load index, speed rating and type (such as P-metric  
versus LT-metric or all-season versus all-terrain) as those originally  
provided by Ford. The recommended tire and wheel size may be found  
on either the Safety Compliance Certification Label or the Tire Label  
which is located on the B-Pillar or edge of the driver’s door. If this  
information is not found on these labels then you should consult your  
Ford dealer. Use of any tire or wheel not recommended by Ford can  
affect the safety and performance of your vehicle, which could result in  
an increased risk of loss of vehicle control, vehicle rollover, personal  
injury and death. Additionally the use of non-recommended tires and  
wheels could cause steering, suspension, axle or transfer case/power  
transfer unit failure. If you have questions regarding tire replacement,  
see an authorized dealer.  
183  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
WARNING: When mounting replacement tires and wheels, you  
should not exceed the maximum pressure indicated on the  
sidewall of the tire to set the beads without additional precautions  
listed below. If the beads do not seat at the maximum pressure  
indicated, re-lubricate and try again.  
When inflating the tire for mounting pressures up to 20 psi (1.38 bar)  
greater than the maximum pressure on the tire sidewall, the following  
precautions must be taken to protect the person mounting the tire:  
1. Make sure that you have the correct tire and wheel size.  
2. Lubricate the tire bead and wheel bead seat area again.  
3. Stand at a minimum of 12 ft (3.66 m) away from the tire wheel  
assembly.  
4. Use both eye and ear protection.  
For a mounting pressure more than 20 psi (1.38 bar) greater than the  
maximum pressure, a Ford dealer or other tire service professional  
should do the mounting.  
Always inflate steel carcass tires with a remote air fill with the person  
inflating standing at a minimum of 12 ft (3.66 m) away from the tire  
wheel assembly.  
Important: Remember to replace the valve stems when the road tires  
are replaced on your vehicle.  
It is recommended that the two front tires or two rear tires generally be  
replaced as a pair.  
Note: The use of a different tire can effect the fuel economy of your  
vehicle.  
The tire pressure monitoring sensors mounted in the wheels (originally  
installed on your vehicle) are not designed to be used in aftermarket  
wheels.  
The use of wheels or tires not recommended by Ford Motor Company  
may affect the operation of your tire pressure monitoring system.  
If the TPMS indicator is flashing, your TPMS is malfunctioning. Your  
replacement tire might be incompatible with your TPMS, or some  
component of the TPMS may be damaged.  
184  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Safety practices  
Driving habits have a great deal to do with your tire mileage and safety.  
Observe posted speed limits  
Avoid fast starts, stops and turns  
Avoid potholes and objects on the road  
Do not run over curbs or hit the tire against a curb when parking  
WARNING: If your vehicle is stuck in snow, mud, sand, etc., do  
not rapidly spin the tires; spinning the tires can tear the tire and  
cause an explosion. A tire can explode in as little as three to five  
seconds.  
WARNING: Do not spin the wheels at over 35 mph (56 km/h).  
The tires may fail and injure a passenger or bystander.  
Highway hazards  
No matter how carefully you drive there’s always the possibility that you  
may eventually have a flat tire on the highway. Drive slowly to the  
closest safe area out of traffic. This may further damage the flat tire, but  
your safety is more important.  
If you feel a sudden vibration or ride disturbance while driving, or you  
suspect your tire or vehicle has been damaged, immediately reduce your  
speed. Drive with caution until you can safely pull off the road. Stop and  
inspect the tires for damage. If a tire is under-inflated or damaged,  
deflate it, remove wheel and replace it with your spare tire and wheel. If  
you cannot detect a cause, have the vehicle towed to the nearest repair  
facility or tire dealer to have the vehicle inspected.  
185  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Tire and wheel alignment  
A bad jolt from hitting a curb or pothole can cause the front end of your  
vehicle to become misaligned or cause damage to your tires. If your  
vehicle seems to pull to one side when you’re driving, the wheels may be  
out of alignment. Have an authorized dealer check the wheel alignment  
periodically.  
Wheel misalignment in the front or the rear can cause uneven and rapid  
treadwear of your tires and should be corrected by an authorized dealer.  
Front-wheel drive (FWD) vehicles and those with an independent rear  
suspension (if equipped) may require alignment of all four wheels.  
The tires should also be balanced periodically. An unbalanced tire and  
wheel assembly may result in irregular tire wear.  
Tire rotation  
Rotating your tires at the recommended interval (as indicated in the  
Scheduled Maintenance Guide chapter) will help your tires wear more  
evenly, providing better tire performance and longer tire life.  
Front-wheel drive (FWD) vehicles  
(front tires at top of diagram)  
186  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Rear-wheel drive (RWD)  
vehicles/Four-wheel drive  
(4WD)/All-wheel drive (AWD)  
vehicles (front tires at top of  
diagram)  
Sometimes irregular tire wear can be corrected by rotating the tires.  
Note: If your tires show uneven wear ask an authorized dealer to check  
for and correct any wheel misalignment, tire imbalance or mechanical  
problem involved before tire rotation.  
Note: Your vehicle may be equipped with a dissimilar spare tire/wheel. A  
dissimilar spare tire/wheel is defined as a spare tire and/or wheel that is  
different in brand, size or appearance from the road tires and wheels. If  
you have a dissimilar spare tire/wheel it is intended for temporary use  
only and should not be used in a tire rotation.  
Note: After having your tires rotated, inflation pressure must be checked  
and adjusted to the vehicle requirements.  
INFORMATION CONTAINED ON THE TIRE SIDEWALL  
Both U.S. and Canada Federal regulations require tire manufacturers to  
place standardized information on the sidewall of all tires. This  
information identifies and describes the fundamental characteristics of  
the tire and also provides a U.S. DOT Tire Identification Number for  
safety standard certification and in case of a recall.  
187  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Information on “P” type tires  
P215/65R15 95H is an example of a  
tire size, load index and speed  
rating. The definitions of these  
items are listed below. (Note that  
the tire size, load index and speed  
rating for your vehicle may be  
different from this example.)  
1. P: Indicates a tire, designated by  
the Tire and Rim Association  
(T&RA), that may be used for  
service on cars, SUVs, minivans and  
light trucks.  
Note: If your tire size does not  
begin with a letter this may mean it  
is designated by either ETRTO  
(European Tire and Rim Technical Organization) or JATMA (Japan Tire  
Manufacturing Association).  
2. 215: Indicates the nominal width of the tire in millimeters from  
sidewall edge to sidewall edge. In general, the larger the number, the  
wider the tire.  
3. 65: Indicates the aspect ratio which gives the tire’s ratio of height to  
width.  
4. R: Indicates a “radial” type tire.  
5. 15: Indicates the wheel or rim diameter in inches. If you change your  
wheel size, you will have to purchase new tires to match the new wheel  
diameter.  
6. 95: Indicates the tire’s load index. It is an index that relates to how  
much weight a tire can carry. You may find this information in your  
Owner’s Guide. If not, contact a local tire dealer.  
Note: You may not find this information on all tires because it is not  
required by federal law.  
7. H: Indicates the tire’s speed rating. The speed rating denotes the  
speed at which a tire is designed to be driven for extended periods of  
time under a standard condition of load and inflation pressure. The tires  
on your vehicle may operate at different conditions for load and inflation  
pressure. These speed ratings may need to be adjusted for the difference  
in conditions. The ratings range from 81 mph (130 km/h) to 186 mph  
(299 km/h). These ratings are listed in the following chart.  
188  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Note: You may not find this information on all tires because it is not  
required by federal law.  
Letter rating  
Speed rating - mph (km/h)  
81 mph (130 km/h)  
87 mph (140 km/h)  
99 mph (159 km/h)  
106 mph (171 km/h)  
112 mph (180 km/h)  
118 mph (190 km/h)  
124 mph (200 km/h)  
130 mph (210 km/h)  
149 mph (240 km/h)  
168 mph (270 km/h)  
186 mph (299 km/h)  
M
N
Q
R
S
T
U
H
V
W
Y
Note: For tires with a maximum speed capability over 149 mph  
(240 km/h), tire manufacturers sometimes use the letters ZR. For  
those with a maximum speed capability over 186 mph (299 km/h), tire  
manufacturers always use the letters ZR.  
8. U.S. DOT Tire Identification Number (TIN): This begins with the  
letters “DOT” and indicates that the tire meets all federal standards. The  
next two numbers or letters are the plant code designating where it was  
manufactured, the next two are the tire size code and the last four  
numbers represent the week and year the tire was built. For example,  
the numbers 317 mean the 31st week of 1997. After 2000 the numbers  
go to four digits. For example, 2501 means the 25th week of 2001. The  
numbers in between are identification codes used for traceability. This  
information is used to contact customers if a tire defect requires a recall.  
9. M+S or M/S: Mud and Snow, or  
AT: All Terrain, or  
AS: All Season.  
10. Tire Ply Composition and Material Used: Indicates the number of  
plies or the number of layers of rubber-coated fabric in the tire tread and  
sidewall. Tire manufacturers also must indicate the ply materials in the  
tire and the sidewall, which include steel, nylon, polyester, and others.  
11. Maximum Load: Indicates the maximum load in kilograms and  
pounds that can be carried by the tire. Refer to the Safety Compliance  
Certification Label, which is located on the B-Pillar or the edge of the  
driver’s door, for the correct tire pressure for your vehicle.  
189  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
12. Treadwear, Traction and Temperature Grades  
Treadwear: The treadwear grade is a comparative rating based on the  
wear rate of the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a  
specified government test course. For example, a tire graded 150  
would wear one and one-half (112) times as well on the government  
course as a tire graded 100.  
Traction: The traction grades, from highest to lowest are AA, A, B,  
and C. The grades represent the tire’s ability to stop on wet pavement  
as measured under controlled conditions on specified government test  
surfaces of asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C may have poor  
traction performance.  
Temperature: The temperature grades are A (the highest), B and C,  
representing the tire’s resistance to the generation of heat and its  
ability to dissipate heat when tested under controlled conditions on a  
specified indoor laboratory test wheel.  
13. Maximum Permissible Inflation Pressure: Indicates the tire  
manufacturers’ maximum permissible pressure and/or the pressure at  
which the maximum load can be carried by the tire. This pressure is  
normally higher than the manufacturer’s recommended cold inflation  
pressure which can be found on the Safety Compliance Certification  
Label or Tire Label which is located on the B-Pillar or the edge of the  
driver’s door. The cold inflation pressure should never be set lower than  
the recommended pressure on the vehicle label.  
The tire suppliers may have additional markings, notes or warnings such  
as standard load, radial tubeless, etc.  
190  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Additional information contained on the tire sidewall for “LT” type  
tires  
“LT” type tires have some additional  
information beyond those of “P”  
type tires; these differences are  
described below.  
Note: Tire Quality Grades do not  
apply to this type of tire.  
1. LT: Indicates a tire, designated by  
the Tire and Rim Association  
(T&RA), that is intended for service  
on light trucks.  
2. Load Range/Load Inflation  
Limits: Indicates the tire’s  
load-carrying capabilities and its  
inflation limits.  
3. Maximum Load Dual lb (kg) at psi (kPa) cold: Indicates the  
maximum load and tire pressure when the tire is used as a dual; defined  
as four tires on the rear axle (a total of six or more tires on the vehicle).  
4. Maximum Load Single lb (kg) at psi (kPa) cold: Indicates the  
maximum load and tire pressure when the tire is used as a single;  
defined as two tires (total) on the rear axle.  
191  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Information on “T” type tires  
“T” type tires have some additional  
information beyond those of “P”  
type tires; these differences are  
described below:  
T145/80D16 is an example of a tire  
size.  
Note: The temporary tire size for  
your vehicle may be different from  
this example. Tire Quality Grades do  
not apply to this type of tire.  
1. T: Indicates a type of tire,  
designated by the Tire and Rim  
Association (T&RA), that is  
intended for temporary service on  
cars, SUVs, minivans and light  
trucks.  
2. 145: Indicates the nominal width  
of the tire in millimeters from sidewall edge to sidewall edge. In general,  
the larger the number, the wider the tire.  
3. 80: Indicates the aspect ratio which gives the tire’s ratio of height to  
width. Numbers of 70 or lower indicate a short sidewall.  
4. D: Indicates a “diagonal” type tire.  
R: Indicates a “radial” type tire.  
5. 16: Indicates the wheel or rim diameter in inches. If you change your  
wheel size, you will have to purchase new tires to match the new wheel  
diameter.  
Location of the tire label  
You will find a Tire Label containing tire inflation pressure by tire size  
and other important information located on the B-Pillar or the edge of  
the driver’s door. Refer to the payload description and graphic in the  
Vehicle loading — with and without a trailer section.  
192  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM (TPMS)  
Each tire, including the spare (if  
provided), should be checked  
monthly when cold and inflated to  
the inflation pressure recommended  
by the vehicle manufacturer on the  
vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label. (If your vehicle has tires  
of a different size than the size indicated on the vehicle placard or tire  
inflation pressure label, you should determine the proper tire inflation  
pressure for those tires.)  
As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been equipped with a tire  
pressure monitoring system (TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pressure  
telltale when one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated.  
Accordingly, when the low tire pressure telltale illuminates, you should  
stop and check your tires as soon as possible, and inflate them to the  
proper pressure. Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire causes the  
tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure. Under-inflation also reduces  
fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicle’s handling  
and stopping ability.  
Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire  
maintenance, and it is the driver’s responsibility to maintain correct tire  
pressure, even if under-inflation has not reached the level to trigger  
illumination of the TPMS low tire pressure telltale.  
Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS malfunction indicator  
to indicate when the system is not operating properly. The TPMS  
malfunction indicator is combined with the low tire pressure telltale.  
When the system detects a malfunction, the telltale will flash for  
approximately one minute and then remain continuously illuminated.  
This sequence will continue upon subsequent vehicle start-ups as long as  
the malfunction exists.  
When the malfunction indicator is illuminated, the system may not be  
able to detect or signal low tire pressure as intended. TPMS malfunctions  
may occur for a variety of reasons, including the installation of  
replacement or alternate tires or wheels on the vehicle that prevent the  
TPMS from functioning properly. Always check the TPMS malfunction  
telltale after replacing one or more tires or wheels on your vehicle to  
ensure that the replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow the  
TPMS to continue to function properly.  
193  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
The tire pressure monitoring system complies with part 15 of the FCC  
rules and with RSS-210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the  
following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful  
interference, and (2) This device must accept any interference received,  
including interference that may cause undesired operation.  
WARNING: The tire pressure monitoring system is NOT a  
substitute for manually checking tire pressure. The tire pressure  
should be checked periodically (at least monthly) using a tire gauge,  
see Inflating your tires in this chapter. Failure to properly maintain  
your tire pressure could increase the risk of tire failure, loss of control,  
vehicle rollover and personal injury.  
Changing tires with TPMS  
Each road tire is equipped with  
a tire pressure sensor located  
inside the tire/wheel cavity. The  
pressure sensor is attached to  
the valve stem. The pressure  
sensor is covered by the tire and  
is not visible unless the tire is  
removed. Care must be taken  
when changing the tire to avoid  
damaging the sensor. It is  
recommended that you always have  
your tires serviced by an authorized dealer.  
The tire pressure should be checked periodically (at least monthly) using  
an accurate tire gauge, refer to Inflating your tires in this chapter.  
Understanding your tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS)  
The tire pressure monitoring system measures pressure in your four road  
tires and sends the tire pressure readings to your vehicle. The low tire  
pressure warning lamp will turn on if the tire pressure is significantly  
low. Once the light is illuminated, your tires are under inflated and need  
to be inflated to the manufacturer’s recommended tire pressure. Even if  
the light turns on and a short time later turns off, your tire pressure still  
needs to be checked. Visit www.checkmytires.org for additional  
information.  
194  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
When your temporary spare tire is installed  
When one of your road tires needs to be replaced with the temporary  
spare, the TPMS system will continue to identify an issue to remind you  
that the damaged road wheel/tire needs to be repaired and put back on  
your vehicle.  
To restore the full functionality of the tire pressure monitoring system,  
have the damaged road wheel/tire repaired and remounted on your  
vehicle. For additional information, refer to Changing tires with TPMS  
in this section.  
When you believe your system is not operating properly  
The main function of the tire pressure monitoring system is to warn you  
when your tires need air. It can also warn you in the event the system is  
no longer capable of functioning as intended. Please refer to the  
following chart for information concerning your tire pressure monitoring  
system:  
Low tire pressure Possible Customer action required  
warning light  
cause  
Solid warning light  
Tire(s)  
under-  
inflated  
1. Check your tire pressure to ensure  
tires are properly inflated; refer to  
Inflating your tires in this chapter.  
2. After inflating your tires to the  
manufacturer’s recommended infla-  
tion pressure as shown on the Tire  
Label (located on the edge of driver’s  
door or the B-Pillar), the vehicle  
must be driven for at least two min-  
utes over 20 mph (32 km/h) before  
the light will turn off.  
Spare tire Your temporary spare tire is in use.  
in use  
Repair the damaged road wheel/tire  
and reinstall it on the vehicle to re-  
store system functionality. For a de-  
scription on how the system func-  
tions, refer to When your temporary  
spare tire is installed in this section.  
TPMS  
If your tires are properly inflated and  
malfunc- your spare tire is not in use and the  
tion  
light remains on, contact your autho-  
rized dealer as soon as possible.  
195  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Low tire pressure Possible Customer action required  
warning light  
cause  
Flashing warning  
light  
Spare tire Your temporary spare tire is in use.  
in use  
Repair the damaged road wheel and  
re-mount it on the vehicle to restore  
system functionality. For a descrip-  
tion of how the system functions un-  
der these conditions, refer to When  
your temporary spare tire is in-  
stalled in this section.  
TPMS  
If your tires are properly inflated and  
malfunc- your spare tire is not in use and the  
tion  
TPMS warning light still flashes, con-  
tact your authorized dealer as soon  
as possible.  
When inflating your tires  
When putting air into your tires (such as at a gas station or in your  
garage), the tire pressure monitoring system may not respond  
immediately to the air added to your tires.  
It may take up to two minutes of driving over 20 mph (32 km/h) for the  
light to turn off after you have filled your tires to the recommended  
inflation pressure.  
How temperature affects your tire pressure  
The tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) monitors tire pressure in  
each pneumatic tire. While driving in a normal manner, a typical  
passenger tire inflation pressure may increase approximately 2 to 4 psi  
(14 to 28 kPa) from a cold start situation. If the vehicle is stationary  
over night with the outside temperature significantly lower than the  
daytime temperature, the tire pressure may decrease approximately 3 psi  
(21 kPa) for a drop of 30°F (17°C) in ambient temperature. This lower  
pressure value may be detected by the TPMS as being significantly lower  
than the recommended inflation pressure and activate the TPMS warning  
for low tire pressure. If the low tire pressure warning light is on, visually  
check each tire to verify that no tire is flat. (If one or more tires are flat,  
repair as necessary.) Check air pressure in the road tires. If any tire is  
under-inflated, carefully drive the vehicle to the nearest location where  
air can be added to the tires. Inflate all the tires to the recommended  
inflation pressure.  
196  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
SNOW TIRES AND CABLES  
WARNING: Snow tires must be the same size, load index, speed  
rating as those originally provided by Ford. Use of any tire or  
wheel not recommended by Ford can affect the safety and  
performance of your vehicle, which could result in an increased risk of  
loss of vehicle control, vehicle rollover, personal injury and death.  
Additionally, the use of non-recommended tires and wheels could  
cause steering, suspension, axle or transfer case/power transfer unit  
failure.  
The tires on your vehicle have all weather treads to provide traction in  
rain and snow. However, in some climates, you may need to use snow  
tires and cables. If you need to use cables, it is recommended that steel  
wheels (of the same size and specifications) be used, as cables may chip  
aluminum wheels.  
Follow these guidelines when using snow tires and traction devices:  
If possible, avoid fully loading your vehicle.  
SAE class S cables should ONLY be used on the front axle for  
P235/70R16 tires.  
Install cables securely, verifying that the cables do not touch any  
wiring, brake lines or fuel lines.  
Do not exceed 30 mph (48 km/h) with tire cables on your vehicle.  
Drive cautiously. If you hear the cables rub or bang against the  
vehicle, stop and retighten them. If this does not work, remove the  
cables to prevent vehicle damage.  
Remove the cables when they are no longer needed. Do not use cables  
on dry roads.  
Consult your authorized dealer for information on other Ford Motor  
Company approved methods of traction control.  
197  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
VEHICLE LOADING – WITH AND WITHOUT A TRAILER  
This section will guide you in the proper loading of your vehicle and/or  
trailer, to keep your loaded vehicle weight within its design rating  
capability, with or without a trailer. Properly loading your vehicle will  
provide maximum return of vehicle design performance. Before loading  
your vehicle, familiarize yourself with the following terms for determining  
your vehicle’s weight ratings, with or without a trailer, from the vehicle’s  
Tire Label or Safety Compliance Certification Label:  
Base Curb Weight – is the weight of the vehicle including a full tank of  
fuel and all standard equipment. It does not include passengers, cargo, or  
optional equipment.  
Vehicle Curb Weight – is the weight of your new vehicle when you  
picked it up from your authorized dealer plus any aftermarket  
equipment.  
198  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Payload – is the combined weight of cargo and passengers that the  
vehicle is carrying. The maximum payload for your vehicle can be found  
on the Tire Label on the B-Pillar or the edge of the driver’s door  
(vehicles exported outside the US and Canada may not have a Tire  
Label). Look for “THE COMBINED WEIGHT OF OCCUPANTS AND  
CARGO SHOULD NEVER EXCEED XXX kg OR XXX lb.” for  
maximum payload. The payload listed on the Tire Label is the maximum  
payload for the vehicle as built by the assembly plant. If any aftermarket  
or authorized-dealer installed equipment has been installed on the  
vehicle, the weight of the equipment must be subtracted from the  
payload listed on the Tire Label in order to determine the new payload.  
WARNING: The appropriate loading capacity of your vehicle can  
be limited either by volume capacity (how much space is  
available) or by payload capacity (how much weight the vehicle should  
carry). Once you have reached the maximum payload of your vehicle,  
do not add more cargo, even if there is space available. Overloading or  
improperly loading your vehicle can contribute to loss of vehicle  
control and vehicle rollover.  
199  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Example only:  
200  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Cargo Weight – includes all weight added to the Base Curb Weight,  
including cargo and optional equipment. When towing, trailer tongue load  
or king pin weight is also part of cargo weight.  
GAW (Gross Axle Weight) – is the total weight placed on each axle  
(front and rear) – including vehicle curb weight and all payload.  
GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating) – is the maximum allowable  
weight that can be carried by a single axle (front or rear). These  
numbers are shown on the Safety Compliance Certification Label  
located on the B-Pillar or the edge of the driver’s door. The total  
load on each axle must never exceed its GAWR.  
Note: For trailer towing information refer to Trailer towing found in  
this chapter or the RV and Trailer Towing Guide provided by your  
authorized dealer.  
GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight) – is the Vehicle Curb Weight + cargo +  
passengers.  
GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating) – is the maximum allowable  
weight of the fully loaded vehicle (including all options, equipment,  
passengers and cargo). The GVWR is shown on the Safety  
Compliance Certification Label located on the B-Pillar or the  
edge of the driver’s door. The GVW must never exceed the GVWR.  
201  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Example only:  
WARNING: Exceeding the Safety Compliance Certification Label  
vehicle weight rating limits could result in substandard vehicle  
handling or performance, engine, transmission and/or structural  
damage, serious damage to the vehicle, loss of control and personal  
injury.  
202  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
GCW (Gross Combined Weight) – is the weight of the loaded vehicle  
(GVW) plus the weight of the fully loaded trailer.  
GCWR (Gross Combined Weight Rating) – is the maximum allowable  
weight of the vehicle and the loaded trailer – including all cargo and  
passengers – that the vehicle can handle without risking damage.  
(Important: The towing vehicle’s braking system is rated for operation at  
GVWR, not at GCWR.) Separate functional brakes should be used for  
safe control of towed vehicles and for trailers where the GCW of the  
towing vehicle plus the trailer exceed the GVWR of the towing vehicle.  
The GCW must never exceed the GCWR.  
Maximum Loaded Trailer Weight – is the highest possible weight of a  
fully loaded trailer the vehicle can tow. It assumes a vehicle with only  
mandatory options, no cargo (internal or external), a tongue load of  
10–15% (conventional trailer) or king pin weight of 15–25% (fifth wheel  
trailer), and driver only (150 lb. [68 kg]). Consult your authorized  
dealer (or the RV and Trailer Towing Guide provided by your  
authorized dealer) for more detailed information.  
Tongue Load or Fifth Wheel King Pin Weight – refers to the amount  
of the weight that a trailer pushes down on a trailer hitch.  
Examples: For a 5,000 lb. (2,268 kg) conventional trailer, multiply 5,000  
by 0.10 and 0.15 to obtain a proper tongue load range of 500 to 750 lb.  
(227 to 340 kg). For an 11,500 lb. (5,216 kg) fifth wheel trailer, multiply  
by 0.15 and 0.25 to obtain a proper king pin load range of 1,725 to  
2,875 lb. (782 to 1,304 kg)  
WARNING: Do not exceed the GVWR or the GAWR specified on  
the Safety Compliance Certification Label.  
WARNING: Do not use replacement tires with lower load  
carrying capacities than the original tires because they may  
lower the vehicle’s GVWR and GAWR limitations. Replacement tires  
with a higher limit than the original tires do not increase the GVWR  
and GAWR limitations.  
203  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
WARNING: Exceeding any vehicle weight rating limitation could  
result in serious damage to the vehicle and/or personal injury.  
Steps for determining the correct load limit:  
1. Locate the statement “The combined weight of occupants and cargo  
should never exceed XXX kg or XXX lb.” on your vehicle’s placard.  
2. Determine the combined weight of the driver and passengers that will  
be riding in your vehicle.  
3. Subtract the combined weight of the driver and passengers from XXX  
kg or XXX lb.  
4. The resulting figure equals the available amount of cargo and luggage  
load capacity. For example, if the “XXX” amount equals 1,400 lb. and  
there will be five 150 lb. passengers in your vehicle, the amount of  
available cargo and luggage load capacity is 650 lb. (1400-750 (5 x 150) =  
650 lb.). In metric units (635-340 (5 x 68) = 295 kg.)  
5. Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo being loaded on  
the vehicle. That weight may not safely exceed the available cargo and  
luggage load capacity calculated in Step 4.  
6. If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, load from your trailer will be  
transferred to your vehicle. Consult this manual to determine how this  
reduces the available cargo and luggage load capacity of your vehicle.  
The following gives you a few examples on how to calculate the available  
amount of cargo and luggage load capacity:  
Another example for your vehicle with 1,400 lb. (635 kg) of cargo and  
luggage capacity. You decide to go golfing. Is there enough load  
capacity to carry you, 4 of your friends and all the golf bags? You and  
four friends average 220 lb. (99 kg) each and the golf bags weigh  
approximately 30 lb. (13.5 kg) each. The calculation would be: 1400 -  
(5 x 220) - (5 x 30) = 1400 - 1100 - 150 = 150 lb. Yes, you have  
enough load capacity in your vehicle to transport four friends and  
your golf bags. In metric units, the calculation would be: 635 kg - (5 x  
99 kg) - (5 x 13.5 kg) = 635 - 495 - 67.5 = 72.5 kg.  
A final example for your vehicle with 1,400 lb. (635 kg) of cargo and  
luggage capacity. You and one of your friends decide to pick up  
cement from the local home improvement store to finish that patio  
you have been planning for the past 2 years. Measuring the inside of  
the vehicle with the rear seat folded down, you have room for  
12-100 lb. (45 kg) bags of cement. Do you have enough load capacity  
204  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
to transport the cement to your home? If you and your friend each  
weigh 220 lb. (99 kg), the calculation would be: 1400 - (2 x 220) - (12  
x 100) = 1400 - 440 - 1200 = - 240 lb. No, you do not have enough  
cargo capacity to carry that much weight. In metric units, the  
calculation would be: 635 kg - (2 x 99 kg) - (12 x 45 kg) = 635 - 198 -  
540 = -103 kg. You will need to reduce the load weight by at least  
240 lb. (104 kg). If you remove 3-100 lb. (45 kg) cement bags, then  
the load calculation would be:  
1400 - (2 x 220) - (9 x 100) = 1400 - 440 - 900 = 60 lb. Now you have  
the load capacity to transport the cement and your friend home. In  
metric units, the calculation would be: 635 kg - (2 x 99 kg) - (9 x  
45 kg) = 635 - 198 - 405 = 32 kg.  
The above calculations also assume that the loads are positioned in your  
vehicle in a manner that does not overload the Front or the Rear Gross  
Axle Weight Rating specified for your vehicle on the Safety Compliance  
Certification Label found on the edge of the driver’s door.  
Special loading instructions for owners of pick-up trucks and  
utility-type vehicles  
WARNING: For important information regarding safe operation  
of this type of vehicle, see the Preparing to drive your vehicle  
section in the Driving chapter of this owner’s guide.  
WARNING: Loaded vehicles may handle differently than  
unloaded vehicles. Extra precautions, such as slower speeds and  
increased stopping distance, should be taken when driving a heavily  
loaded vehicle.  
Your vehicle can haul more cargo and people than most passenger cars.  
Depending upon the type and placement of the load, hauling cargo and  
people may raise the center of gravity of the vehicle.  
TRAILER TOWING  
Trailer towing with your vehicle may require the use of a trailer tow  
option package.  
Trailer towing puts additional loads on your vehicle’s engine,  
transmission, axle, brakes, tires and suspension. For your safety and to  
maximize vehicle performance, be sure to use the proper equipment  
while towing.  
205  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Follow these guidelines to ensure safe towing:  
Do not tow a trailer until your vehicle has been driven at least  
1,000 miles (1,600 km).  
Consult your local motor vehicle laws for towing a trailer.  
Refer to the instructions included with towing accessories for the  
proper installation and adjustment specifications.  
Thoroughly prepare your vehicle for towing. Refer to Preparing to  
tow in this chapter.  
Stay within your vehicle’s load limits.  
Use extra caution when driving while trailer towing. Refer to Driving  
while you tow in this chapter.  
Service your vehicle more frequently if you tow a trailer. Refer to  
Special operating conditions in the Scheduled Maintenance Guide  
chapter.  
For load specification terms found on the label and instructions on  
calculating your vehicle’s load, refer to Vehicle loading - with and  
without a trailer in this chapter. Remember to figure in the tongue load  
of your loaded trailer when figuring the total weight.  
Powertrain  
Maximum GCWR -  
lb (kg)  
Maximum Trailer  
Weight - lb (kg)  
1000 (454)  
2WD 2.5L  
4WD 2.5L  
4880 (2214)  
5040 (2286)  
1000 (454)  
Notes:  
– For high altitude operation, reduce GCW by 2% per 1000 ft (300 m)  
elevation.  
– Your vehicle is capable of pulling the maximum trailer weight(s) as  
specified above; the combined weight of the completed towing vehicle  
and the loaded trailer must not exceed the GCWR.  
– Maximum trailer frontal area should not exceed 24 ft2 (2.2 m2).  
– Certain states require electric trailer brakes for trailers over a  
specified weight. Be sure to check state regulations for this specified  
weight. The maximum trailer weights listed above may be limited to  
this specified weight, as the vehicle’s electrical system does not include  
the wiring connector needed to activate electric trailer brakes.  
WARNING: Do not exceed the GVWR or the GAWR specified on  
the certification label.  
206  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
WARNING: Towing trailers beyond the maximum recommended  
gross trailer weight exceeds the limit of the vehicle and could  
result in engine damage, transmission damage, structural damage, loss  
of vehicle control, vehicle rollover and personal injury.  
Preparing to tow  
Use the proper equipment for towing a trailer and make sure it is  
properly attached to your vehicle. Contact your authorized dealer or a  
reliable trailer dealer as soon as possible if you require assistance.  
Hitches  
Do not use hitches that clamp onto the vehicle bumper; use a load  
carrying hitch. You must distribute the load in your trailer so that  
10–15% of the total weight of the trailer is on the tongue.  
Safety chains  
Always connect the trailer’s safety chains to the hook retainers on the  
vehicle. To connect the trailer’s safety chains, cross the chains under the  
trailer tongue and allow slack for turning corners.  
If you use a rental trailer, follow the instructions that the rental agency  
gives to you.  
Do not attach safety chains to the bumper.  
Trailer brakes  
Electric brakes and manual, automatic or surge-type trailer brakes are  
safe if installed properly and adjusted to the manufacturer’s  
specifications. The trailer brakes must meet local and Federal  
regulations.  
WARNING: Do not connect a trailer’s hydraulic brake system  
directly to your vehicle’s brake system. Your vehicle may not  
have enough braking power and your chances of having a collision  
greatly increase.  
The braking system of the tow vehicle is rated for operation at the  
GVWR not GCWR.  
207  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Trailer lamps  
Trailer lamps are required on most towed vehicles. Make sure all running  
lights, brake lights, turn signals and hazard lights are working. Do not  
connect trailer lamps directly to your vehicle’s tail lamps. This can cause  
damage to your vehicle’s electrical system. Contact your authorized  
dealer or trailer rental agency for proper instructions and equipment for  
hooking-up trailer lamps.  
WARNING: Never connect any trailer lighting to the vehicle’s  
tail lamp circuits, because it may damage the electrical system  
resulting in fire. Contact your authorized dealer as soon as possible for  
assistance in proper trailer tow wiring installation. Additional electrical  
equipment may be required.  
Driving while you tow  
When towing a trailer:  
Do not drive faster than 70 mph (113 km/h) during the first 500 miles  
(800 km) of trailer towing and don’t make full-throttle starts.  
Turn off the speed control. The speed control may shut off  
automatically when you are towing on long, steep grades.  
Allow more distance for stopping with a trailer attached; anticipate  
stops and brake gradually.  
Servicing after towing  
If you tow a trailer for long distances, your vehicle will require more  
frequent service intervals. Refer to Special operating conditions in the  
Scheduled Maintenance Guide chapter.  
208  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Trailer towing tips  
Practice turning, stopping and backing-up before starting on a trip to  
get the feel of the vehicle-trailer combination. When turning, make  
wider turns so the trailer wheels will clear curbs and other obstacles.  
To aid in engine/transmission cooling and A/C efficiency during hot  
weather while stopped in traffic, place the gearshift lever in P (Park).  
After you have traveled 50 miles (80 km), thoroughly check your  
hitch, electrical connections and trailer wheel lug nuts.  
If you are driving down a long or steep hill, shift to a lower gear. Do  
not apply the brakes continuously, as they may overheat and become  
less effective.  
Vehicles with trailers should not be parked on a grade. If you must  
park on a grade, place wheel chocks under the trailer’s wheels.  
Launching or retrieving a boat  
Disconnect the wiring to the trailer before backing the trailer  
into the water. Reconnect the wiring to the trailer after the  
trailer is removed from the water.  
When backing down a ramp during boat launching or retrieval:  
Do not allow the static water level to rise above the bottom edge of  
the rear bumper.  
Do not allow waves to break higher than 6 in (15 cm) above the  
bottom edge of the rear bumper.  
Exceeding these limits may allow water to enter vehicle components:  
Causing internal damage to the components.  
Affecting driveability, emissions and reliability.  
Replace the rear axle lubricant any time the axle has been submerged in  
water. Rear axle lubricant quantities are not to be checked or changed  
unless a leak is suspected or repair required.  
209  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
RECREATIONAL TOWING  
An example of “recreational towing” is towing your vehicle behind a  
motorhome.  
Note: Put your climate control system in recirculated air mode to  
prevent exhaust fumes from entering the vehicle. Refer to the Climate  
Controls chapter for more information.  
Note: If you tow your vehicle with all four wheels on the ground, follow  
these instructions:  
Tow only in the forward direction.  
Release the parking brake.  
Place the transmission shift lever in N (Neutral).  
Place the ignition to the accessory position (refer to Starting in the  
Driving chapter).  
Your vehicle may be towed up to a speed of 75 mph (120 km/h), but  
you should always obey local speed limits.  
You also have the option of trailering the vehicle with its front wheels on  
a dolly (FWD only), or trailering with all four wheels off the ground. Do  
not tow your four–wheel drive (4WD) vehicle with the front  
wheels off the ground and the rear wheels on the ground (such as  
with the use of a tow dolly). This will cause damage to your 4WD  
system.  
For other towing requirements, refer to Wrecker towing in the Roadside  
Emergencies chapter.  
210  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
STARTING  
Positions of the ignition  
1. Off— locks the gearshift lever  
and allows key removal.  
2. Accessory— allows the electrical  
accessories such as the radio to  
operate while the vehicle is not  
running.  
3. On— all electrical circuits  
operational and warning lights will  
illuminate. This is the position the  
key is in when you’re driving.  
4. Start— starts the vehicle and electrical power systems.  
Preparing to start your vehicle  
Engine starting is controlled by the electronically-controlled  
Continuously Variable Transaxle (eCVT). For more information on  
starting the vehicle, refer to Starting the vehicle in this chapter.  
WARNING: Extended idling at high engine speeds can produce  
very high temperatures in the engine and exhaust system,  
creating the risk of fire or other damage.  
WARNING: Do not park, idle, or drive your vehicle in dry grass  
or other dry ground cover. The emission system heats up the  
engine compartment and exhaust system, which can start a fire.  
WARNING: Do not start your vehicle in a closed garage or in  
other enclosed areas. Exhaust fumes can be toxic. Always open  
the garage door before you start the engine. See Guarding against  
exhaust fumes in this chapter for more instructions.  
WARNING: If you smell exhaust fumes inside your vehicle, have  
your dealer inspect your vehicle immediately. Do not drive if you  
smell exhaust fumes.  
211  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Important safety precautions  
A computer system controls the engine’s idle revolutions per minute  
(RPM). When the engine starts, the idle RPM runs higher than normal in  
order to warm the engine. If the engine idle speed does not slow down  
automatically, have the vehicle checked.  
Before starting the vehicle:  
1. Make sure all vehicle occupants have buckled their safety belts. For  
more information on safety belts and their proper usage, refer to the  
Seating and Safety Restraints chapter.  
2. Make sure vehicle accessories are off.  
Make sure the parking brake is  
set.  
Make sure the gearshift lever is in  
P (Park).  
212  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
3. Turn the key to 3 (on) without  
turning the key to 4 (start).  
Some warning lights will briefly illuminate. See Warning lights and  
chimes in the Instrument Cluster chapter for more information  
regarding the warning lights.  
Starting the vehicle  
1. Turn the key to 3 (on) without  
turning the key to 4 (start). If there  
is difficulty in turning the key,  
rotate the steering wheel until the  
key turns freely. This condition may  
occur when:  
the front wheels are turned  
a front wheel is against the curb  
2. Turn the key to 4 (start), then  
release the key. After releasing the  
key from the 4 (start) position, a  
vehicle symbol (called the Ready  
Indicator Light) will illuminate in  
the instrument cluster to indicate the vehicle is ready to drive. This light  
will remain on while the vehicle is on, whether the engine is running or  
not, to indicate the vehicle is capable of movement (using its electric  
motor, engine, or both). The vehicle’s computer will determine if an  
engine start is required at key-on. The engine will start if it is necessary  
for cabin heating or windshield defrost. The engine will also be started  
when ambient temperatures are low. Note: The vehicle may be turned  
off at any time by turning the key to the off position.  
3. Once the “Ready Indicator Light” is on, apply the brake, release the  
parking brake, shift into gear and drive.  
213  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
Note: If the engine fails to start when it should, which is indicated by  
the service engine soon  
light , put the gearshift lever into P (Park),  
turn the ignition off, then attempt to start the vehicle again. If the  
vehicle still does not start, it may require refueling, jump starting,  
resetting of the fuel pump/high voltage shut-off switches or service. For  
information on jump starting the vehicle and resetting the fuel  
pump/high voltage shut-off switches, refer to the Jump starting (low  
voltage [underhood] battery only) section and the Fuel pump/High  
voltage shut-off switches section found in the Roadside Emergencies  
chapter.  
Guarding against exhaust fumes  
Carbon monoxide is present in exhaust fumes. Take precautions to avoid  
its dangerous effects.  
WARNING: If you smell exhaust fumes inside your vehicle, have  
your dealer inspect your vehicle immediately. Do not drive if you  
smell exhaust fumes.  
Important ventilating information  
If the engine is idling while the vehicle is stopped for a long period of  
time, open the windows at least 1 inch (2.5 cm) or adjust the heating or  
air conditioning to bring in fresh air.  
ENGINE BLOCK HEATER (IF EQUIPPED)  
An engine block heater warms the engine coolant which aids in starting  
and allows the heater/defroster system to respond quickly. If your vehicle  
is equipped with this system, your equipment includes a heater element  
which is installed in your engine block and a wire harness which allows  
the user to connect the system to a grounded 120 volt A/C electrical  
source. The block heater system is most effective when outdoor  
temperatures reach below 0°F (-18°C).  
WARNING: Failure to follow engine block heater instructions  
could result in property damage or physical injury.  
WARNING: To reduce the risk of electrical shock, do not use  
your heater with ungrounded electrical systems or two-pronged  
(cheater) adapters.  
214  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Prior to using the engine block heater, follow these recommendations for  
proper and safe operation:  
For your safety, use an outdoor extension cord that is product  
certified by Underwriter’s Laboratory (UL) or Canadian Standards  
Association (CSA). Use only an extension cord that can be used  
outdoors, in cold temperatures, and is clearly marked “Suitable for Use  
with Outdoor Appliances.” Never use an indoor extension cord  
outdoors; it could result in an electric shock or fire hazard.  
Use a 16-gauge outdoor extension cord, minimum.  
Use as short an extension cord as possible.  
Do not use multiple extension cords. Instead, use one extension cord  
which is long enough to reach from the engine block heater cord to  
the outlet without stretching.  
Make certain that the extension cord is in excellent condition (not  
patched or spliced). Store your extension cord indoors at  
temperatures above 32°F (0°C). Outdoor conditions can deteriorate  
extension cords over a period of time.  
To reduce the risk of electrical shock, do not use your heater with  
ungrounded electrical systems or two pronged (cheater) adapters.  
Also ensure that the block heater, especially the cord, is in good  
condition before use.  
Make sure that when in operation, the extension cord plug/engine  
block heater cord plug connection is free and clear of water in order  
to prevent possible shock or fire.  
Be sure that areas where the vehicle is parked are clean and clear of  
all combustibles such as petroleum products, dust, rags, paper and  
similar items.  
Be sure that the engine block heater, heater cord and extension cord  
are solidly connected. A poor connection can cause the cord to  
become very hot and may result in an electrical shock or fire. Be sure  
to check for heat anywhere in the electrical hookup once the system  
has been operating for approximately a half hour.  
Finally, have the engine block heater system checked during your fall  
tune-up to be sure it’s in good working order.  
How to use the engine block heater  
Ensure the receptacle terminals are clean and dry prior to use. To clean  
them, use a dry cloth.  
Depending on the type of factory installed equipment, your engine block  
heater will use .4 to 1.0 kilowatt-hours of energy per hour of use. Your  
215  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
factory installed block heater system does not have a thermostat;  
however, maximum temperature is attained after approximately three  
hours of operation. Block heater operation longer than three hours will  
not improve system performance and will unnecessarily use additional  
electricity.  
Make sure system is unplugged and properly stowed before driving the  
vehicle. While not in use, make sure the protective cover seals the  
prongs of the engine block heater cord plug.  
BRAKES  
Occasional brake noise is normal. If a metal-to-metal, continuous grinding  
or continuous squeal sound is present, the brake linings may be worn-out  
and should be inspected by an authorized dealer. If the vehicle has  
continuous vibration or shudder in the steering wheel while braking, the  
vehicle should be inspected by an authorized dealer.  
Refer to Warning lights and  
!
P
chimes in the Instrument Cluster  
chapter for information on the brake  
system warning light.  
BRAKE  
Under normal operating conditions, brake dust may accumulate on the  
wheels. Some brake dust is inevitable as brakes wear and does not  
contribute to brake noise. The use of modern friction materials with  
emphasis on improved performance and environmental considerations  
can lead to more dust than in the past. Brake dust can be cleaned by  
weekly washing with soapy water and a soft sponge. Heavier deposits can  
be removed with MotorcraftWheel and Tire Cleaner (ZC-37–A).  
Four-wheel anti-lock brake system (ABS)  
Your vehicle is equipped with an anti-lock braking system (ABS). This  
system helps you maintain steering control during emergency stops by  
keeping the brakes from locking. Noise from the ABS pump motor and  
brake pedal pulsation may be observed during ABS braking and the  
brake pedal may suddenly travel a little farther as soon as ABS braking is  
done and normal brake operation resumes. These are normal  
characteristics of the ABS and should be no reason for concern.  
Using ABS  
When hard braking is required, apply continuous force on the brake  
pedal. Do not pump the brake pedal since this will reduce the  
effectiveness of the ABS and will increase your vehicle’s stopping  
216  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
distance. The ABS will be activated immediately, allowing you to retain  
steering control during hard braking and on slippery surfaces. However,  
the ABS does not decrease stopping distance.  
ABS warning lamp  
The ABS lamp in the instrument  
cluster momentarily illuminates  
ABS  
when the ignition is turned on. If  
the light does not illuminate during  
start up, remains on or flashes, the  
ABS may be disabled and may need to be serviced.  
Even when the ABS is disabled,  
normal braking is still effective. If  
your BRAKE warning lamp  
illuminates with the parking brake  
released, have your brake system  
serviced immediately by an authorized dealer.  
!
P
BRAKE  
Regenerative Braking System (RBS)  
Your vehicle uses a feature known as regenerative braking. This is used  
to simulate the engine braking of an internal combustion engine and  
assist the standard brake system while recovering some of the energy of  
motion and storing it in the battery to improve fuel economy. The  
standard brake system is designed to fully stop the car if regenerative  
braking is not available. During regenerative braking, the motor is spun  
as a generator to create electrical current. This recharges the high  
voltage battery and slows the vehicle. In effect, once the accelerator  
pedal is released, the motor changes from an energy user to an energy  
producer.  
When the accelerator pedal is released or the brake pedal is applied, the  
brake controller automatically detects the amount of deceleration  
requested and optimizes how much of the deceleration will be produced  
by regenerative braking. The remaining portion is generated by standard  
friction braking. When the battery is almost fully charged, the amount of  
regenerative braking is limited to avoid overcharging, and the requested  
deceleration is produced by standard friction braking alone.  
Regenerative braking does not take the place of the standard friction  
brakes; it only assists them. Regenerative braking has also been designed  
to interact with the anti-lock brake system (ABS). Regenerative braking  
is disabled when the ABS is activated or the battery is fully charged.  
217  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Parking brake  
Apply the parking brake whenever  
the vehicle is parked. To set the  
parking brake, press the parking  
brake pedal down until the pedal  
stops.  
The BRAKE warning lamp in the  
instrument cluster illuminates and  
remains illuminated (when the  
ignition is turned on) until the  
parking brake is released.  
!
P
BRAKE  
WARNING: If the parking brake is fully released, but the brake  
warning lamp remains illuminated, the brakes may not be  
working properly. See your authorized dealer.  
WARNING: Always set the parking brake fully and make sure  
that the gearshift is securely latched in P (Park).  
The parking brake is not recommended to stop a moving vehicle.  
However, if the normal brakes fail, the parking brake can be used to stop  
your vehicle in an emergency. Since the parking brake applies only the  
rear brakes, the vehicle’s stopping distance will increase greatly and the  
handling of your vehicle will be adversely affected.  
218  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Pull the release lever to release the  
brake. Driving with the parking  
brake on will cause the brakes to  
wear out quickly and reduce fuel  
economy.  
ADVANCETRACWITH ROLL STABILITY CONTROL™ (RSC)  
STABILITY ENHANCEMENT SYSTEM  
The AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem provides the following stability  
enhancement features for certain driving situations:  
Traction control (TCS), which functions to help avoid drive-wheel spin  
and loss of traction  
Electronic stability control (ESC), which functions to help avoid skids  
or lateral slides  
Roll Stability Control™ (RSC), which functions to help avoid a  
vehicle roll-over  
WARNING: Vehicle modifications involving braking system,  
aftermarket roof racks, suspension, steering system, tire  
construction and/or wheel/tire size may change the handling  
characteristics of the vehicle and may adversely affect the performance  
of the AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem. In addition, installing any  
stereo loudspeakers may interfere with and adversely affect the  
AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem. Install any aftermarket stereo  
loudspeaker as far as possible from the front center console, the  
tunnel, and the front seats in order to minimize the risk of interfering  
with the AdvanceTracwith RSCsensors. Reducing the effectiveness  
of the AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem could lead to an increased risk  
of loss of vehicle control, vehicle rollover, personal injury and death.  
219  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
WARNING: Remember that even advanced technology cannot  
defy the laws of physics. It’s always possible to lose control of a  
vehicle due to inappropriate driver input for the conditions. Aggressive  
driving on any road condition can cause you to lose control of your  
vehicle increasing the risk of personal injury or property damage.  
Activation of the AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem is an indication that  
at least some of the tires have exceeded their ability to grip the road;  
this could reduce the operator’s ability to control the vehicle,  
potentially resulting in a loss of vehicle control, vehicle rollover,  
personal injury and death. If your AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem  
activates, SLOW DOWN.  
WARNING: If a failure has been detected within the  
AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem, the stability control light will  
illuminate steadily. Have the system serviced by an authorized dealer  
immediately. Operating your vehicle with AdvanceTracwith RSC௡  
disabled could lead to an increased risk of loss of vehicle control,  
vehicle rollover, personal injury and death.  
The AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem automatically enables each time  
the engine is started. All features of the AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem  
(TCS, ESC, and RSC) are active and monitor the vehicle from start-up.  
However, the system will only intervene if the driving situation requires  
it.  
The AdvanceTracwith RSC௡  
system includes a traction control  
off button on the instrument panel  
below the climate control, a stability  
control “OFF” light and a stability control light in the instrument cluster.  
The stability control light and stability control “OFF” light in the  
instrument cluster will illuminate temporarily during start-up as part of a  
normal system self-check, or during driving if a driving situation causes  
the AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem to operate. The stability control off  
light will illuminate if traction control or trailer sway control are disabled  
after pressing the TCS OFF switch. If the stability control light remains  
steadily illuminated, have the system serviced by an authorized dealer  
immediately.  
Note: If the system cannot be turned off, refer to MyKey™ in the Locks  
and Security chapter for more information.  
220  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
When AdvanceTracwith RSCperforms a normal system self-check,  
some drivers may notice a slight movement of the brake, and/or a  
rumble, grunting, or grinding noise after startup and when driving off.  
When an event occurs that activates AdvanceTracwith RSC, you may  
experience the following:  
A slight deceleration of the vehicle  
The stability control light will flash.  
A vibration in the pedal when your foot is on the brake pedal  
If the driving condition is severe and your foot is not on the brake, the  
brake pedal may move as the systems applies higher brake forces. You  
may also hear a whoosh of air from under the instrument panel during  
this severe condition.  
The brake pedal may feel stiffer than usual.  
Traction control (TCS)  
Traction control is a driver aid feature that helps your vehicle maintain  
traction of the wheels, typically when driving on slippery and/or hilly  
road surfaces, by detecting and controlling wheel spin.  
Excessive wheel spin is controlled in two ways, which may work  
separately or in tandem: engine traction control and brake traction  
control. Engine traction control works to limit drive-wheel spin by  
momentarily reducing engine power. Brake traction control works to limit  
wheel spin by momentarily applying the brakes to the wheel that is  
slipping. Traction control is most active at low speeds.  
During traction control events, the stability control light in the  
instrument cluster will flash.  
If the traction control system is activated excessively in a short period of  
time, the braking portion of the system may become temporarily disabled  
to allow the brakes to cool down. In this situation, traction control will  
use only engine power reduction or transfer to help control the wheels  
from over-spinning. When the brakes have cooled down, the system will  
regain all features. Anti-lock braking, RSC, and ESC are not affected by  
this condition and will continue to function during the cool-down period.  
The engine traction control and brake traction control system may be  
deactivated in certain situations. See the Switching off traction control  
section below.  
Electronic stability control (ESC)  
Electronic stability control (ESC) may enhance your vehicle’s directional  
stability during adverse maneuvers, for example when cornering severely  
221  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
or avoiding objects in the roadway. ESC operates by applying brakes to  
one or more of the wheels individually and, if necessary, reducing engine  
power if the system detects that the vehicle is about to skid or slide  
laterally.  
During electronic stability control events, the stability control light in the  
instrument cluster will flash.  
Certain adverse driving maneuvers may activate the electronic stability  
control system, which include but are not limited to:  
Taking a turn too fast  
Maneuvering quickly to avoid an accident, pedestrian or obstacle  
Driving over a patch of ice or other slippery surfaces  
Changing lanes on a snow-rutted road  
Entering a snow-free road from a snow-covered side street, or vice  
versa  
Entering a paved road from a gravel road, or vice versa  
Cornering while towing a heavily loaded trailer (refer to Trailer  
towing in the Tires, Wheels and Loading chapter).  
Roll Stability Control™ (RSC)  
Roll Stability Control (RSC) may help to maintain roll stability of the  
vehicle during adverse maneuvers. RSCoperates by detecting the  
vehicle’s roll motion and the rate at which it changes and by applying the  
brakes to one or more wheels individually.  
During an event that activates Roll Stability Control™ (RSC), the  
stability control light in the instrument cluster will flash.  
Certain adverse driving maneuvers may activate the RSCsystem, which  
include:  
Emergency lane-change  
Taking a turn too fast  
Quick maneuvering to avoid an accident, pedestrian or obstacle  
Switching off traction control  
If the vehicle is stuck in snow, mud or sand, and seems to lose engine  
power, switching off the traction control features of the AdvanceTrac௡  
with RSCsystem may be beneficial because the wheels are allowed to  
spin. This will restore full engine power and will enhance momentum  
through the obstacle. To switch off the traction control, press the  
traction control off button. Full features of the stability control system  
222  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
can be restored by pressing the traction control off button again, or by  
turning off and restarting the engine.  
If you switch off the traction control, the stability control “OFF” light will  
illuminate steadily. Pressing the stability control off button again will turn  
off the stability control “OFF” light.  
In R (Reverse), ABS and the engine and brake traction control features  
will continue to function; however, ESC and RSCare disabled.  
AdvanceTracwith RSCFeatures  
RSC/  
Stability  
control  
light  
Stability  
control  
“OFF”  
Button  
functions  
ESC/  
Traction  
control  
Trailer  
sway  
Illuminated  
during bulb  
check  
Not  
Illuminated  
Illuminated  
during bulb  
check  
Illuminated  
solid  
Default at  
start-up  
Enabled  
Enabled1  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Enabled2  
Button pressed  
momentarily  
Button pressed  
again after  
Not  
illuminated  
Not  
illuminated  
deactivation  
1
When the AdvanceTracbutton is pressed momentarily, traction  
control is disabled.  
2
When the AdvanceTracbutton is pressed and held for more than five  
seconds, trailer sway control is disabled.  
Trailer sway control (if equipped)  
Your vehicle may be equipped with trailer sway control (TSC). When  
properly equipped, trailer sway control will use the sensors of the  
vehicle’s AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem to detect and attempt to  
mitigate trailer sway by applying brake force at individual wheels and, if  
necessary, by reducing engine power. No driver action is required.  
223  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
WARNING: Trailer sway control does not prevent a trailer from  
swaying, it mitigates the sway from increasing once it has  
occurred. TSC cannot stop all trailers from swaying. If you are  
experiencing trailer sway, it is likely that the trailer is improperly  
loaded for the correct tongue weight or the speed of the vehicle and  
trailer is too high. Pull the vehicle-trailer over to a safe location to  
check the trailer weight distribution and tongue load and reduce speed  
to a safe level while towing. If trailer sway is experienced, SLOW  
DOWN. Always use caution when towing a trailer and follow the  
tongue weight recommendations. Refer to the Trailer towing section  
in the Tires Wheels and Loading chapter of this owner’s guide for  
more information on towing a trailer with your vehicle.  
During trailer sway control events, the stability control light in the  
instrument cluster will flash momentarily. In some cases, when trailer  
sway is detected, the vehicle speed is too high and may be at or above a  
speed at which trailer sway will grow continuously. This may cause the  
system to activate multiple times, and you may experience a slight  
deceleration of the vehicle.  
Disabling trailer sway control  
Trailer sway control can be disabled during any key cycle. Pressing and  
holding the stability control button for more than five seconds will  
disable the trailer sway control feature and the stability control light will  
flash momentarily and then illuminate solid for that ignition cycle. Trailer  
sway control can be re-enabled by momentarily pressing the stability  
control button. Trailer sway control will also be re-enabled at each new  
key cycle.  
WARNING: Turning off trailer sway control increases the risk of  
loss of vehicle control, serious injury, or death. Ford does not  
recommend disabling this feature except in situations where speed  
reduction may be detrimental (e.g., hill climbing), the driver has  
significant trailer towing experience, and can control trailer sway and  
maintain safe operation.  
STEERING  
Your vehicle is equipped with an electric power-assisted steering (EPAS)  
system. There is no fluid reservoir to check or fill.  
If your vehicle loses electrical power while you are driving (or if the  
ignition is turned off), you can steer the vehicle manually, but it takes  
224  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
more effort. Under extreme usage conditions, the steering effort may  
increase. This occurs to prevent overheating and permanent damage to  
your steering system. If this should occur, you will neither lose the ability  
to steer the vehicle manually nor will it cause permanent damage.  
Typical steering and driving maneuvers will allow the system to cool and  
steering assist will return to normal.  
If the steering wanders or pulls, check for:  
an improperly inflated tire.  
uneven tire wear.  
loose or worn suspension components.  
loose or worn steering components.  
improper steering alignment.  
A high crown in the road or high crosswinds may also make the steering  
seem to wander/pull.  
PREPARING TO DRIVE  
WARNING: Utility vehicles have a significantly higher rollover  
rate than other types of vehicles.  
WARNING: In a rollover crash, an unbelted person is  
significantly more likely to die than a person wearing a seat belt.  
Utility vehicles and trucks have larger tires and increased ground  
clearance, giving the vehicle a higher center of gravity than a passenger  
car.  
WARNING: Vehicles with a higher center of gravity such as  
utility vehicles and trucks handle differently than vehicles with a  
lower center of gravity. Utility vehicles and trucks are not designed for  
cornering at speeds as high as passenger cars any more than low-slung  
sports cars are designed to perform satisfactorily under off-road  
conditions. Avoid sharp turns, excessive speed or abrupt maneuvers in  
these vehicles. Failure to drive cautiously could result in an increased  
risk of loss of vehicle control, vehicle rollover, personal injury and  
death.  
225  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
WARNING: Loaded vehicles, with a higher center of gravity,  
may handle differently than unloaded vehicles. Do not overload  
your vehicle and use extra precautions, such as driving at slower  
speeds, avoiding abrupt steering changes and allowing for increased  
stopping distance, when driving a heavily loaded vehicle. Over-loading  
or loading the vehicle improperly can deteriorate handling capability  
and contribute to loss of vehicle control and vehicle rollover.  
BRAKE-SHIFT INTERLOCK  
This vehicle is equipped with a brake-shift interlock feature that prevents  
the gearshift lever from being moved from P (Park) when the ignition is  
in the on position unless brake pedal is pressed.  
If you cannot move the gearshift lever out of P (Park) with ignition in  
the on position and the brake pedal pressed, it is possible that a fuse has  
blown or the vehicle’s brake lamps are not operating properly. Refer to  
Fuses and relays in the Roadside Emergencies chapter.  
If the fuse is not blown, perform the following procedure:  
1. Apply the parking brake.  
2. Using a screwdriver or similar  
tool, carefully pry out the small  
Brake Transmission Shift Interlock  
(BTSI) cover cap located to the  
right of the gearshift lever.  
3. Press the brake pedal and then  
start the vehicle.  
4. Insert a screwdriver or similar  
tool straight down into the access  
hole and press downward while  
pulling the gearshift lever out of the  
P (Park) position and into the N  
(Neutral) position.  
5. Remove tool and reinstall BTSI cover cap.  
6. Release the parking brake and drive normally.  
226  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
WARNING: Do not drive your vehicle until you verify that the  
brake lamps are working.  
WARNING: Always set the parking brake fully and make sure  
the gearshift is latched in P (Park). Turn the ignition to the off  
position and remove the key whenever you leave your vehicle.  
WARNING: If the parking brake is fully released, but the brake  
warning lamp remains illuminated, the brakes may not be  
working properly. See your authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION OPERATION  
Understanding the gearshift positions of the  
electronically-controlled Continuously Variable Transmission  
(eCVT)  
P (Park)  
This position locks the transmission  
and prevents the front wheels from  
turning.  
To put your vehicle in gear:  
1. Start the engine  
2. Release the parking brake  
3. Press the brake pedal  
4. Move the gearshift lever into the  
desired gear  
To put your vehicle in P (Park):  
1. Come to a complete stop  
2. Move the gearshift lever and  
securely latch it in P (Park)  
WARNING: Always set the parking brake fully and make sure  
the gearshift is latched in P (Park). Turn the ignition to the off  
position and remove the key whenever you leave your vehicle.  
227  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
R (Reverse)  
With the gearshift lever in R (Reverse), the vehicle will move backward.  
Always come to a complete stop before shifting into and out of R  
(Reverse).  
N (Neutral)  
With the gearshift lever in N (Neutral), the vehicle is free to roll; hold  
the brake pedal down while in this position. Because of the unique  
nature of the hybrid vehicle, the engine will not start in the N (Neutral)  
position.  
The vehicle does not charge the high voltage battery in the N (Neutral)  
position. Do not idle the vehicle in N (Neutral) for extended periods as  
this will discharge your high voltage battery.  
D (Drive)  
The normal driving position for the best fuel economy.  
L (Low)  
Provides maximum engine braking.  
The transmission may be shifted into L (Low) at any vehicle speed.  
WARNING: When parking, do not use the gearshift in place of  
the parking brake. Always set the parking brake fully and make  
sure that the gearshift is securely latched in P (Park). Turn off the  
ignition whenever you leave your vehicle. Never leave your vehicle  
unattended while it is running. If you do not take these precautions,  
your vehicle may move unexpectedly and injure someone.  
If your vehicle gets stuck in mud or snow  
If your vehicle gets stuck in mud or snow, it may be rocked out by  
shifting between forward and reverse gears, stopping between shifts in a  
steady pattern. Press lightly on the accelerator in each gear.  
Do not rock the vehicle if the engine is not at normal operating  
temperature or damage to the transmission may occur.  
Do not rock the vehicle for more than a minute or damage to the  
transmission and tires may occur, or the engine may overheat.  
228  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
REVERSE SENSING SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)  
The reverse sensing system (RSS) sounds a tone to warn the driver of  
obstacles near the rear bumper when R (Reverse) is selected and the  
vehicle is moving at speeds less than 3 mph (5 km/h). The system is not  
effective at speeds above 3 mph (5 km/h) and may not detect certain  
angular or moving objects.  
WARNING: To help avoid personal injury, please read and  
understand the limitations of the reverse sensing system as  
contained in this section. Reverse sensing is only an aid for some  
(generally large and fixed) objects when moving in reverse on a flat  
surface at “parking speeds”. Inclement weather may also affect the  
function of the RSS; this may include reduced performance or a false  
activation.  
WARNING: To help avoid personal injury, always use caution  
when in reverse and when using the RSS.  
WARNING: This system is not designed to prevent contact with  
small or moving objects. The system is designed to provide a  
warning to assist the driver in detecting large stationary objects to  
avoid damaging the vehicle. The system may not detect smaller  
objects, particularly those close to the ground.  
WARNING: Certain add-on devices such as large trailer hitches,  
bike or surfboard racks and any device that may block the  
normal detection zone of the RSS system may create false beeps.  
229  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
The RSS detects obstacles up to  
6 feet (1.8 meters) from the rear  
bumper with a decreased coverage  
area at the outer corners of the  
bumper, (refer to the figures for  
approximate zone coverage areas).  
As you move closer to the obstacle,  
the rate of the tone increases. When  
the obstacle is less than 10 inches  
(25.0 cm) away, the tone will sound  
continuously. If the RSS detects a  
stationary or receding object further  
than 10 inches (25.0 cm) from the  
side of the vehicle, the tone will  
sound for only three seconds. Once  
the system detects an object  
approaching, the tone will sound  
again.  
While receiving a warning the radio volume will be reduced to a  
predetermined level. After the warning goes away, the radio will return  
to the previous value. The RSS automatically turns on when the gearshift  
lever is placed in R (Reverse) and the ignition is on. A control in the  
message center allows the driver to disable the system, refer to Message  
center in the Instrument Cluster chapter for more information.  
Note: If the system cannot be turned off, refer to MyKey™ in the Locks  
and Security chapter for more information.  
Keep the RSS sensors (located on the rear bumper/fascia) free  
from snow, ice and large accumulations of dirt (do not clean the  
sensors with sharp objects). If the sensors are covered, it will  
affect the accuracy of the RSS.  
If your vehicle sustains damage to the rear bumper/fascia, leaving  
it misaligned or bent, the sensing zone may be altered causing  
inaccurate measurement of obstacles or false alarms.  
230  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
REARVIEW CAMERA SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)  
The rearview camera system located  
on the liftgate provides a video  
image, which appears in the  
rearview mirror or on the navigation  
screen (if equipped), of the area  
behind the vehicle. It adds  
assistance to the driver while  
reversing or reverse parking the  
vehicle.  
To use the camera, place the transmission in R (Reverse); an image will  
display on the left portion of the rearview mirror or on the navigation  
screen (if equipped). The area displayed on the screen may vary  
according to the vehicle orientation and/or road condition.  
(1) Rear bumper  
(2) Red zone  
(3) Yellow zone  
(4) Green zone  
(5) Centerline of vehicle  
Always use caution while backing.  
Objects in the red zone are closest  
to your vehicle and objects in the  
green zone are further away. Objects  
are getting closer to your vehicle as they move from the green zone to  
the yellow or red zones.  
Use the side mirrors and rearview mirror to get better coverage on both  
sides and rear of the vehicle.  
Image delay if displayed through the rearview mirror:  
When shifting out of R (Reverse) and into any other gear, the image in  
the rearview mirror will remain on for a few seconds before it shuts off  
to assist in parking or trailer hookup.  
Image delay if displayed through the Navigation screen:  
After shifting out of R (Reverse) and into any gear other than P (Park),  
the image in the navigation screen will remain until the vehicle speed  
reaches 5 mph (8 km/h), only if the rear camera delay feature is on, or  
until any navigation radio button is pressed.  
231  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Note: The default setting for the camera delay is off. Press the  
“Settings” button found on the navigation screen (if equipped) to set the  
camera delay feature to on or off.  
When towing, the camera will only see what is being towed behind the  
vehicle; this might not provide adequate coverage as it usually provides  
in normal operation and some objects might not be seen.  
The lens for the camera is located on the liftgate. Keep the lens clean so  
the video image remains clear and undistorted. Clean the lens with a  
soft, lint-free cloth and non-abrasive cleaner.  
Note: If the camera image is not clear or seems distorted, it may be  
covered with water droplets, snow, mud or any other substance. If this  
occurs, clean the camera lens before using the reverse camera.  
WARNING: The camera is a reverse aid supplement device that  
still requires the driver to use it in conjunction with the rearview  
mirror and the side mirrors for maximum coverage.  
WARNING: Objects that are close to either corner of the  
bumper or under the bumper, might not be seen on the screen  
due to the limited coverage of the camera.  
WARNING: Backup as slow as possible since higher speeds  
might limit your reaction time to stop the vehicle.  
WARNING: Do not use the camera with the liftgate open.  
If the back end of the vehicle is hit or damaged, then check with your  
authorized dealer to have your camera checked for proper coverage and  
operation.  
Night time and dark area use  
At night time or in dark areas, the camera relies on the reverse lamp  
lighting to produce an image. Therefore it is necessary that both reverse  
lamps are operating in order to get a clear image in the dark. If either of  
the lamps are not operating, stop using the camera, at least in the dark,  
until the lamp(s) are replaced and functioning.  
Servicing  
If the image comes on while the vehicle is not in R (Reverse), have  
the camera inspected by your authorized dealer.  
232  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
If the image is not clear, then check if there is anything covering the  
lens such as dirt, mud, ice, snow, etc. If the image is still not clear  
after cleaning, have your camera inspected by your authorized dealer.  
ACTIVE PARK ASSIST (APA) (IF EQUIPPED)  
Active park assist (APA) will detect an available parallel parking space  
and automatically steer the vehicle into the space (hands free) while you  
control the accelerator, gearshift and brakes. The system will visually  
and/or audibly instruct the driver to park the vehicle.  
WARNING: This system is designed to be a supplementary park  
aid. It may not work in all conditions and is not intended to  
replace the driver’s attention and judgment. The driver is responsible  
for avoiding hazards and maintaining a safe distance and speed, even  
when the APA is in use.  
Conditions in which the systems may not work:  
Something passes between the front bumper and the space such as a  
pedestrian or cyclist  
The edge of the neighboring parked vehicle is high from the ground  
such as a bus, tow truck or flat bed truck  
Automatic search for parking space  
To start, press the APA control  
switch located on the instrument  
panel. The message center will  
display ACTIVE PARK SEARCHING.  
To designate what side of the street  
to search on, use the turn signal.  
The arrow symbols >> and << in  
the message center indicate on  
which side of the vehicle APA will park. If the turn signal is not on, the  
system will automatically search the passenger side.  
233  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
For best performance, the driver should drive the vehicle as parallel as  
possible while passing a parking space. If driven too fast (above 18 mph  
[30 km/h]) for the system to measure parking spaces, the message center  
will display ACTIVE PARK REDUCE SPEED.  
When the system has found a space, the message center will display  
SPACE FOUND PULL FORWARD followed by a chime. Drive forward  
until the message center displays SPACE FOUND STOP followed by a  
chime. When you stop the vehicle in position to begin parking, the  
message center displays REMOVE HANDS PUT IN REVERSE. The driver  
should always come to a complete stop before changing gears.  
Automatic steering into parking space  
Automatic steering is activated when you stop the vehicle, remove your  
hands from the steering wheel and select R (Reverse) gear. Be sure the  
steering wheel motion is not obstructed by any objects. The vehicle will  
steer itself from this point on as you follow the instructions in the  
message center to safely move the vehicle reverse and forward in the  
space. You may cancel APA at anytime by grabbing the steering wheel or  
by pressing the APA control switch. When the vehicle is in R (Reverse),  
the message center displays BACK UP USE CAUTION.  
234  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
When you determine the vehicle is back far enough or you hear a solid  
tone from reverse sensing system, bring the vehicle to a complete stop  
and move the gearshift to D (Drive). The message center will now  
display PULL FORWARD USE CAUTION followed by a chime.  
When you determine the vehicle is far enough forward or a solid tone  
from forward sensing system (if equipped) is heard, bring the vehicle to  
a complete stop and move the gearshift to R (Reverse). The message  
center may display BACK UP SLOWLY USE CAUTION followed by a  
chime. The system may offer subsequent backward and forward  
maneuvers before proceeding to the finish phase.  
APA finished  
When active park assist has completed the automated steering, the  
message center displays ACTIVE PARK FINISHED followed by a chime.  
The driver is responsible to assess and correct as necessary the final  
parking position and put the vehicle in P (Park).  
The system can also be deactivated at any time by the following:  
Pressing the APA control switch  
Grabbing the steering wheel  
Exceeding a vehicle speed of 18 mph (30 km/h) for 30 seconds during  
active park searching  
235  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
Exceeding a vehicle speed of 6 mph (10 km/h) during automatic  
steering  
Deactivating the AdvanceTracsystem or the system has activated on  
a slippery or loose surface  
ABS activation or failure  
Any door (except the driver’s door) opens  
Something touching the steering wheel.  
If a fault is present in the system, the message ACTIVE PARK FAULT  
will be displayed followed by a chime. Contact an authorized dealer to  
have your vehicle serviced.  
The system should not be used if:  
a foreign object (i.e. bike rack, trailer, etc.) is attached to the front or  
rear of the vehicle or at another location close to the sensors.  
the front bumper or side sensors are damaged (i.e. in a collision) or  
obstructed by a foreign object (i.e. front bumper cover).  
a mini-spare tire is used.  
Troubleshooting  
Why isn’t APA searching for a parking space?  
You may have deactivated the AdvanceTracsystem.  
One of the doors (except the driver’s door) may not be securely  
closed.  
Why doesn’t APA offer a particular parking space?  
Something may be contacting the front bumper or side sensors. Clear  
any material stuck to the sensors.  
There may not be enough room to maneuver the vehicle into the  
space. Remember, there needs to be enough space on the opposite  
side of the vehicle to allow the front of the vehicle to swing out as you  
back into the space.  
The vehicle is not driven close enough to the parking space, less than  
60 inches (1.5 m) from neighboring parked vehicles.  
The vehicle is driven too close to the side objects (e.g. less than  
16 inches [41 cm] from neighboring parked vehicles).  
You may be driving in R (Reverse). APA can only look for a parking  
space while moving forward.  
236  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
Why doesn’t APA position the vehicle where I want in the space?  
The driver allows the vehicle to roll in the opposite direction of the  
transmission, such as rolling forward when R (Reverse) gear is  
selected.  
You may be driving in R (Reverse). APA can only look for a parking  
space while moving forward.  
There may be an irregular curb along the parking space. APA might  
not be able to align the vehicle to curbs that are damaged, very  
shallow or covered with material such as debris, leaves, snow, or tarps.  
The vehicles or objects bordering the space may not be positioned  
appropriately.  
The vehicle was pulled further up from the parking space than usual  
while driving by the space. APA performs best when you drive the  
same distance past the entire length of the parking space whenever  
parking your vehicle.  
The tires may not be installed and maintained correctly. For example,  
one or more tires may not be inflated correctly, may not be of the  
same size, or may not be authorized for use on this vehicle.  
The vehicle had a repair or alteration that is not authorized by the  
manufacturer.  
One of the parked vehicles has a high altitude attachment (i.e. salt  
sprayer, snow plow, moving truck high bed, etc.) High altitude  
attachments may not be detected by the system.  
The parking space length or parked objects position have changed  
after the vehicle has passed the parking space.  
The temperature around your vehicle changes quickly, such as driving  
from a heated garage into the cold or after leaving a car wash. As a  
result, the outside air temperature displayed in the vehicle may not be  
close enough to the actual temperature. APA relies on correctly  
sensing the temperature outside for precisely positioning the vehicle.  
BLIND SPOT MIRRORS  
Blind spot mirrors have an integrated convex spotter mirror built into  
the upper outboard corner of the outside mirrors. They are designed to  
assist the driver by increasing visibility along the side of the vehicle. For  
more information on your side view mirrors, refer to Exterior mirrors in  
the Driver Controls chapter.  
237  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Driving with blind spot mirrors  
Before a lane change, check the  
main mirror first, then check the  
blind spot mirror. If no vehicles are  
present in the blind spot mirror and  
the traffic in the adjacent lane is at  
a safe distance, signal that you are  
going to change lanes. Glance over  
your shoulder to verify traffic is  
clear, and carefully change lanes.  
3
2
1
When the approaching vehicle is at  
a distance, its image is small and  
near the inboard edge of the main  
mirror. As the vehicle approaches,  
the image becomes larger and  
begins to move outboard across the  
main mirror (1). As the vehicle  
approaches its image will transition  
from the main mirror and begin to  
appear in the blind spot mirror (2).  
As the vehicle leaves the blind spot  
mirror it will transition to the driver’s peripheral field of view (3).  
WARNING: Objects in the blind spot mirror are closer than they  
appear.  
FOUR WHEEL DRIVE (4WD) SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)  
WARNING: For important information regarding safe operation  
of this type of vehicle, see Preparing to drive your vehicle in  
this chapter.  
Your vehicle is equipped with an intelligent 4WD System that  
continuously monitors vehicle conditions and automatically adjusts the  
power distribution between the front and rear wheels. It combines  
transparent all-surface operation with highly capable four-wheel drive.  
The 4WD system is always active and requires no driver input. It is  
capable of handling all road conditions, including street and highway  
driving as well as off-road and winter driving.  
238  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Driving off-road with truck and utility vehicles  
4WD vehicles are specially equipped for driving on sand, snow, mud and  
rough terrain and have operating characteristics that are somewhat  
different from conventional vehicles, both on and off the road.  
How your vehicle differs from other vehicles  
Truck and utility vehicles can differ from some other vehicles. Your  
vehicle may be higher to allow it to travel over rough terrain without  
getting hung up or damaging underbody components.  
The differences that make your vehicle so versatile also make it handle  
differently than an ordinary passenger car.  
Maintain steering wheel control at all times, especially in rough terrain.  
Since sudden changes in terrain can result in abrupt steering wheel  
motion, make sure you grip the steering wheel from the outside. Do not  
grip the spokes.  
Drive cautiously to avoid vehicle damage from concealed objects such as  
rocks and stumps.  
You should either know the terrain or examine maps of the area before  
driving. Map out your route before driving in the area. To maintain  
steering and braking control of your vehicle, you must have all four  
wheels on the ground and they must be rolling, not sliding or spinning.  
Basic operating principles  
Drive slower in strong crosswinds which can affect the normal steering  
characteristics of your vehicle.  
Be extremely careful when driving on pavement made slippery by  
loose sand, water, gravel, snow or ice.  
If your vehicle goes off the edge of the pavement  
If your vehicle goes off the edge of the pavement, slow down, but  
avoid severe brake application, and ease the vehicle back onto the  
pavement only after reducing your speed. Do not turn the steering  
wheel too sharply while returning to the road surface.  
It may be safer to stay on the apron or shoulder of the road and slow  
down gradually before returning to the pavement. You may lose  
control if you do not slow down or if you turn the steering wheel too  
sharply or abruptly.  
It often may be less risky to strike small objects, such as highway  
reflectors, with minor damage to your vehicle rather than attempt a  
sudden return to the pavement which could cause the vehicle to slide  
239  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
sideways out of control or roll over. Remember, your safety and the  
safety of others should be your primary concern.  
WARNING: Vehicles with a higher center of gravity such as  
utility and four-wheel drive vehicles handle differently than  
vehicles with a lower center of gravity. Utility and four-wheel drive  
vehicles are not designed for cornering at speeds as high as passenger  
cars any more than low-slung sports cars are designed to perform  
satisfactorily under off-road conditions. Avoid sharp turns, excessive  
speed and abrupt maneuvers in these vehicles. Failure to drive  
cautiously could result in an increased risk of loss of vehicle control,  
vehicle rollover, personal injury and death.  
If your vehicle gets stuck  
If your vehicle gets stuck in mud or snow it may be rocked out by  
shifting between forward and reverse gears, stopping between shifts, in a  
steady pattern. Press lightly on the accelerator in each gear.  
Do not rock the vehicle if the engine is not at normal operating  
temperature or damage to the transmission may occur.  
Do not rock the vehicle for more than a few minutes or damage  
to the transmission and tires may occur or the engine may  
overheat.  
WARNING: Always set the parking brake fully and make sure  
the gearshift is latched in P (Park). Turn the ignition to the off  
position and remove the key whenever you leave your vehicle.  
WARNING: If the parking brake is fully released, but the brake  
warning lamp remains illuminated, the brakes may not be  
working properly. See your authorized dealer.  
WARNING: Do not spin the wheels at over 35 mph (56 km/h).  
The tires may fail and injure a passenger or bystander.  
240  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Emergency maneuvers  
In an unavoidable emergency situation where a sudden sharp turn  
must be made, remember to avoid “over-driving” your vehicle, i.e.,  
turn the steering wheel only as rapidly and as far as required to avoid  
the emergency. Excessive steering will result in less vehicle control,  
not more. Additionally, smooth variations of the accelerator and/or  
brake pedal pressure should be utilized if changes in vehicle speed are  
required. Avoid abrupt steering, acceleration or braking which could  
result in an increased risk of loss of vehicle control, vehicle rollover  
and/or personal injury. Use all available road surface to return the  
vehicle to a safe direction of travel.  
In the event of an emergency stop, avoid skidding the tires and do not  
attempt any sharp steering wheel movements.  
WARNING: Vehicles with a higher center of gravity such as  
utility and four-wheel drive vehicles handle differently than  
vehicles with a lower center of gravity. Utility and four-wheel drive  
vehicles are not designed for cornering at speeds as high as passenger  
cars any more than low-slung sports cars are designed to perform  
satisfactorily under off-road conditions. Avoid sharp turns, excessive  
speed and abrupt maneuvers in these vehicles. Failure to drive  
cautiously could result in an increased risk of loss of vehicle control,  
vehicle rollover, personal injury and death.  
If the vehicle goes from one type of surface to another (i.e., from  
concrete to gravel) there will be a change in the way the vehicle  
responds to a maneuver (steering, acceleration or braking). Again,  
avoid these abrupt inputs.  
Sand  
When driving over sand, try to keep all four wheels on the most solid  
area of the trail. Avoid reducing the tire pressures and drive steadily  
through the terrain. Apply the accelerator slowly and avoid spinning the  
wheels.  
Avoid excessive speed because vehicle momentum can work against you  
and cause the vehicle to become stuck to the point that assistance may  
be required from another vehicle. Remember, you may be able to back  
out the way you came if you proceed with caution.  
241  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Mud and water  
If you must drive through high  
water, drive slowly. Traction or  
brake capability may be limited.  
When driving through water,  
determine the depth; avoid water  
higher than the bottom of the hubs  
(if possible) and proceed slowly. If  
the ignition system gets wet, the  
vehicle may stall.  
Once through water, always try the brakes. Wet brakes do not stop the  
vehicle as effectively as dry brakes. Drying can be improved by moving  
your vehicle slowly while applying light pressure on the brake pedal.  
Be cautious of sudden changes in vehicle speed or direction when you  
are driving in mud. Even 4WD vehicles can lose traction in slick mud. As  
when you are driving over sand, apply the accelerator slowly and avoid  
spinning your wheels. If the vehicle does slide, steer in the direction of  
the slide until you regain control of the vehicle.  
If the transmission, transfer case or front axle are submerged in water,  
their fluids should be checked and changed, if necessary.  
Driving through deep water may damage the transmission.  
If the front or rear axle is submerged in water, the axle lubricant should  
be replaced.  
After driving through mud, clean off residue stuck to rotating driveshafts  
and tires. Excess mud stuck on tires and rotating driveshafts causes an  
imbalance that could damage drive components.  
“Tread Lightly” is an educational  
program designed to increase public  
awareness of land-use regulations  
and responsibilities in our nation’s  
wilderness areas. Ford Motor  
Company joins the U.S. Forest Service and the Bureau of Land  
Management in encouraging you to help preserve our national forest and  
other public and private lands by “treading lightly.”  
Driving on hilly or sloping terrain  
Although natural obstacles may make it necessary to travel diagonally up  
or down a hill or steep incline, you should always try to drive straight up  
or straight down. Avoid driving crosswise or turning on steep  
242  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
slopes or hills. A danger lies in losing traction, slipping sideways and  
possibly rolling over. Whenever driving on a hill, determine beforehand  
the route you will use. Do not drive over the crest of a hill without  
seeing what conditions are on the other side. Do not drive in reverse  
over a hill without the aid of an observer.  
If you do stall out, do not try to  
turn around because you might roll  
over. It is better to back down to a  
safe location.  
Apply just enough power to the  
wheels to climb the hill. Too much  
power will cause the tires to slip,  
spin or lose traction, resulting in  
loss of vehicle control.  
Descend a hill in the same gear you  
would use to climb up the hill to  
avoid excessive brake application  
and brake overheating. Do not  
descend in neutral; instead,  
disengage overdrive or manually  
shift to a lower gear. When  
descending a steep hill, avoid  
sudden hard braking as you could  
lose control. When you brake hard,  
the front wheels can’t turn and if  
they aren’t turning, you won’t be  
able to steer. The front wheels have to be turning in order to steer the  
vehicle.  
Since your vehicle has anti-lock brakes, apply the brakes steadily. Do not  
“pump” the brakes.  
Driving on snow and ice  
4WD vehicles have advantages over 2WD vehicles in snow and ice but  
can skid like any other vehicle.  
Should you start to slide while driving on snowy or icy roads, turn the  
steering wheel in the direction of the slide until you regain control.  
Avoid sudden applications of power and quick changes of direction on  
snow and ice. Apply the accelerator slowly and steadily when starting  
from a full stop.  
243  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Avoid sudden braking as well. Although a 4WD vehicle may accelerate  
better than a two-wheel drive vehicle in snow and ice, it won’t stop any  
faster, because as in other vehicles, braking occurs at all four wheels. Do  
not become overconfident as to road conditions.  
Make sure you allow sufficient distance between you and other vehicles  
for stopping; drive slower than usual. Since your vehicle is equipped with  
a Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS), apply the brake steadily.  
Do not “pump” the brakes. Refer to the Brakes section of this chapter  
for additional information on the operation of the anti-lock brake system.  
WARNING: If you are driving in slippery conditions that require  
tire chains or cables, then it is critical that you drive cautiously.  
Keep speeds down, allow for longer stopping distances and avoid  
aggressive steering to reduce the chances of a loss of vehicle control  
which can lead to serious injury or death. If the rear end of the vehicle  
slides while cornering, steer in the direction of the slide until you  
regain control of the vehicle.  
Maintenance and modifications  
The suspension and steering systems on your vehicle have been designed  
and tested to provide durable load carrying capability and predictable  
performance whether loaded or empty. For this reason, Ford Motor  
Company strongly recommends that you do not make modifications such  
as adding or removing parts (such as lift kits or stabilizer bars) or using  
replacement parts not equivalent to the original factory equipment.  
Any modifications to a vehicle that raise the center of gravity can make  
it more likely the vehicle will roll over as a result of a loss of control.  
Ford Motor Company recommends that caution be used with any vehicle  
equipped with a high load or device (such as ladder racks or pickup box  
cover).  
Failure to maintain your vehicle properly may void the warranty, increase  
your repair cost, reduce vehicle performance and operational capabilities  
and adversely affect driver and passenger safety. Frequent inspection of  
vehicle chassis components is recommended if the vehicle is subjected to  
heavy off-road usage.  
244  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
DRIVING THROUGH WATER  
If driving through deep or standing  
water is unavoidable, proceed very  
slowly especially when the depth is  
not known. Never drive through  
water that is higher than the bottom  
of the wheel rims (for cars) or the  
bottom of the hubs (for trucks).  
When driving through water, traction or brake capability may be limited.  
Also, water may enter your engine’s air intake and severely damage your  
engine or your vehicle may stall. Driving through deep water where  
the transmission vent tube is submerged may allow water into the  
transmission and cause internal transmission damage.  
Once through the water, always dry the brakes by moving your  
vehicle slowly while applying light pressure on the brake pedal.  
Wet brakes do not stop the vehicle as quickly as dry brakes.  
245  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
ROADSIDE ASSISTANCE  
Getting roadside assistance  
To fully assist you should you have a vehicle concern, Ford Motor  
Company offers a complimentary roadside assistance program. This  
program is separate from the New Vehicle Limited Warranty. The service  
is available:  
24–hours, seven days a week  
for the period of five years or 60,000 miles (100,000 km), whichever  
occurs first on Ford and Mercury vehicles, and six years or  
70,000 miles (110,000 km) on Lincoln vehicles.  
Roadside assistance will cover:  
a flat tire change with a good spare  
battery jump start  
lock-out assistance (key replacement cost is the customer’s  
responsibility)  
fuel delivery – Independent Service Contractors, if not prohibited by  
state, local or municipal law shall deliver up to 2.0 gallons (7.5L) of  
gasoline or 5.0 gallons (18.9L) of diesel fuel to a disabled vehicle. Fuel  
delivery service is limited to two no-charge occurrences within a  
12-month period.  
winch out – available within 100 feet (30.5 meters) of a paved or  
county maintained road, no recoveries.  
towing – Ford/Mercury/Lincoln eligible vehicle towed to an authorized  
dealer within 35 miles (56 km) of the disablement location or to the  
nearest authorized dealer. If a member requests to be towed to an  
authorized dealer more than 35 miles (56 km) from the disablement  
location, the member shall be responsible for any mileage costs in  
excess of 35 miles (56 km).  
Trailers shall be covered up to $200 if the disabled eligible vehicle  
requires service at the nearest authorized dealer. If the trailer is disabled,  
but the towing vehicle is operational, the trailer does not qualify for any  
roadside services.  
If you need towing after the New Vehicle Limited Warranty period has  
ended, roadside assistance can arrange towing and charge your credit  
card unless the problem is covered by another Ford warranty. Ford will  
pay the tow charge under the other warranty.  
246  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
Canadian customers refer to your Customer Information Guide  
for information on:  
coverage period  
exact fuel amounts  
towing of your disabled vehicle  
emergency travel expense reimbursement  
travel planning benefits  
In Canada, for uninterrupted Roadside Assistance coverage, you may  
purchase extended coverage prior to your Basic Warranty’s Roadside  
Assistance expiring. For more information and enrollment, contact  
1–877–294–2582 or visit our website at www.ford.ca.  
Using roadside assistance  
Complete the roadside assistance identification card and place it in your  
wallet for quick reference. In the United States, this card is found in the  
Owner Guide portfolio in the glove compartment. In Canada, the card is  
found in the Warranty Guide in the glove compartment.  
U.S. Ford, Mercury and Lincoln vehicle customers who require Roadside  
Assistance, call 1-800-241-3673.  
Canadian customers who require roadside assistance, call  
1-800-665-2006.  
If you need to arrange roadside assistance for yourself, Ford Motor  
Company will reimburse a reasonable amount for towing to the nearest  
dealership within 35 miles (56 km). To obtain reimbursement  
information, U.S. Ford, Mercury and Lincoln vehicle customers call  
1-800-241-3673. Customers will be asked to submit their original  
receipts.  
Canadian customers who need to obtain reimbursement information, call  
1-800-665-2006 or visit our website at www.ford.ca.  
247  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
HAZARD FLASHER CONTROL  
The hazard flasher is located on the  
steering column, just behind the  
steering wheel. The hazard flashers  
will operate when the ignition is in  
any position or if the key is not in  
the ignition.  
Press the flasher control and all  
front and rear direction signals will  
flash. Press the flasher control again  
to turn them off. Use it when your  
vehicle is disabled and is creating a  
safety hazard for other motorists.  
Note: With extended use, the flasher may run down your low voltage  
(underhood) battery.  
FUEL PUMP/HIGH VOLTAGE SHUT-OFF SWITCHES  
The fuel pump shut-off switch stops the electric fuel pump from sending  
fuel to the engine and the high voltage shut-off switch shuts off power  
from the high voltage battery when your vehicle receives a substantial  
physical jolt.  
After an accident, if the engine does not start, one or both of the  
switches may have been activated.  
248  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
The fuel pump shut-off switch is  
located in the front passenger’s  
footwell, behind a flip-up cover.  
The high voltage shut-off switch is  
located in the cargo area on the  
passenger side of the vehicle in the  
jack compartment, behind the jack  
access door. The switch is located  
behind the jack.  
To reset the switch(es):  
1. Turn the ignition to the off position.  
2. Check the fuel system for leaks.  
3. If no leaks are apparent, reset the switch by pressing in on the reset  
button. Both switches should be checked and reset.  
4. Turn the ignition to the on position.  
5. Wait a few seconds and return the key to the off position.  
6. Make another check for leaks.  
249  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
If you see or smell fuel, do not reset the fuel pump shut-off or try to  
start your vehicle; you could injure yourself or others. Have all the  
passengers get out of the vehicle and call the local fire department or a  
towing service.  
FUSES AND RELAYS  
Fuses  
If electrical components in the  
vehicle are not working, a fuse may  
have blown. Blown fuses are  
identified by a broken wire within  
the fuse. Check the appropriate  
15  
fuses before replacing any electrical  
components.  
Note: Always replace a fuse with one that has the specified amperage  
rating. Using a fuse with a higher amperage rating can cause severe wire  
damage and could start a fire.  
Standard fuse amperage rating and color  
COLOR  
Fuse  
rating  
2A  
3A  
4A  
Mini  
fuses  
Grey  
Violet  
Pink  
Tan  
Standard  
fuses  
Grey  
Violet  
Pink  
Tan  
Maxi  
fuses  
Cartridge Fuse link  
maxi fuses cartridge  
5A  
7.5A  
10A  
15A  
20A  
25A  
30A  
40A  
50A  
60A  
70A  
80A  
Brown  
Red  
Brown  
Red  
Yellow  
Green  
Orange  
Red  
Blue  
Tan  
Blue  
Pink  
Green  
Red  
Yellow  
Blue  
Pink  
Green  
Red  
Yellow  
Brown  
Black  
Blue  
Yellow  
Natural  
Green  
Blue  
Yellow  
Natural  
Green  
Natural  
Black  
250  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
Passenger compartment fuse panel  
The fuse panel is located on the  
right-hand side of the center  
console, by the instrument panel.  
Remove the panel cover to access  
the fuse cover. Press the tabs on the  
top and bottom of the fuse cover to  
remove.  
The fuses are coded as follows:  
Fuse/Relay  
Location  
Fuse Amp  
Rating  
30A  
Protected Circuits  
1
2
3
110V inverter  
Brake on/off switch  
SYNCmodule  
15A  
15A  
251  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
Fuse/Relay  
Location  
Fuse Amp  
Rating  
30A  
Protected Circuits  
4
5
Moon roof  
10A  
Brake-shift i nterlock (BSI), Passenger  
compartment fuse panel, Keypad  
illumination  
6
7
8
20A  
10A  
10A  
15A  
15A  
10A  
7.5A  
5A  
Turn signals, Stop lamps  
Low beam headlamps (left)  
Low beam headlamps (right)  
Interior lights  
Backlighting  
Four wheel drive  
Power mirror switch  
Not used (spare)  
FCIM (radio buttons), Front display  
module, GPS module  
Climate control  
Not used (spare)  
All lock motor feeds, Liftgate release,  
Liftglass release  
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
10A  
15  
16  
17  
10A  
15A  
20A  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
20A  
25A  
15A  
15A  
15A  
15A  
20A  
10A  
10A  
20A  
5A  
Heated seat  
Rear wiper  
Datalink  
Fog lamps  
Park lamps  
High beam headlamps  
Horn relay  
Demand lamps  
Instrument panel cluster  
Ignition switch  
Radio  
5A  
5A  
10A  
Instrument panel cluster  
Not used (spare)  
Restraints control module  
252  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
Fuse/Relay  
Location  
Fuse Amp  
Rating  
10A  
Protected Circuits  
32  
33  
34  
35  
Rear video camera module  
Not used (spare)  
Not used (spare)  
Four wheel drive, Electronic power assist  
steering (EPAS), 110V inverter module,  
Park aid module, Active park assist  
module  
10A  
5A  
10A  
36  
5A  
Passive anti-theft system (PATS)  
transceiver  
37  
38  
39  
40  
41  
10A  
20A  
20A  
20A  
15A  
Not used (spare)  
Subwoofer/Amp (premium radio)  
Radio, Radio amplifier (navigation)  
Front power point  
Driver/passenger door lock switches,  
Auto dimming mirror, Compass, Ambient  
lighting, Moon roof, Camera display in  
mirror  
42  
43  
10A  
10A  
Not used (spare)  
Rear wiper logic, Heated seats relay,  
Instrument cluster  
44  
45  
46  
10A  
5A  
7.5A  
Not used (spare)  
Front wiper logic, Blower motor relay  
Occupant classification system (OCS),  
Passenger airbag deactivation indicator  
(PADI)  
47  
48  
30A Circuit Power windows  
Breaker  
Delayed accessory relay  
Power distribution box  
The power distribution box is located in the engine compartment. The  
power distribution box contains high-current fuses that protect your  
vehicle’s main electrical systems from overloads.  
253  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
WARNING: Always disconnect the low voltage (underhood)  
battery before servicing high current fuses.  
WARNING: To reduce risk of electrical shock, always replace  
the cover to the power distribution box before reconnecting the  
low voltage (underhood) battery or refilling fluid reservoirs.  
If the low voltage (underhood) battery has been disconnected and  
reconnected, refer to the Low voltage (underhood) battery section of  
the Maintenance and Specifications chapter.  
The fuses are coded as follows.  
Fuse/Relay  
Location  
Fuse Amp  
Rating  
Protected Circuits  
A
B
1
2
3
4
5
80A Midi  
Power steering control module  
125A Midi Passenger compartment fuse panel  
15A*  
30A**  
20A**  
40A**  
10A*  
Heated mirror  
Rear defroster  
Rear power point  
Electric vacuum pump  
Powertrain control module (PCM) – keep  
alive power, PCM relay, Transmission  
control module, Canister vent  
254  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
Fuse/Relay  
Location  
Fuse Amp  
Rating  
Protected Circuits  
6
Not used  
7
8
9
10  
15A*  
5A*  
50A**  
30A**  
Liftgate latch  
Traction battery control module  
Brake control module  
Front wipers  
11  
Not used  
12  
13  
40A**  
Blower motor  
Not used  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
10A*  
50A**  
40A**  
40A**  
50A**  
30A**  
Heater/Coolant pump  
Traction battery control module (TBCM)  
Cooling fan 1  
Cooling fan 2  
Brake control module solenoid  
Power seats  
Not used  
21A  
21B  
21C  
21D  
22  
23  
24  
25  
15A*  
15A*  
10A*  
5A*  
Rear defroster relay  
Ignition relay  
Blower relay  
PCM relay  
Ignition coils  
Fuel injectors  
Transmission control module  
TBCM  
26  
27  
20A*  
10A*  
Fuel pump, TBCM  
PCM (general powertrain components  
malfunction indicator lamp), Heater  
pump relay, Motor electronics coolant  
pump relay, Electronic A/C compressor  
Universal exhaust gas oxygen (UEGO)  
sensor, PCM – emission related  
powertrain components malfunction  
indicator lamp  
28  
15A*  
255  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
Fuse/Relay  
Location  
29  
Fuse Amp  
Protected Circuits  
Rating  
15A*  
PCM power  
30A  
30B  
30C  
30D  
31A  
31B  
Cooling fan 1 relay  
Electric vacuum pump mechanical relay  
Cooling fan main relay  
Cooling fan 2 relay  
Reverse lamp relay  
Not used  
31C  
Heater pump relay  
Coolant pump relay  
Not used  
Liftgate latch relay  
Not used  
31D  
31E  
31F  
32  
33  
PCM diode  
34  
Not used  
35  
10A*  
Run/start, Reverse lamps, Rear defrost  
relay  
36  
Not used  
* Mini fuse ** Cartridge fuse  
256  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
Auxiliary relay box  
The relay box is located in the engine compartment on the radiator  
support bracket.  
Fuse/Relay Fuse amp  
Description  
location  
rating  
Relay  
Electric vacuum pump (solid state)  
1
2
3
4
5
6
5A*  
Not used  
Not used  
Not used  
Vacuum pump monitor  
Not used  
Not used  
* Mini fuses **Cartridge fuse  
CHANGING THE TIRES  
If you get a flat tire while driving, do not apply the brake heavily.  
Instead, gradually decrease your speed. Hold the steering wheel firmly  
and slowly move to a safe place on the side of the road.  
257  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
Note: The tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) indicator light will  
illuminate when the spare tire is in use. To restore the full functionality  
of the monitoring system, all road wheels equipped with tire pressure  
monitoring sensors must be mounted on the vehicle.  
Have a flat serviced by an authorized dealer in order to prevent damage  
to the TPMS sensors, refer to Tire pressure monitoring system  
(TPMS) in the Tires, Wheels and Loading chapter. Replace the spare  
tire with a road tire as soon as possible. During repairing or replacing of  
the flat tire, have the authorized dealer inspect the TPMS sensor for  
damage.  
WARNING: The use of tire sealants may damage your tire  
pressure monitoring system (TPMS) and should not be used.  
However, if you must use a sealant, the TPMS sensor and valve stem  
on the wheel must be replaced by an authorized Ford dealer.  
WARNING: Refer to Tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS)  
in the Tires, Wheels and Loading chapter for important  
information. If the tire pressure monitor sensor becomes damaged, it  
will no longer function.  
Dissimilar spare tire/wheel information  
WARNING: Failure to follow these guidelines could result in an  
increased risk of loss of vehicle control, injury or death.  
If you have a dissimilar spare tire/wheel, then it is intended for  
temporary use only. This means that if you need to use it, you should  
replace it as soon as possible with a road tire/wheel that is the same size  
and type as the road tires and wheels that were originally provided by  
Ford. If the dissimilar spare tire or wheel is damaged, it should be  
replaced rather than repaired.  
A dissimilar spare tire/wheel is defined as a spare tire and/or wheel that  
is different in brand, size or appearance from the road tires and wheels  
and can be one of three types:  
1. T-type mini-spare: This spare tire begins with the letter “T” for tire  
size and may have “Temporary Use Only” molded in the sidewall  
2. Full-size dissimilar spare with label on wheel: This spare tire has  
a label on the wheel that states: “THIS TIRE AND WHEEL FOR  
TEMPORARY USE ONLY”  
258  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
When driving with one of the dissimilar spare tires listed above, do not:  
Exceed 50 mph (80 km/h)  
Load the vehicle beyond maximum vehicle load rating listed on the  
Safety Compliance Label  
Tow a trailer  
Use snow chains on the end of the vehicle with the dissimilar spare  
tire  
Use more than one dissimilar spare tire at a time  
Use commercial car washing equipment  
Try to repair the dissimilar spare tire  
Use of one of the dissimilar spare tires listed above at any one wheel  
location can lead to impairment of the following:  
Handling, stability and braking performance  
Comfort and noise  
Ground clearance and parking at curbs  
Winter weather driving capability  
Wet weather driving capability  
3. Full-size dissimilar spare without label on wheel  
When driving with the full-size dissimilar spare tire/wheel, do not:  
Exceed 70 mph (113 km/h)  
Use more than one dissimilar spare tire/wheel at a time  
Use commercial car washing equipment  
Use snow chains on the end of the vehicle with the dissimilar spare  
tire/wheel  
The usage of a full-size dissimilar spare tire/wheel can lead to  
impairment of the following:  
Handling, stability and braking performance  
Comfort and noise  
Ground clearance and parking at curbs  
Winter weather driving capability  
Wet weather driving capability  
All-wheel driving capability (if applicable)  
Load leveling adjustment (if applicable)  
259  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
When driving with the full-size dissimilar spare tire/wheel additional  
caution should be given to:  
Towing a trailer  
Driving vehicles equipped with a camper body  
Driving vehicles with a load on the cargo rack  
Drive cautiously when using a full-size dissimilar spare tire/wheel and  
seek service as soon as possible.  
Stopping and securing the vehicle  
1. Park on a level surface, set the  
parking brake and activate the  
hazard flashers.  
2. Place gearshift lever in P (Park)  
and turn engine off.  
Removing the jack and tools  
The jack and tools are located in the  
right rear of the cargo area behind  
an access panel.  
260  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
To remove jack from vehicle:  
1. Release the thumbscrew on the  
bracket.  
2. Release the retention clip on the  
upper part of the jack bracket.  
3. Dislodge the jack from the  
bracket and carefully guide jack  
down and out through trim opening,  
upper end out first.  
Remove the lug wrench from the  
jack in order to remove the spare  
tire from under the vehicle.  
Removing the spare tire or spare tire and tether (if equipped)  
1. Insert the lug wrench through the  
access hole in the rear bumper.  
2. Turn the handle counterclockwise  
and lower the spare tire until it can  
be slid rearward and the cable is  
slack.  
3. Slide the retainer through the  
center of the wheel.  
261  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
If equipped with a tether, perform the following additional steps:  
4. Lift the spare tire on end to  
access tether attachment (1).  
5. Use the lug wrench to remove the  
lug nut from the spare tire tether.  
6. If not replacing the spare or flat  
tire to the underbody storage area,  
raise winch up into the installed  
position.  
7. Use the attached fastener strap  
(2) to tie the tether end to the  
winch actuator shaft (if equipped).  
Tire change procedure  
WARNING: When one of the front wheels is off the ground, the  
transmission alone will not prevent the vehicle from moving or  
slipping off the jack, even if the vehicle is in P (Park).  
262  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
WARNING: To help prevent the vehicle from moving when you  
change a tire, be sure the parking brake is set, then block (in  
both directions) the wheel that is diagonally opposite (other side and  
end of the vehicle) to the tire being changed.  
WARNING: If the vehicle slips off the jack, you or someone else  
could be seriously injured.  
WARNING: Do not attempt to change a tire on the side of the  
vehicle close to moving traffic. Pull far enough off the road to  
avoid the danger of being hit when operating the jack or changing the  
wheel.  
Note: Passengers should not remain in the vehicle when the vehicle is  
being jacked.  
1. Block the diagonally opposite  
wheel.  
2. Loosen each wheel lug nut  
one-half turn counterclockwise but  
do not remove them until the wheel  
is raised off the ground.  
263  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
Before placing the jack under the vehicle, NOTE the jack locations:  
Front  
View shown from rear of front tire.  
Position the jack directly below the  
protruding bolt.  
264  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
Rear  
View shown from forward of rear  
tire. Position the jack directly below  
the stud on the rear trailing arm.  
3. Position the jack according to the  
guides and turn the jack handle  
clockwise until the tire is a  
maximum of 1 inch (25 mm) off the  
ground.  
Be sure to place the jack away  
from the rear edge of the rocker  
to avoid damaging the rear tire  
spoiler (pictured).  
265  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
Never use the differentials as a  
jacking point.  
WARNING: To lessen the  
risk of personal injury, do  
not put any part of your body  
under the vehicle while changing a  
tire. Do not start the engine when  
your vehicle is on the jack. The  
jack is only meant for changing  
the tire.  
4. Remove the lug nuts with the lug nut wrench.  
5. Replace the flat tire with the spare tire, making sure the valve stem is  
facing outward. Reinstall lug nuts until the wheel is snug against the hub.  
Do not fully tighten the lug nuts until the wheel has been lowered.  
6. Lower the wheel by turning the jack handle counterclockwise.  
7. Remove the jack and fully tighten  
the lug nuts in the order shown.  
Refer to Wheel lug nut torque  
specifications later in this chapter  
for the proper lug nut torque  
specification.  
1
3
4
5
2
Stowing the jack and tools  
Make sure the jack is fully lowered  
and reclip the tools onto the jack.  
Reinstall the jack and tools in the cargo area. To replace the jack in the  
vehicle,  
266  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
guide the jack bottom first in the  
trim opening and position in the  
bracket (3),  
secure the retention clip on the  
upper part of the jack (2), and  
close the thumbscrew (1).  
Make sure the jack is fastened so it  
does not rattle when you drive.  
Stowing the flat/spare tire  
Note: Failure to follow spare tire stowage instructions may result in  
failure of cable or loss of spare tire.  
If you are stowing a tire that requires reattaching it to the  
vehicle with a tether, perform these steps first, then proceed with  
the steps following.  
1. Place tire on end with valve stem  
facing rearward, away from vehicle.  
2. Place tether into bolt holes in  
wheel and attach lug nut using lug  
wrench.  
3. Lay the tire on the ground with the valve stem facing down. If your  
vehicle is equipped with aluminum wheels, remove the wheel ornament.  
267  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
4. Slide the wheel partially under the vehicle and install the retainer  
through the center of the wheel.  
5. Turn the jack handle clockwise until the tire is raised to its original  
position underneath the vehicle. The effort to turn the jack handle  
increases significantly as the tire contacts the frame. The spare tire  
carrier will ratchet when the tire is in the fully stowed position. The  
spare tire carrier has a built-in ratchet feature that will not allow you to  
overtighten. If the spare tire carrier ratchets with very little effort, take  
the vehicle to your authorized dealer for assistance at your earliest  
convenience. If your vehicle is equipped with a trailer hitch, guide  
the tire with one hand; keep the rear of the tire tilted down until  
the tire clears the bumper.  
6. Check that the tire lies flat against the frame assembly. Push against  
the tire to make sure it is tightly seated under the vehicle. Loosen and  
retighten, if necessary. Failure to properly stow the spare tire may result  
in failure of the winch cable and loss of the spare tire. (Make sure that  
the tire does not contact the bumper.)  
7. Repeat this tightness check procedure (every six months, per  
scheduled maintenance information), when servicing the spare tire  
pressure or at any time that the spare tire is disturbed through service of  
other components.  
WHEEL LUG NUT TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS  
Retighten the lug nuts to the specified torque at 500 miles (800 km)  
after any wheel disturbance (tire rotation, changing a flat tire, wheel  
removal, etc.).  
Bolt size  
Wheel lug nut torque*  
ft-lb  
100  
Nm  
M12 x 1.5  
135  
* Torque specifications are for nut and bolt threads free of dirt and  
rust. Use only Ford recommended replacement fasteners.  
WARNING: When a wheel is installed, always remove any  
corrosion, dirt or foreign materials present on the mounting  
surfaces of the wheel or the surface of the wheel hub, brake drum or  
brake disc that contacts the wheel. Ensure that any fasteners that  
attach the rotor to the hub are secured so they do not interfere with  
the mounting surfaces of the wheel. Installing wheels without correct  
metal-to-metal contact at the wheel mounting surfaces can cause the  
wheel nuts to loosen and the wheel to come off while the vehicle is in  
motion, resulting in loss of control.  
268  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
Note: Inspect the wheel pilot hole  
prior to installation. If there is  
visible corrosion in wheel pilot hole,  
remove loose particles by wiping  
with clean rag and apply grease.  
Apply grease only to the wheel pilot  
hole surface by smearing a “dime”  
(1 square cm) sized glob of grease  
around the wheel pilot surface (1)  
with end of finger. DO NOT apply  
grease to lugnut/stud holes or  
wheel-to-brake surfaces.  
RUNNING OUT OF FUEL  
If you have run out of fuel and need to refill the vehicle with a portable  
fuel container, see Running out of fuel in the Maintenance and  
Specifications chapter for proper fuel filling method using a portable  
fuel container and the included fuel filler funnel. Do not insert the  
nozzle of portable fuel containers or any type of aftermarket funnels into  
the Easy Fuel™ “no cap” fuel system as it can be damaged. You must  
use the included funnel in such circumstances.  
WARNING: Do not insert the nozzle of portable fuel containers  
or aftermarket funnels into the Easy Fuel™ system. This could  
damage the fuel system and its seal, and may cause fuel to run onto  
the ground instead of filling the tank, all of which could result in  
serious personal injury.  
JUMP STARTING (LOW VOLTAGE [UNDERHOOD] BATTERY  
ONLY)  
WARNING: The gases around the battery can explode if  
exposed to flames, sparks, or lit cigarettes. An explosion could  
result in injury or vehicle damage.  
WARNING: Batteries contain sulfuric acid which can burn skin,  
eyes and clothing, if contacted.  
Do not attempt to push-start your automatic transmission  
vehicle. Automatic transmissions do not have push-start  
capability. Attempting to push-start a vehicle with an automatic  
transmission may cause transmission damage.  
269  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
Preparing your vehicle  
If your low voltage (underhood) battery becomes disconnected or  
disabled for any reason, the vehicle controller must relearn the engine’s  
operating characteristics in order to operate it at maximum efficiency.  
This relearning process occurs the first time the vehicle is driven after  
reconnecting the low voltage battery. If the learning procedure does not  
have time to complete during the drive, the engine will continue to  
operate for 3-5 seconds after you turn the ignition off to complete the  
relearning process. This is a normal condition and will not re-occur until  
the low voltage battery is disconnected again. Refer to Low voltage  
(underhood) battery in the Maintenance and Specification chapter  
for more information.  
1. Use only a 12–volt supply to start your vehicle.  
2. Do not disconnect the battery of the disabled vehicle as this could  
damage the vehicle’s electrical system.  
3. Park the booster vehicle close to the hood of the disabled vehicle  
making sure the two vehicles do not touch. Set the parking brake on  
both vehicles and stay clear of the engine cooling fan and other moving  
parts.  
4. Check all battery terminals and remove any excessive corrosion before  
you attach the battery cables. Ensure that vent caps are tight and level.  
5. Turn the heater fan on in both vehicles to protect from any electrical  
surges. Turn all other accessories off.  
Connecting the jumper cables  
Note: In the illustration, the vehicle on the bottom is used to designate  
the assisting (boosting) battery.  
270  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
1. Connect the positive (+) jumper  
cable to the positive (+) terminal of  
the discharged battery.  
1
2. Connect the other end of the  
positive (+) cable to the positive  
(+) terminal of the assisting battery.  
4
+
3. Connect the negative (-) cable to  
the negative (-) terminal of the  
assisting battery.  
4. Make the final connection of the  
negative (-) cable to an exposed  
metal part of the stalled vehicle’s  
engine, away from the battery and  
the carburetor/fuel injection system.  
+
3
2
Note: Do not attach the negative (-) cable to fuel lines, engine rocker  
covers, the intake manifold or electrical components as grounding points.  
WARNING: Do not connect the end of the second cable to the  
negative (-) terminal of the battery to be jumped. A spark may  
cause an explosion of the gases that surround the battery.  
Ensure that the cables are clear of fan blades, belts, moving parts of both  
engines, or any fuel delivery system parts.  
Jump starting  
1. Start the engine of the booster vehicle and run the engine at  
moderately increased speed.  
2. Start the engine of the disabled vehicle.  
3. Once the disabled vehicle has been started, run both engines for an  
additional three minutes before disconnecting the jumper cables.  
271  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
Removing the jumper cables  
Remove the jumper cables in the reverse order that they were  
connected.  
Note: In the illustration, the vehicle on the bottom is used to designate  
the assisting (boosting) battery.  
1. Remove the jumper cable from  
the ground metal surface.  
2. Remove the jumper cable on the  
negative (-) terminal of the booster  
vehicle’s battery.  
4  
1
+
3. Remove the jumper cable from  
the positive (+) terminal of the  
booster vehicle’s battery.  
4. Remove the jumper cable from  
the positive (+) terminal of the  
disabled vehicle’s battery.  
+
2  
3  
After the disabled vehicle has been started and the jumper cables  
removed, allow it to idle for several minutes so the engine computer can  
relearn its idle conditions.  
272  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
WRECKER TOWING  
If you need to have your vehicle towed, contact a professional towing  
service or, if you are a member of a roadside assistance program, your  
roadside assistance service provider.  
It is recommended that your vehicle be towed with a wheel lift and  
dollies or flatbed equipment. Do not tow with a slingbelt. Ford Motor  
Company has not approved a slingbelt towing procedure.  
On FWD vehicles, if your vehicle is to be towed from the front, ensure  
proper wheel lift equipment is used to raise the front wheels off the  
ground. The rear wheels can be left on the ground when towed in this  
fashion.  
If your vehicle is to be towed from the rear using wheel lift equipment, it  
is required that the front wheels (drive wheels) be placed on a dolly to  
prevent damage to the transmission.  
On 4WD vehicles, it is required that your vehicle be towed with a wheel  
lift and dollies or flatbed equipment with all the wheels off the ground to  
prevent damage to the automatic transmission, 4WD system or vehicle.  
273  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
Ford Motor Company produces a towing manual for all authorized tow  
truck operators. Have your tow truck operator refer to this manual for  
proper hook-up and towing procedures for your vehicle.  
If the vehicle is towed by other means or incorrectly, vehicle  
damage may occur.  
Emergency towing  
In case of a roadside emergency with a disabled vehicle (without access  
to wheel dollies, car hauling trailer, or flatbed transport vehicle) your  
vehicle (regardless of transmission powertrain configuration) can be flat  
towed (all wheels on the ground) under the following conditions:  
Vehicle is facing forward so that it is being towed in a forward  
direction.  
Place the transmission in N (Neutral). Refer to Brake-shift interlock  
in the Driving chapter for specific instructions if you cannot move the  
gear shift lever into N (Neutral).  
Maximum speed is not to exceed 35 mph (56 km/h).  
Maximum distance is 50 miles (80 km).  
274  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Customer Assistance  
GETTING THE SERVICES YOU NEED  
Warranty repairs to your vehicle must be performed by an authorized  
Ford, Lincoln, or Mercury dealer. While any authorized dealer handling  
your vehicle line will provide warranty service, we recommend you  
return to your selling authorized dealer who wants to ensure your  
continued satisfaction.  
Please note that certain warranty repairs require special training and/or  
equipment, so not all authorized dealers are authorized to perform all  
warranty repairs. This means that, depending on the warranty repair  
needed, you may have to take your vehicle to another authorized dealer.  
A reasonable time must be allowed to perform a repair after taking your  
vehicle to the authorized dealer. Repairs will be made using Ford or  
Motorcraftparts, or remanufactured or other parts that are authorized  
by Ford.  
Away from home  
If you are away from home when your vehicle needs service, contact the  
Ford Customer Relationship Center or use the online resources listed  
below to find the nearest authorized dealer.  
In the United States:  
Mailing address  
Ford Motor Company  
Customer Relationship Center  
P.O. Box 6248  
Dearborn, MI 48121  
Telephone  
1-800-392-3673 (FORD)  
(TDD for the hearing impaired: 1-800-232-5952)  
Online  
Additional information and resources are available online at  
www.genuineservice.com.  
U.S. dealer locator by Dealer Name, City/State, or Zip Code  
Owner Guides  
Maintenance Schedules  
Recalls  
Ford Extended Service Plans  
Ford Genuine Accessories  
Service specials and promotions.  
275  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Customer Assistance  
In Canada:  
Mailing address (Ford vehicles)  
Customer Relationship Centre  
Ford Motor Company of Canada, Limited  
P.O. Box 2000  
Oakville, Ontario L6J 5E4  
Telephone  
1-800-565-3673 (FORD)  
Online  
www.ford.ca  
Mailing address (Lincoln vehicles)  
Lincoln Centre  
Ford Motor Company of Canada, Limited  
P.O. Box 2000  
Oakville, Ontario L6J 5E4  
Telephone  
1-800-387-9333  
Online  
www.lincolncanada.com  
Additional assistance  
If you have questions or concerns, or are unsatisfied with the service you  
are receiving, follow these steps:  
1. Contact your Sales Representative or Service Advisor at your  
selling/servicing authorized dealer.  
2. If your inquiry or concern remains unresolved, contact the Sales  
Manager, Service Manager or Customer Relations Manager.  
3. If you require assistance or clarification on Ford Motor Company  
policies, please contact the Ford Customer Relationship Center  
In order to help you serve you better, please have the following  
information available when contacting a Customer Relationship Center:  
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)  
Your telephone number (home and business)  
The name of the authorized dealer and city where located  
The vehicle’s current odometer reading  
276  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Customer Assistance  
In some states, you must directly notify Ford in writing before pursuing  
remedies under your state’s warranty laws. Ford is also allowed a final  
repair attempt in some states.  
In the United States, a warranty dispute must be submitted to the BBB  
AUTO LINE before taking action under the Magnuson-Moss Warranty  
Act, or to the extent allowed by state law, before pursuing replacement  
or repurchase remedies provided by certain state laws. This dispute  
handling procedure is not required prior to enforcing state created rights  
or other rights which are independent of the Magnuson-Moss Warranty  
Act or state replacement or repurchase laws.  
IN CALIFORNIA (U.S. ONLY)  
California Civil Code Section 1793.2(d) requires that, if a manufacturer  
or its representative is unable to repair a motor vehicle to conform to the  
vehicle’s applicable express warranty after a reasonable number of  
attempts, the manufacturer shall be required to either replace the  
vehicle with one substantially identical or repurchase the vehicle and  
reimburse the buyer in an amount equal to the actual price paid or  
payable by the consumer (less a reasonable allowance for consumer  
use). The consumer has the right to choose whether to receive a refund  
or replacement vehicle.  
California Civil Code Section 1793.22(b) presumes that the manufacturer  
has had a reasonable number of attempts to conform the vehicle to its  
applicable express warranties if, within the first 18 months of ownership  
of a new vehicle or the first 18,000 miles (29,000 km), whichever occurs  
first:  
1. Two or more repair attempts are made on the same non-conformity  
likely to cause death or serious bodily injury OR  
2. Four or more repair attempts are made on the same nonconformity (a  
defect or condition that substantially impairs the use, value or safety of  
the vehicle) OR  
3. The vehicle is out of service for repair of nonconformities for a total of  
more than 30 calendar days (not necessarily all at one time)  
277  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Customer Assistance  
In the case of 1 or 2 above, the consumer must also notify the  
manufacturer of the need for the repair of the nonconformity at the  
following address:  
Ford Motor Company  
16800 Executive Plaza Drive  
Mail Drop 3NE-B  
Dearborn, MI 48126  
You are required to submit your warranty dispute to BBB AUTO LINE  
before asserting in court any rights or remedies conferred by California  
Civil Code Section 1793.22(b). You are also required to use BBB AUTO  
LINE before exercising rights or seeking remedies created by the Federal  
Magnuson-Moss Warranty Act, 15 U.S.C. sec. 2301 et seq. If you choose  
to seek redress by pursuing rights and remedies not created by California  
Civil Code Section 1793.22(b) or the Magnuson-Moss Warranty Act,  
resort to BBB AUTO LINE is not required by those statutes.  
THE BETTER BUSINESS BUREAU (BBB) AUTO LINE PROGRAM  
(U.S. ONLY)  
Your satisfaction is important to Ford Motor Company and to your dealer.  
If a warranty concern has not been resolved using the three-step  
procedure outlined on the first page of the Customer Assistance section,  
you may be eligible to participate in the BBB AUTO LINE program.  
The BBB AUTO LINE program consists of two parts – mediation and  
arbitration. During mediation, a representative of the BBB will contact  
both you and Ford Motor Company to explore options for settlement of  
the claim. If an agreement is not reached during mediation or you do not  
want to participate in mediation, and if your claim is eligible, you may  
participate in the arbitration process. An arbitration hearing will be  
scheduled so that you can present your case in an informal setting  
before an impartial person. The arbitrator will consider the testimony  
provided and make a decision after the hearing.  
Disputes submitted to the BBB AUTO LINE program are usually decided  
within forty days after you file your claim with the BBB. You are not  
bound by the decision, and may reject the decision and proceed to court  
where all findings of the BBB Auto Line dispute, and decision, are  
admissible in the court action. Should you choose to accept the BBB  
AUTO LINE decision, Ford is then bound by the decision, and must  
comply with the decision within 30 days of receipt of your acceptance  
letter.  
BBB AUTO LINE Application: Using the information provided below,  
please call or write to request a program application. You will be asked  
278  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Customer Assistance  
for your name and address, general information about your new vehicle,  
information about your warranty concerns, and any steps you have  
already taken to try to resolve them. A Customer Claim Form will be  
mailed that will need to be completed, signed and returned to the BBB  
along with proof of ownership. Upon receipt, the BBB will review the  
claim for eligibility under the Program Summary Guidelines.  
You can get more information by calling BBB AUTO LINE at  
1-800-955-5100, or writing to:  
BBB AUTO LINE  
4200 Wilson Boulevard, Suite 800  
Arlington, Virginia 22203–1833  
BBB AUTO LINE applications can also be requested by calling the Ford  
Motor Company Customer Relationship Center at 1-800-392-3673.  
Note: Ford Motor Company reserves the right to change eligibility  
limitations, modify procedures, or to discontinue this process at any time  
without notice and without obligation.  
UTILIZING THE MEDIATION/ARBITRATION PROGRAM  
(CANADA ONLY)  
For vehicles delivered to authorized Canadian dealers. In those cases  
where you continue to feel that the efforts by Ford of Canada and the  
authorized dealer to resolve a factory-related vehicle service concern  
have been unsatisfactory, Ford of Canada participates in an impartial  
third party mediation/arbitration program administered by the Canadian  
Motor Vehicle Arbitration Plan (CAMVAP).  
The CAMVAP program is a straight forward and relatively speedy  
alternative to resolve a disagreement when all other efforts to produce a  
settlement have failed. This procedure is without cost to you and is  
designed to eliminate the need for lengthy and expensive legal  
proceedings.  
In the CAMVAP program, impartial third-party arbitrators conduct  
hearings at mutually convenient times and places in an informal  
environment. These impartial arbitrators review the positions of the  
parties, make decisions and, when appropriate, render awards to resolve  
disputes. CAMVAP decisions are fast, fair, and final as the arbitrator’s  
award is binding on both you and Ford of Canada.  
CAMVAP services are available in all Canadian territories and provinces.  
For more information, without charge or obligation, call your CAMVAP  
Provincial Administrator directly at 1-800-207-0685 or visit  
www.camvap.ca.  
279  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Customer Assistance  
GETTING ASSISTANCE OUTSIDE THE U.S. AND CANADA  
Before exporting your vehicle to a foreign country, contact the  
appropriate foreign embassy or consulate. These officials can inform you  
of local vehicle registration regulations and where to find unleaded fuel.  
If you cannot find unleaded fuel or can only get fuel with an anti-knock  
index lower than is recommended for your vehicle, contact a regional  
office or owner relations/customer relationship office.  
The use of leaded fuel in your vehicle without proper conversion may  
damage the effectiveness of your emission control system and may cause  
engine knocking or serious engine damage. Ford Motor Company/Ford of  
Canada is not responsible for any damage caused by use of improper  
fuel. Using leaded fuel may also result in difficulty importing your vehicle  
back into the U.S.  
If your vehicle must be serviced while you are traveling or living in  
Asia-Pacific Region, Sub-Saharan Africa, U.S. Virgin Islands, Central  
America, the Caribbean, and Israel, contact the nearest authorized  
dealer. If the authorized dealer cannot help you, contact:  
FORD MOTOR COMPANY  
FORD EXPORT OPERATIONS  
1555 Fairlane Drive  
Fairlane Business Park #3  
Allen Park, Michigan 48101  
U.S.A.  
Telephone: (313) 594-4857  
FAX: (313) 390-0804  
If your vehicle must be serviced while you are traveling or living in  
Puerto Rico, contact the nearest authorized dealer. If the authorized  
dealer cannot help you, contact:  
Ford International Business Development Inc.  
Customer Assistance Center  
P.O. Box 11957  
Caparra Heights Station  
San Juan, Puerto Rico 00922-1957  
Telephone: (800) 841-FORD (3673)  
FAX: (313) 390-0804  
280  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Customer Assistance  
If your vehicle must be serviced while you are traveling or living in the  
Middle East, contact the nearest authorized dealer. If the authorized  
dealer cannot help you, contact:  
Ford Middle East  
Customer Relationship Center  
P.O. Box 21470  
Dubai, United Arab Emirates  
Telephone: +971 4 3326084  
FAX: +971 4 3327299  
www.me.ford.com  
If you buy your vehicle in North America and then relocate to any of the  
above locations, register your vehicle identification number (VIN) and  
new address with Ford Motor Company Export Operations.  
If you are in another foreign country, contact the nearest authorized  
dealer. If the authorized dealer employees cannot help you, they can  
direct you to the nearest Ford affiliate office.  
Customers in the U.S. should call 1-800-392-3673.  
ORDERING ADDITIONAL OWNER’S LITERATURE  
To order the publications in this portfolio, contact Helm, Incorporated at:  
HELM, INCORPORATED  
P.O. Box 07150  
Detroit, Michigan 48207  
Or to order a free publication catalog, call toll free: 1-800-782-4356  
Monday-Friday 8:00 a.m. - 6:00 p.m. EST  
Helm, Incorporated can also be reached by their website:  
www.helminc.com.  
(Items in this catalog may be purchased by credit card, check or  
money order.)  
Obtaining a French Owner’s Guide  
French Owner’s Guides can be obtained from your authorized dealer or  
by contacting Helm, Incorporated using the contact information listed  
previously in this section.  
281  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Customer Assistance  
REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS (U.S. ONLY)  
If you believe that your vehicle has  
a defect which could cause a crash  
or could cause injury or death, you  
should immediately inform the  
National Highway Traffic Safety  
Administration (NHTSA) in addition to notifying Ford Motor Company.  
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and  
if it finds that a safety defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may order a  
recall and remedy campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved  
in individual problems between you, your dealer, or Ford Motor  
Company.  
To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at  
1–888–327–4236 (TTY: 1–800–424–9153); go to http://www.safercar.gov;  
or write to:  
Administrator  
1200 New Jersey Avenue, Southeast  
Washington, D.C. 20590  
You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from  
http://www.safercar.gov.  
REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS (CANADA ONLY)  
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or  
could cause injury or death, you should immediately inform Transport  
Canada, using their toll-free number: 1–800–333–0510, or online at:  
https://wwwapps.tc.gc.ca/Saf-Sec-Sur/7/PCDB-BDPP/Index.aspx.  
282  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cleaning  
WASHING THE EXTERIOR  
Wash your vehicle regularly with cool or lukewarm water and a neutral  
pH shampoo, such as MotorcraftDetail Wash (ZC-3-A), which is  
available from your authorized dealer.  
Never use strong household detergents or soap, such as dish washing  
or laundry liquid. These products can discolor and spot painted  
surfaces.  
Never wash a vehicle that is “hot to the touch” or during exposure to  
strong, direct sunlight.  
Always use a clean sponge or car wash mitt with plenty of water for  
best results.  
Dry the vehicle with a chamois or soft terry cloth towel in order to  
eliminate water spotting.  
It is especially important to wash the vehicle regularly during the  
winter months, as dirt and road salt are difficult to remove and cause  
damage to the vehicle.  
Immediately remove items such as gasoline, diesel fuel, bird droppings  
and insect deposits because they can cause damage to the vehicle’s  
paintwork and trim over time. Use MotorcraftBug and Tar Remover  
(ZC-42) which is available from your authorized dealer.  
Remove any exterior accessories, such as antennas, before entering a  
car wash.  
Suntan lotions and insect repellents can damage any painted  
surface; if these substances come in contact with your vehicle,  
wash off as soon as possible.  
Exterior chrome  
Wash the vehicle first, using cool or lukewarm water and a neutral pH  
shampoo, such as MotorcraftDetail Wash (ZC-3-A).  
Use MotorcraftCustom Bright Metal Cleaner (ZC-15), available from  
your authorized dealer. Apply the product as you would a wax to  
clean bumpers and other chrome parts; allow the cleaner to dry for a  
few minutes, then wipe off the haze with a clean, dry rag.  
Never use abrasive materials such as steel wool or plastic pads  
as they can scratch the chrome surface.  
WAXING  
Wash the vehicle first.  
Use a quality wax that does not contain abrasives.  
283  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cleaning  
Do not allow paint sealant to come in contact with any non-body  
(low-gloss black) colored trim, such as grained door handles, roof  
racks, bumpers, side moldings, mirror housings or the windshield cowl  
area. The paint sealant will “gray” or stain the parts over time.  
PAINT CHIPS  
Your authorized dealer has touch-up paint to match your vehicle’s color.  
Take your color code (printed on a sticker in the driver’s door jamb) to  
your authorized dealer to ensure you get the correct color.  
Remove particles such as bird droppings, tree sap, insect deposits, tar  
spots, road salt and industrial fallout before repairing paint chips.  
Always read the instructions before using the products.  
ALUMINUM WHEELS AND WHEEL COVERS  
Aluminum wheels and wheel covers are coated with a clearcoat paint  
finish. In order to maintain their shine:  
Clean weekly with MotorcraftWheel and Tire Cleaner (ZC-37-A),  
which is available from your authorized dealer. Heavy dirt and brake  
dust accumulation may require agitation with a sponge. Rinse  
thoroughly with a strong stream of water.  
Never apply any cleaning chemical to hot or warm wheel rims or  
covers.  
Some automatic car washes may cause damage to the finish on your  
wheel rims or covers. Industrial-strength (heavy-duty) cleaners, or  
cleaning chemicals, in combination with brush agitation to remove  
brake dust and dirt, could wear away the clearcoat finish over time.  
Do not use hydrofluoric acid-based or high caustic-based wheel  
cleaners, steel wool, fuels or strong household detergent.  
To remove tar and grease, use MotorcraftBug and Tar Remover  
(ZC-42), available from your authorized dealer.  
ENGINE  
Engines are more efficient when they are clean because grease and dirt  
buildup keep the engine warmer than normal. When washing:  
Take care when using a power washer to clean the engine. The  
high-pressure fluid could penetrate the sealed parts and cause  
damage.  
Do not spray a hot engine with cold water to avoid cracking the  
engine block or other engine components.  
284  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cleaning  
Spray MotorcraftEngine Shampoo and Degreaser (ZC-20) on all  
parts that require cleaning and pressure rinse clean. In Canada, use  
MotorcraftEngine Shampoo (CXC-66-A).  
Cover the highlighted areas to prevent water damage when cleaning  
the engine. Note: As with all transmissions, be especially careful as  
water entry into the vents can damage internal parts.  
Never wash or rinse the engine while it is hot or running; water in the  
running engine may cause internal damage.  
Never wash or rinse any ignition coil, spark plug wire or spark plug  
well, or the area in and around these locations.  
PLASTIC (NON-PAINTED) EXTERIOR PARTS  
Use only approved products to clean plastic parts. These products are  
available from your authorized dealer.  
For routine cleaning, use MotorcraftDetail Wash (ZC-3-A).  
If tar or grease spots are present, use MotorcraftBug and Tar  
Remover (ZC-42).  
WINDOWS AND WIPER BLADES  
The windshield, rear and side windows and the wiper blades should be  
cleaned regularly. If the wipers do not wipe properly, substances on the  
285  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cleaning  
vehicle’s glass or the wiper blades may be the cause. These may include  
hot wax treatments used by commercial car washes, water repellent  
coatings, tree sap, or other organic contamination; these contaminants  
may cause squeaking or chatter noise from the blades, and streaking and  
smearing of the windshield. To clean these items, follow these tips:  
The windshield, rear windows and side windows may be cleaned with  
a non-abrasive cleaner such as MotorcraftUltra-Clear Spray Glass  
Cleaner (ZC-23), available from your authorized dealer.  
The wiper blades can be cleaned with isopropyl (rubbing) alcohol or  
MotorcraftPremium Windshield Washer Concentrate (ZC-32-A) in  
the U.S., or Premium Quality Windshield Washer Fluid [CXC-37-(A, B,  
D, or F)] in Canada, available from your authorized dealer. This  
washer fluid contains special solution in addition to alcohol which  
helps to remove the hot wax deposited on the wiper blade and  
windshield from automated car wash facilities. Be sure to replace  
wiper blades when they appear worn or do not function properly.  
Do not use abrasives, as they may cause scratches.  
Do not use fuel, kerosene, or paint thinner to clean any parts.  
If you cannot remove those streaks after cleaning with the glass cleaner  
or if the wipers chatter and move in a jerky motion, clean the outer  
surface of the windshield and the wiper blades using a sponge or soft  
cloth with a neutral detergent or mild-abrasive cleaning solution. After  
cleaning, rinse the windshield and wiper blades with clean water. The  
windshield is clean if beads do not form when you rinse the windshield  
with water.  
Do not use sharp objects, such as a razor blade, to clean the  
inside of the rear window or to remove decals, as it may cause  
damage to the rear window defroster’s heated grid lines.  
INSTRUMENT PANEL/INTERIOR TRIM AND CLUSTER LENS  
Clean the instrument panel, interior trim areas and cluster lens with a  
clean, damp, white cotton cloth, then use a clean and dry white cotton  
cloth to dry these areas.  
Avoid cleaners or polishes that increase the gloss of the upper portion  
of the instrument panel. The dull finish in this area helps protect the  
driver from undesirable windshield reflection.  
Be certain to wash or wipe your hands clean if you have been in  
contact with certain products such as insect repellent and suntan  
lotion in order to avoid possible damage to the interior painted  
surfaces.  
286  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cleaning  
Do not use household or glass cleaners as these may damage the  
finish of the instrument panel, interior trim and cluster lens.  
Do not allow air fresheners and hand sanitizers to spill on interior  
surfaces. If a spill occurs, wipe off immediately. Damage may not be  
covered by your warranty.  
WARNING: Do not use chemical solvents or strong detergents  
when cleaning the steering wheel or instrument panel to avoid  
contamination of the airbag system.  
If a staining liquid like coffee/juice has been spilled on the instrument  
panel or on interior trim surfaces, clean as follows:  
1. Wipe up spilled liquid using a clean, white, cotton cloth.  
2. Wipe the surface with a damp, clean, white cotton cloth. For more  
thorough cleaning, use a mild soap and water solution. If the spot cannot  
be completely cleaned by this method, the area may be cleaned using a  
commercially available cleaning product designed for automotive  
interiors.  
3. If necessary, apply more soap and water solution or cleaning product  
to a clean, white, cotton cloth and press the cloth onto the soiled  
area–allow this to set at room temperature for 30 minutes.  
4. Remove the soaked cloth, and if it is not soiled badly, use this cloth to  
clean the area by using a rubbing motion for 60 seconds.  
5. Following this, wipe area dry with a clean, white, cotton cloth.  
INTERIOR  
For fabric, carpets, cloth seats, safety belts and seats equipped with side  
airbags:  
Remove dust and loose dirt with a vacuum cleaner.  
Remove light stains and soil with MotorcraftProfessional Strength  
Carpet & Upholstery Cleaner (ZC-54).  
If grease or tar is present on the material, spot-clean the area first  
with MotorcraftSpot and Stain Remover (ZC-14). In Canada, use  
MotorcraftMulti-Purpose Cleaner (CXC-101).  
If a ring forms on the fabric after spot cleaning, clean the entire area  
immediately (but do not oversaturate) or the ring will set.  
Do not use household cleaning products or glass cleaners, which can  
stain and discolor the fabric and affect the flame retardant abilities of  
the seat materials.  
287  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cleaning  
WARNING: Do not use cleaning solvents, bleach or dye on the  
vehicle’s safety belts, as these actions may weaken the belt  
webbing.  
WARNING: On vehicles equipped with seat-mounted airbags, do  
not use chemical solvents or strong detergents. Such products  
could contaminate the side-airbag system and affect performance of  
the side airbag in a collision.  
LEATHER SEATS  
(IF EQUIPPED, EXCEPT FOR THE KING RANCHEDITION)  
For King Ranchleather seats, refer to a separate section in this  
chapter.  
Clean spills and stains as quickly as possible.  
For routine cleaning, wipe the surface with a soft, damp cloth. For  
more thorough cleaning, wipe the surface with a mild soap and water  
solution. In Canada, use MotorcraftVinyl Cleaner (CXC-93). Dry the  
area with a soft cloth.  
If the leather cannot be completely cleaned using a mild soap and  
water solution, the leather may be cleaned using a commercially  
available leather cleaning product designed for automotive interiors.  
To check for compatibility, first test any cleaner or stain remover on  
an inconspicuous part of the leather.  
Do not use household cleaning products, alcohol solutions, solvents or  
cleaners intended for rubber, vinyl and plastics, or oil/petroleum-based  
leather conditioners. These products may cause premature wearing or  
damage to the leather.  
LEATHER SEATS FOR THE KING RANCHEDITION ONLY  
(IF EQUIPPED)  
Your vehicle is equipped with seating covered in premium, top-grain  
leather which is extremely durable, but still requires special care and  
maintenance in order to ensure longevity and comfort.  
Regular cleaning and conditioning will maintain the appearance of the  
leather.  
Cleaning  
For dirt, use a vacuum cleaner then use a clean, damp cloth or soft  
brush.  
288  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cleaning  
For routine cleaning, wipe the surface with a soft, damp cloth. For more  
thorough cleaning, wipe the surface with a mild soap and water solution.  
Clean spills as quickly as possible.  
Test any cleaner or stain remover on an inconspicuous part of the  
leather as cleaners may darken the leather.  
Do not spill coffee, ketchup, mustard, orange juice or oil-based  
products on the leather as they may permanently stain the leather.  
Do not use household cleaning products, alcohol solutions, solvents or  
cleaners intended for rubber, vinyl or plastics.  
Scratches  
Natural Markings - Because the leather in the seat comes from genuine  
steer hides, there will be evidence of naturally occurring markings, such  
as small scars. These markings give character to the seating covers and  
should be considered as proof of a genuine leather product.  
In order to lessen the appearance of certain scratches and other wear  
marks, apply conditioner on the affected area following the same  
instructions as in the Conditioning section.  
Conditioning  
Bottles of King RanchLeather Conditioner are available at the King  
RanchSaddle Shop. Visit the website at www.krsaddleshop.com, or  
telephone (in the United States) 1–800–282–KING (5464). If you are  
unable to obtain King RanchLeather Conditioner, use another premium  
leather conditioner.  
Clean the surfaces using the steps outlined in the Cleaning section.  
Ensure the leather is dry then apply a nickel-sized amount of  
conditioner to a clean, dry cloth.  
Rub the conditioner into leather until it disappears. Allow the  
conditioner to dry and repeat the process for the entire interior. If a  
film appears, wipe off film with a dry, clean cloth.  
UNDERBODY  
Flush the complete underside of your vehicle frequently. Keep body and  
door drain holes free from packed dirt.  
289  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cleaning  
FORD AND LINCOLN MERCURY CAR CARE PRODUCTS  
Your Ford or Lincoln Mercury authorized dealer has many quality  
products available to clean your vehicle and protect its finishes. These  
quality products have been specifically engineered to fulfill your  
automotive needs; they are custom designed to complement the style  
and appearance of your vehicle. Each product is made from high quality  
materials that meet or exceed rigid specifications. For best results, use  
the following products or products of equivalent quality:  
MotorcraftBug and Tar Remover (ZC-42)  
MotorcraftCustom Bright Metal Cleaner (ZC-15)  
MotorcraftDetail Wash (ZC-3-A)  
MotorcraftDusting Cloth (ZC-24)  
MotorcraftEngine Shampoo and Degreaser (U.S. only) (ZC-20)  
MotorcraftEngine Shampoo (Canada only) (CXC-66-A)  
MotorcraftMulti-Purpose Cleaner (Canada only) (CXC-101)  
MotorcraftPremium Glass Cleaner (Canada only) (CXC-100)  
MotorcraftPremium Quality Windshield Washer Fluid (Canada only)  
[CXC-37-(A, B, D or F)]  
MotorcraftPremium Windshield Washer Concentrate (U.S. only)  
(ZC-32-A)  
MotorcraftProfessional Strength Carpet & Upholstery Cleaner (ZC-54)  
MotorcraftSpot and Stain Remover (U.S. only) (ZC-14)  
MotorcraftUltra-Clear Spray Glass Cleaner (ZC-23)  
MotorcraftVinyl Cleaner (Canada only) (CXC-93)  
MotorcraftWheel and Tire Cleaner (ZC-37-A)  
290  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
SERVICE RECOMMENDATIONS  
To help you service your vehicle, we provide scheduled maintenance  
information which makes tracking routine service easy.  
If your vehicle requires professional service, your authorized dealer can  
provide the necessary parts and service. Check your Warranty Guide to  
find out which parts and services are covered.  
Use only recommended fuels, lubricants, fluids and service parts  
conforming to specifications. Motorcraftparts are designed and built to  
provide the best performance in your vehicle.  
PRECAUTIONS WHEN SERVICING YOUR VEHICLE  
Do not work on a hot engine.  
Make sure that nothing gets caught in moving parts.  
Do not work on a vehicle with the engine running in an enclosed  
space, unless you are sure you have enough ventilation.  
Keep all open flames and other burning material (such as cigarettes)  
away from the battery and all fuel related parts.  
High voltage information  
WARNING: Exposure to high voltage may result in severe  
personal injury or death. High voltage components must be  
serviced by a trained service technician.  
Your vehicle consists of various high voltage components and wiring. All  
of the high voltage power flows through specific wiring assemblies which  
are labeled as such and/or are covered with a solid orange convolute or  
orange stripe tape. Do not come in contact with these components.  
291  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
The following are specific locations in the rear cargo area that consist of  
high voltage components and/or wiring.  
1
2
3
1. High voltage connector shield  
2. Service disconnect  
3. High voltage battery case  
292  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
Working with the engine off  
1. Set the parking brake and ensure the gearshift is securely latched in P  
(Park).  
2. Turn off the engine and remove the key.  
3. Block the wheels to prevent the vehicle from moving unexpectedly.  
Working with the engine on  
1. Set the parking brake and shift to P (Park).  
2. Block the wheels.  
WARNING: To reduce the risk of vehicle damage and/or  
personal burn injuries, do not start your engine with the air  
cleaner removed and do not remove it while the engine is running.  
OPENING THE HOOD  
1. Inside the vehicle, pull the hood  
release handle located under the  
bottom of the instrument panel.  
2. At the front of the vehicle, lift up  
on the auxiliary latch handle located  
in the center between the hood and  
the grille.  
3. Lift the hood open and secure it  
with the prop rod.  
293  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
IDENTIFYING COMPONENTS IN THE ENGINE COMPARTMENT  
1. Engine coolant reservoir  
2. Motor/Electronics (M/E) coolant reservoir  
3. Engine oil filler cap  
4. Brake fluid reservoir  
5. Power distribution box  
6. Low voltage (underhood) battery  
7. Engine air filter assembly  
8. Engine oil dipstick  
9. Windshield washer fluid reservoir  
294  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
WINDSHIELD WASHER FLUID  
Add fluid to fill the reservoir if the  
level is low. In very cold weather, do  
not fill the reservoir completely.  
Only use a washer fluid that meets Ford specifications. Do not use any  
special washer fluid such as windshield water repellent type fluid or bug  
wash. They may cause squeaking, chatter noise, streaking and smearing.  
Refer to the Maintenance product specifications and capacities  
section in this chapter.  
State or local regulations on volatile organic compounds may restrict the  
use of methanol, a common windshield washer antifreeze additive.  
Washer fluids containing non-methanol antifreeze agents should be used  
only if they provide cold weather protection without damaging the  
vehicle’s paint finish, wiper blades or washer system.  
WARNING: If you operate your vehicle in temperatures below  
40°F (5°C), use washer fluid with antifreeze protection. Failure  
to use washer fluid with antifreeze protection in cold weather could  
result in impaired windshield vision and increase the risk of injury or  
accident.  
Note: Do not put washer fluid in the engine coolant reservoir. Washer  
fluid placed in the cooling system may harm engine and cooling system  
components.  
Checking and adding washer fluid for the liftgate  
Washer fluid for the liftgate is supplied by the same reservoir as the  
windshield.  
295  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
CHANGING THE WIPER BLADES  
1. Pull the wiper blade and arm  
away from the glass.  
2. Squeeze the locking tabs to  
release the blade from the arm and  
pull the blade away from the arm to  
remove it.  
3. Attach the new blade to the arm and snap it into place.  
Replace wiper blades at least once per year for optimum performance.  
Poor wiper quality can be improved by cleaning the wiper blades and the  
windshield. Refer to Windows and wiper blades in the Cleaning  
chapter.  
To prolong the life of the wiper blades, it is highly recommended to  
scrape off the ice on the windshield before turning on the wipers. The  
layer of ice has many sharp edges and can damage the micro edge of the  
wiper rubber element.  
296  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
Changing rear window wiper blade  
The rear wiper arm is designed without a service position. This reduces  
the risk of damage to the blade in an automatic car wash.  
To replace the wiper blade:  
1. Grab the wiper arm with one  
hand close to the arm/blade joint  
and pull it as far away from the  
glass as possible. Do not use  
excessive force because it can break  
the wiper arm at the heel. Hold it  
there until the next step.  
2. Grab the primary structure of the  
blade with the other hand close to  
the arm/blade joint.  
3. Grip tightly and press on the arm/blade joint from beneath and  
separate the blade from the arm.  
4. Attach the new wiper to the  
wiper arm and press it into place  
until a click is heard.  
If you find this procedure too  
difficult, please see your dealer.  
ENGINE OIL  
Checking the engine oil  
Refer to the scheduled maintenance information for the appropriate  
intervals for checking the engine oil.  
1. Make sure the vehicle is on level ground.  
2. Turn the engine off and wait 15 minutes for the oil to drain into the  
oil pan.  
3. Set the parking brake and ensure the gearshift is securely latched in P  
(Park).  
4. Open the hood. Protect yourself from engine heat.  
297  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
5. Locate and carefully remove the engine oil level dipstick.  
6. Wipe the dipstick clean. Insert the dipstick fully, then remove it again.  
If the oil level is within the lower and upper holes/lines, the oil level is  
acceptable. DO NOT ADD OIL.  
If the oil level is below the lower hole/line, engine oil must be added  
to raise the level within the normal operating range.  
If required, add engine oil to the engine. Refer to Adding engine oil  
in this chapter.  
Do not overfill the engine with oil. Oil levels above the upper  
hole/line may cause engine damage. If the engine is overfilled,  
some oil must be removed from the engine by an authorized dealer.  
7. Put the dipstick back in and ensure it is fully seated.  
Adding engine oil  
1. Check the engine oil. For instructions, refer to Checking the engine  
oil in this chapter.  
2. If the engine oil level is not within the normal range, add only certified  
engine oil of the recommended viscosity. Remove the engine oil filler cap  
and use a funnel to pour the engine oil into the opening.  
3. Recheck the engine oil level. Make sure the oil level is not above the  
full mark on the engine oil level dipstick.  
4. Install the dipstick and ensure it is fully seated.  
5. Fully install the engine oil filler cap by turning the filler cap clockwise  
1/4 of a turn until it is seated.  
298  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
To avoid possible oil loss, DO NOT operate the vehicle with the  
engine oil level dipstick and/or the engine oil filler cap removed.  
Engine oil and filter recommendations  
Look for this certification  
trademark.  
Use SAE 5W-20 engine oil  
Only use oils certified for gasoline engines by the American Petroleum  
Institute (API). An oil with this trademark symbol conforms to the  
current engine and emission system protection standards and fuel  
economy requirements of the International Lubricant Standardization and  
Approval Committee (ILSAC), comprised of U.S. and Japanese  
automobile manufacturers.  
To protect your engine and engine’s warranty, use MotorcraftSAE  
5W-20 or an equivalent SAE 5W-20 oil meeting Ford specification  
WSS-M2C930-A. SAE 5W-20 oil provides optimum fuel economy and  
durability performance meeting all requirements for your  
vehicle’s engine. Refer to Maintenance product specifications and  
capacities later in this section for more information.  
Do not use supplemental engine oil additives, cleaners or other engine  
treatments. They are unnecessary and could lead to engine damage that  
is not covered by Ford warranty.  
Change your engine oil and filter according to the appropriate schedule  
listed in scheduled maintenance information.  
When changing the oil filter on the 2.5L engine, you must also replace  
the filter cap O-ring. Reuse of the O-rings may cause engine oil leakage  
and may result in severe engine damage. The customer warranty may be  
void for any damage to the engine if the O-rings are not replaced.  
Ford production and Motorcraftreplacement oil filters are designed for  
added engine protection and long life. If a replacement oil filter is used  
that does not meet Ford material and design specifications, start-up  
engine noises or knock may be experienced.  
299  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
It is recommended you use the appropriate Motorcraftoil filter or  
another with equivalent performance for your engine application.  
LOW VOLTAGE (UNDERHOOD) BATTERY  
Your vehicle is equipped with a  
Motorcraftmaintenance-free  
battery which normally does not  
require additional water during its  
life of service.  
If your battery has a cover/shield, make sure it is reinstalled  
after the battery has been cleaned or replaced.  
For longer, trouble-free operation, keep the top of the battery clean and  
dry. Also, make certain the battery cables are always tightly fastened to  
the battery terminals.  
If you see any corrosion on the battery or terminals, remove the cables  
from the terminals and clean with a wire brush. You can neutralize the  
acid with a solution of baking soda and water.  
Note: Electrical or electronic accessories or components added to  
the vehicle by the dealer or the owner (e.g. spot lights, electric  
winch, etc.) may adversely affect vehicle performance and  
durability.  
WARNING: Batteries normally produce explosive gases which  
can cause personal injury. Therefore, do not allow flames, sparks  
or lighted substances to come near the battery. When working near the  
battery, always shield your face and protect your eyes. Always provide  
proper ventilation.  
WARNING: When lifting a plastic-cased battery, excessive  
pressure on the end walls could cause acid to flow through the  
vent caps, resulting in personal injury and/or damage to the vehicle or  
battery. Lift the battery with a battery carrier or with your hands on  
opposite corners.  
300  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
WARNING: Keep batteries out of reach of children. Batteries  
contain sulfuric acid. Avoid contact with skin, eyes or clothing.  
Shield your eyes when working near the battery to protect against  
possible splashing of acid solution. In case of acid contact with skin or  
eyes, flush immediately with water for a minimum of 15 minutes and  
get prompt medical attention. If acid is swallowed, call a physician  
immediately.  
WARNING: Battery posts, terminals and related accessories  
contain lead and lead compounds. Wash hands after handling.  
Because your vehicle’s engine is electronically-controlled by a computer,  
some control conditions are maintained by power from the battery. When  
the battery is disconnected or a new battery is installed, the engine must  
relearn its idle and fuel trim strategy for optimum driveability and  
performance. To begin this process:  
1. With the vehicle at a complete stop, set the parking brake.  
2. Put the gearshift in P (Park), turn off all accessories and start the  
vehicle. Step on the accelerator to start the engine.  
3. Run the vehicle until the engine reaches normal operating  
temperature.  
4. Allow the engine to idle for at least one minute.  
5. Step on the accelerator to start the engine. While the engine is  
running, shift the vehicle to neutral.  
6. Allow the vehicle to run for at least one minute by pressing on the  
accelerator pedal.  
7. Drive the vehicle to complete the relearning process.  
The vehicle may need to be driven 10 miles (16 km) or more to  
relearn the idle and fuel trim strategy.  
If you do not allow the engine to relearn its idle trim, the idle  
quality of your vehicle may be adversely affected until the idle  
trim is eventually relearned.  
If the battery has been disconnected or a new battery has been installed,  
the clock and the preset radio stations must be reset once the battery is  
reconnected.  
301  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
Always dispose of automotive  
batteries in a responsible manner.  
Follow your local authorized  
standards for disposal. Call your  
local authorized recycling center  
to find out more about recycling  
automotive batteries.  
RECYCLE  
Low and high voltage battery – storage  
Your vehicle must be started and run for a minimum of 10 minutes once  
a month in order to maintain the high voltage battery charge. This will  
maintain the high voltage battery but it is not enough to maintain the  
low voltage (underhood) battery and additional low voltage (underhood)  
battery charging may be required after 60 days.  
If your vehicle is to be stored for 30 days or longer, the low voltage  
(underhood) battery negative terminal must be disconnected. Failure to  
do this could damage your vehicle’s batteries.  
ENGINE COOLANT AND MOTOR/ELECTRONICS COOLANT  
Your vehicle is equipped with two separate coolant systems. One is for  
engine cooling and the other is for various electric motors and other  
components that are specific to the hybrid operating systems.  
302  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
Checking engine coolant  
The concentration and level of  
engine coolant should be checked at  
the intervals listed in scheduled  
maintenance information. The  
coolant concentration should be  
maintained at 50/50 coolant and  
distilled water, which equates to a  
freeze point of -34°F (-36°C).  
Coolant concentration testing is  
possible with a hydrometer or  
antifreeze tester. The level of  
coolant should be maintained at the  
FULL COLD level or within the  
COLD FILL RANGE in the coolant  
reservoir. If the level falls below, add  
coolant per the instructions in the  
Adding engine coolant section.  
When the engine is cold, check the  
level of engine coolant in the  
reservoir.  
303  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
Checking motor/electronics (M/E) coolant  
The M/E coolant reservoir is located  
behind the engine coolant reservoir.  
Refer to the following engine  
coolant sections for all information,  
instructions and warnings related to  
cooling systems. The two systems  
use the same coolant and operate  
similarly, with the Motor and  
Electronics system generally  
operating at a lower temperature  
and pressure. The fluid levels in  
both reservoirs need to be  
maintained. When the engine is  
cold, check the level of M/E coolant  
in the reservoir.  
Factory fill and coolant specifications  
Your vehicle was factory-filled with a 50/50 engine coolant and water  
concentration. If the concentration of coolant falls below 40% or above  
60%, the engine parts could become damaged or not work properly. A  
50/50 mixture of coolant and water provides the following:  
Freeze protection down to -34°F (-36°C).  
Boiling protection up to 265°F (129°C).  
Protection against rust and other forms of corrosion.  
Enables calibrated gauges to work properly.  
Common instructions for cooling systems  
The engine coolant should be at the FULL COLD level or within the  
COLD FILL RANGE as listed on the engine coolant reservoir  
(depending upon application).  
Refer to the scheduled maintenance information for service interval  
schedules.  
Be sure to read and understand Precautions when servicing your  
vehicle in this chapter.  
304  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
If the engine coolant has not been checked at the recommended interval,  
the engine coolant reservoir may become low or empty. If the reservoir is  
low or empty, add engine coolant to the reservoir. Refer to Adding  
engine coolant in this chapter.  
Note: Automotive fluids are not interchangeable; do not use engine  
coolant/antifreeze or windshield washer fluid outside of its specified  
function and vehicle location.  
Adding engine coolant  
When adding coolant, make sure it is a 50/50 mixture of engine coolant  
and distilled water. Add the mixture to the coolant reservoir, when the  
engine is cool, until the appropriate fill level is obtained. If coolant is  
filled to the COLD FILL RANGE or FULL COLD level when the engine is  
not cool, the system will remain underfilled.  
WARNING: Do not add engine coolant when the engine is hot.  
Steam and scalding liquids released from a hot cooling system  
can burn you badly. Also, you can be burned if you spill coolant on hot  
engine parts.  
WARNING: Do not put engine coolant in the windshield washer  
fluid container. If sprayed on the windshield, engine coolant  
could make it difficult to see through the windshield.  
DO NOT MIX different colors or types of coolant in your vehicle.  
Make sure the correct coolant is used. DO NOT MIX recycled coolant  
and new (unused) coolant together in the vehicle. Mixing of engine  
coolants may harm your engine’s cooling system. The use of an  
improper coolant may harm engine and cooling system components  
and may void the warranty. Refer to Maintenance product  
specifications and capacities in this chapter.  
A large amount of water without engine coolant may be added, in case  
of emergency, to reach a vehicle service location. In this instance, the  
cooling system must be drained and refilled with a 50/50 mixture of  
engine coolant and distilled water as soon as possible. Water alone  
(without engine coolant) can cause engine damage from corrosion,  
overheating or freezing.  
Do not use alcohol, methanol, brine or any engine coolants  
mixed with alcohol or methanol antifreeze (coolant). Alcohol  
and other liquids can cause engine damage from overheating or  
freezing.  
305  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
Do not add extra inhibitors or additives to the coolant. These  
can be harmful and compromise the corrosion protection of the engine  
coolant.  
For vehicles with overflow coolant systems with a non-pressurized cap  
on the coolant recovery system, add coolant to the coolant recovery  
reservoir when the engine is cool. Add the proper mixture of coolant and  
distilled water to the FULL COLD level. For all other vehicles which have  
a coolant degas system with a pressurized cap, or if it is necessary to  
remove the coolant pressure relief cap on the radiator of a vehicle with  
an overflow system, follow these steps to add engine coolant.  
WARNING: To reduce the risk of personal injury, make sure the  
engine is cool before unscrewing the coolant pressure relief cap.  
The cooling system is under pressure; steam and hot liquid can come  
out forcefully when the cap is loosened slightly.  
Add the proper mixture of coolant and water to the cooling system by  
following these steps:  
1. Before you begin, turn the engine off and let it cool.  
2. When the engine is cool, wrap a thick cloth around the coolant  
pressure relief cap on the coolant reservoir (a translucent plastic bottle).  
Slowly turn cap counterclockwise (left) until pressure begins to release.  
3. Step back while the pressure releases.  
4. When you are sure that all the pressure has been released, use the  
cloth to turn it counterclockwise and remove the cap.  
5. Fill the coolant reservoir slowly with the proper coolant mixture, to  
within the COLD FILL RANGE or the FULL COLD level on the reservoir.  
If you removed the radiator cap in an overflow system, fill the radiator  
until the coolant is visible and radiator is almost full.  
6. Replace the cap. Turn until tightly installed. Cap must be tightly  
installed to prevent coolant loss.  
After any coolant has been added, check the coolant concentration (refer  
to Checking engine coolant). If the concentration is not 50/50  
(protection to –34°F/–36°C), drain some coolant and adjust the  
concentration. It may take several drains and additions to obtain a 50/50  
coolant concentration.  
Whenever coolant has been added, the coolant level in the coolant  
reservoir should be checked the next few times you drive the vehicle. If  
necessary, add enough 50/50 concentration of engine coolant and  
distilled water to bring the liquid level to the proper level.  
306  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
If you have to add more than 1.0 quart (1.0 liter) of engine coolant per  
month, have your authorized dealer check the engine cooling system.  
Your cooling system may have a leak. Operating an engine with a low  
level of coolant can result in engine overheating and possible engine  
damage.  
Recycled engine coolant  
Ford Motor Company does NOT recommend the use of recycled engine  
coolant since a Ford-approved recycling process is not yet available.  
Used engine coolant should be disposed of in an appropriate  
manner. Follow your community’s regulations and standards for recycling  
and disposing of automotive fluids.  
Coolant refill capacity  
To find out how much fluid your vehicle’s cooling system can hold, refer  
to Maintenance product specifications and capacities in this chapter.  
Fill your engine coolant reservoir as outlined in Adding engine coolant  
in this section.  
Severe climates  
If you drive in extremely cold climates (less than –34°F [–36°C]):  
It may be necessary to increase the coolant concentration  
above 50%.  
NEVER increase the coolant concentration above 60%.  
A coolant concentration of 60% will provide freeze point  
protection down to -62°F [-52°C]. Increased engine coolant  
concentrations above 60% will decrease the overheat  
protection characteristics of the engine coolant and may cause  
engine damage.  
If available, refer to the chart on the coolant container to  
ensure the coolant concentration in your vehicle will provide  
adequate freeze protection at the temperatures in which you  
drive in the winter months.  
If you drive in extremely hot climates:  
It is still necessary to maintain the coolant concentration  
above 40%.  
NEVER decrease the coolant concentration below 40%.  
307  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
A coolant concentration of 40% will provide freeze point  
protection down to -12°F [-24°C]. Decreased engine coolant  
concentrations below 40% will decrease the corrosion/freeze  
protection characteristics of the engine coolant and may cause  
engine damage.  
If available, refer to the chart on the coolant container to  
ensure the coolant concentration in your vehicle will provide  
adequate protection at the temperatures in which you drive.  
Vehicles driven year-round in non-extreme climates should use a 50/50  
mixture of engine coolant and distilled water for optimum cooling system  
and engine protection.  
FUEL FILTER  
Your vehicle is equipped with a lifetime fuel filter that is integrated with  
the fuel tank. Regular maintenance or replacement is not needed.  
WHAT YOU SHOULD KNOW ABOUT AUTOMOTIVE FUELS  
Important safety precautions  
WARNING: Do not overfill the fuel tank. The pressure in an  
overfilled tank may cause leakage and lead to fuel spray and fire.  
WARNING: The fuel system may be under pressure. If you hear  
a hissing sound near the fuel filler door (Easy Fuel™ “no cap”  
fuel system), do not refuel until the sound stops. Otherwise, fuel may  
spray out, which could cause serious personal injury.  
WARNING: Automotive fuels can cause serious injury or death  
if misused or mishandled.  
WARNING: Gasoline may contain benzene, which is a  
cancer-causing agent.  
308  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
Observe the following guidelines when handling automotive fuel:  
Extinguish all smoking materials  
and any open flames before  
refueling your vehicle.  
Always turn off the vehicle before  
refueling.  
Automotive fuels can be harmful  
or fatal if swallowed. Fuel such as gasoline is highly toxic and if  
swallowed can cause death or permanent injury. If fuel is swallowed,  
call a physician immediately, even if no symptoms are immediately  
apparent. The toxic effects of fuel may not be visible for hours.  
Avoid inhaling fuel vapors. Inhaling too much fuel vapor of any kind  
can lead to eye and respiratory tract irritation. In severe cases,  
excessive or prolonged breathing of fuel vapor can cause serious  
illness and permanent injury.  
Avoid getting fuel liquid in your eyes. If fuel is splashed in the eyes,  
remove contact lenses (if worn), flush with water for 15 minutes and  
seek medical attention. Failure to seek proper medical attention could  
lead to permanent injury.  
Fuels can also be harmful if absorbed through the skin. If fuel is  
splashed on the skin and/or clothing, promptly remove contaminated  
clothing and wash skin thoroughly with soap and water. Repeated or  
prolonged skin contact with fuel liquid or vapor causes skin irritation.  
Be particularly careful if you are taking “Antabuse” or other forms of  
disulfiram for the treatment of alcoholism. Breathing gasoline vapors,  
or skin contact could cause an adverse reaction. In sensitive  
individuals, serious personal injury or sickness may result. If fuel is  
splashed on the skin, promptly wash skin thoroughly with soap and  
water. Consult a physician immediately if you experience an adverse  
reaction.  
WARNING: When refueling always shut the engine off and  
never allow sparks or open flames near the filler neck. Never  
smoke while refueling. Fuel vapor is extremely hazardous under certain  
conditions. Care should be taken to avoid inhaling excess fumes.  
WARNING: The flow of fuel through a fuel pump nozzle can  
produce static electricity, which can cause a fire if fuel is  
pumped into an ungrounded fuel container.  
309  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
Refueling  
WARNING: Fuel vapor burns violently and a fuel fire can cause  
severe injuries. To help avoid injuries to you and others:  
Read and follow all the instructions on the pump island;  
Turn off your engine when you are refueling;  
Do not smoke if you are near fuel or refueling your vehicle;  
Keep sparks, flames and smoking materials away from fuel;  
Stay outside your vehicle and do not leave the fuel pump unattended  
when refueling your vehicle — this is against the law in some places;  
Keep children away from the fuel pump; never let children pump  
fuel.  
Do not use personal electronic devices while refueling. It can ignite  
fuel vapors.  
Use the following guidelines to avoid electrostatic charge build-up when  
filling an ungrounded fuel container:  
Place approved fuel container on the ground.  
DO NOT fill a fuel container while it is in the vehicle (including the  
cargo area).  
Keep the fuel pump nozzle in contact with the fuel container while  
filling.  
DO NOT use a device that would hold the fuel pump handle in the fill  
position.  
Easy Fuel™ “no cap” fuel system  
Your fuel tank is equipped with an Easy Fuel™ “no cap” fuel filler  
system. This allows you to simply open the fuel filler door and insert the  
fuel filler nozzle into the fuel system. The Easy Fuel™ system is  
self-sealing and protected against dust, dirt, water and snow/ice.  
When fueling your vehicle:  
1. Turn the engine off.  
2. Open the fuel filler door.  
3. Slowly insert the fuel filler nozzle fully into the fuel system, and leave  
the nozzle fully inserted until you are done pumping. Pump fuel as  
normal.  
310  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
4. After you are done pumping fuel, slowly remove the fuel filler  
nozzle—allow about five seconds after pumping fuel before removing the  
fuel filler nozzle. This allows residual fuel to drain back into the fuel tank  
and not spill onto the vehicle.  
Note: A fuel spillage concern may occur if overfilling the fuel tank. Do  
not overfill the tank to the point that the fuel is able to bypass the fuel  
filler nozzle. The overfilled fuel may run down the drain located below  
and in front of the fuel filler door.  
If the check fuel fill inlet lamp or CHECK FUEL FILL INLET message  
comes on, the fuel fill inlet may not have properly closed. The inlet may  
have stuck open or debris may be preventing the inlet from fully closing.  
At the next opportunity, safely pull off the road, turn off the engine,  
open the fuel filler door and remove any visible debris from the fuel fill  
opening. Insert either the fuel fill nozzle or the fuel fill funnel (see  
Refilling with a portable fuel container for funnel location) provided  
with the vehicle several times to dislodge any debris and/or allow the  
inlet to close properly. If this action corrects the problem, the check fuel  
fill inlet lamp or CHECK FUEL FILL INLET message may not reset  
immediately. It may take several driving cycles for the check fuel fill inlet  
lamp or CHECK FUEL FILL INLET message to turn off. A driving cycle  
consists of an engine start-up (after four or more hours with the engine  
off) followed by city/highway driving. Continuing to drive with the check  
fuel fill inlet lamp or CHECK FUEL FILL INLET message on may cause  
the service engine soon lamp to turn on as well.  
WARNING: The fuel system may be under pressure. If you hear  
a hissing sound near the fuel filler door (Easy Fuel™ “no cap”  
fuel system), do not refuel until the sound stops. Otherwise, fuel may  
spray out, which could cause serious personal injury.  
311  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
Choosing the right fuel  
Use only UNLEADED fuel or UNLEADED fuel blended with a maximum  
of 10% ethanol. Do not use fuel ethanol (E85), diesel, methanol, leaded  
fuel or any other fuel. The use of leaded fuel is prohibited by law and  
could damage your vehicle.  
Your vehicle was not designed to use fuel or fuel additives with metallic  
compounds, including manganese-based additives.  
Note: Use of any fuel other than those recommended may cause  
powertrain damage, a loss of vehicle performance, and repairs may not  
be covered under warranty.  
Octane recommendations  
Your vehicle is designed to use  
“Regular” unleaded gasoline with a  
pump (R+M)/2 octane rating of 87.  
87  
Some stations offer fuels posted as  
(R+M)/2 METHOD  
“Regular” with an octane rating  
below 87, particularly in high altitude areas. Fuels with octane levels  
below 87 are not recommended.  
Do not be concerned if your engine sometimes knocks lightly. However, if  
it knocks heavily under most driving conditions while you are using fuel  
with the recommended octane rating, see your authorized dealer to  
prevent any engine damage.  
Fuel quality  
If you are experiencing starting, rough idle or hesitation driveability  
problems during a cold start, try a different brand of “Regular” unleaded  
gasoline. Premium unleaded gasoline is not recommended for vehicles  
designed to use “Regular” unleaded gasoline because it may cause these  
problems to become more pronounced. If the problems persist, see your  
authorized dealer.  
Do not add aftermarket fuel additive products to your fuel tank. It  
should not be necessary to add any aftermarket products to your fuel  
tank if you continue to use high quality fuel of the recommended octane  
rating. These products have not been approved for your engine and  
could cause damage to the fuel system. Repairs to correct the effects of  
using an aftermarket product in your fuel may not be covered by your  
warranty.  
Many of the world’s automakers approved the World-Wide Fuel Charter  
that recommends gasoline specifications to provide improved  
312  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
performance and emission control system protection for your vehicle.  
Gasolines that meet the World-Wide Fuel Charter should be used when  
available. Ask your fuel supplier about gasolines that meet the  
World-Wide Fuel Charter.  
Cleaner air  
Ford endorses the use of reformulated “cleaner-burning” gasolines to  
improve air quality, per the recommendations in the Choosing the right  
fuel section.  
Running out of fuel  
Avoid running out of fuel because this situation may have an adverse  
effect on powertrain components.  
If you have run out of fuel:  
You may need to cycle the ignition from off to on several times after  
refueling to allow the fuel system to pump the fuel from the tank to  
the engine. On restarting, cranking time will take a few seconds longer  
than normal.  
Normally, adding 1 gallon (3.8L) of fuel is enough to restart the  
engine. If the vehicle is out of fuel and on a steep grade, more than  
1 gallon (3.8L) may be required.  
The service engine soon  
indicator may come on. For more  
information on the service engine soon indicator, refer to Warning  
lights and chimes in the Instrument Cluster chapter.  
Refilling with a portable fuel container  
With the Easy Fuel™ “no cap” fuel system, use the following directions  
when filling from a portable fuel container:  
WARNING: Do not insert the nozzle of portable fuel containers  
or aftermarket funnels into the Easy Fuel™ system. This could  
damage the fuel system and its seal, and may cause fuel to run onto  
the ground instead of filling the tank, which could result in serious  
personal injury.  
WARNING: Do not try to pry open or push open the Easy  
Fuel™ system with foreign objects. This could damage the fuel  
system and its seal and cause injury to you or others.  
When filling the vehicle’s fuel tank from a portable fuel container, use the  
funnel included with the vehicle.  
313  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
1. Locate the white plastic funnel. It  
is attached to the inside of the rear  
passenger side cargo compartment  
access door.  
2. Slowly insert the funnel into the  
Easy Fuel™ system.  
3. Fill the vehicle with fuel from the portable fuel container.  
4. When done, clean the funnel or properly dispose of it. Extra funnels  
can be purchased from your authorized dealer if you choose to dispose  
of the funnel. Do not use aftermarket funnels; they will not work with  
the Easy Fuel™ system and can damage it. The included funnel has  
been specially designed to work safely with your vehicle.  
ESSENTIALS OF GOOD FUEL ECONOMY  
Measuring techniques  
Your best source of information about actual fuel economy is you, the  
driver. You must gather information as accurately and consistently as  
possible. Fuel expense, frequency of fill-ups or fuel gauge readings are  
NOT accurate as a measure of fuel economy. We do not recommend  
taking fuel economy measurements during the first 1,000 miles  
(1,600 km) of driving (engine break-in period). You will get a more  
accurate measurement after 2,000 miles–3,000 miles  
(3,000 km–5,000 km).  
314  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
Filling the tank  
When the fuel gauge indicates empty, there is still a small reserve of fuel  
in the fuel system. When refueling your vehicle after the fuel gauge  
indicates empty, you might not be able to refuel the full amount of the  
advertised capacity of the fuel tank due to the empty reserve still  
present in the tank. The amount of usable fuel in the empty reserve  
varies and should not be relied upon to increase driving range.  
For consistent results when filling the fuel tank:  
Turn the engine/ignition switch to the off position prior to refueling;  
an error in the reading will result if the engine is left running.  
Allow no more than two automatic click-offs when filling.  
Always use fuel with the recommended octane rating.  
Use a known quality gasoline, preferably a national brand.  
Your results will be most accurate if your filling method is consistent.  
Calculating fuel economy  
1. Fill the fuel tank completely and record the initial odometer reading  
(in miles or kilometers).  
2. Each time you fill the tank, record the amount of fuel added (in  
gallons or liters).  
3. After at least three to five tank fill-ups, fill the fuel tank and record  
the current odometer reading.  
4. Subtract your initial odometer reading from the current odometer  
reading.  
5. Follow one of the simple calculations in order to determine fuel  
economy:  
Calculation 1: Divide total miles traveled by total gallons used.  
Calculation 2: Multiply liters used by 100, then divide by total  
kilometers traveled.  
Keep a record for at least one month and record the type of driving (city  
or highway). This will provide an accurate estimate of the vehicle’s fuel  
economy under current driving conditions. Additionally, keeping records  
during summer and winter will show how temperature impacts fuel  
economy. In general, very hot or very cold temperatures give lower fuel  
economy.  
315  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
Driving style — good driving and fuel economy habits  
Since it is able to operate in electric mode and to collect braking energy,  
your hybrid vehicle may get better fuel economy in city driving than on  
the highway. This is contrary to conventional vehicles. However, many of  
the same actions that improve fuel economy in a conventional vehicle  
will also improve fuel economy in this vehicle.  
Give consideration to the lists that follow and you may be able to  
improve your fuel economy.  
Habits  
Avoid aggressive driving. Quick acceleration and deceleration decrease  
fuel economy.  
Drive at a smooth, constant speed. Excessive variation in pedal input  
causes more operating mode changes and reduces efficiency.  
Drive at reasonable speeds. Traveling at 60 mph (96 km/h) uses  
approximately 20% less fuel than traveling at 70 mph (113 km/h).  
Minimize A/C and defroster usage. Your vehicle is equipped with an  
electric A/C system, which can provide cooling for passenger comfort  
or defrost without running the engine. However, the A/C system uses  
battery energy when the engine is off, which reduces fuel economy.  
Using Auto mode, minimizing use of defrost and Max A/C, and  
choosing a higher temperature setting when cooling can help reduce  
energy usage. See the Climate Control chapter for more information.  
Minimize temperature extremes when the vehicle is parked, for  
example by storing in a garage to avoid extreme cold in winter and  
extreme sun loads in summer. The high voltage battery operates more  
efficiently in moderate temperatures, and less energy will be spent  
returning the passenger compartment to a comfortable temperature.  
Combine errands. Your vehicle is more fuel efficient when the engine  
is warm. Driving to your farthest destination first will warm the engine  
more quickly and may improve fuel economy for the rest of the trip.  
Maintenance  
Keep tires properly inflated and use only recommended size.  
Keep wheels properly aligned.  
Use recommended engine oil. Refer to Maintenance product  
specifications and capacities in this chapter.  
Perform all regularly scheduled maintenance items. Follow the  
recommended maintenance schedule and owner maintenance checks  
found in scheduled maintenance information.  
316  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
Conditions  
Heavily loading a vehicle or towing a trailer may reduce fuel economy  
at any speed.  
Carrying unnecessary weight may reduce fuel economy (approximately  
1 mpg [0.4 km/L] is lost for every 300 lb [136 kg] of weight carried).  
Adding certain accessories to your vehicle (for example; bug  
deflectors, rollbars/light bars, running boards, ski/luggage racks, flags)  
may reduce fuel economy.  
Using fuel blended with alcohol may lower fuel economy.  
Driving on flat terrain offers improved fuel economy as compared to  
driving on mountainous terrain.  
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM  
Your vehicle is equipped with various emission control components and a  
catalytic converter which will enable your vehicle to comply with  
applicable exhaust emission standards. To make sure that the catalytic  
converter and other emission control components continue to work  
properly:  
Use only the specified fuel listed.  
Avoid running out of fuel.  
Do not turn off the ignition while your vehicle is moving, especially at  
high speeds.  
Have the items listed in scheduled maintenance information  
performed according to the specified schedule.  
The scheduled maintenance items listed in scheduled maintenance  
information are essential to the life and performance of your vehicle  
and to its emissions system.  
If other than Ford, Motorcraftor Ford-authorized parts are used for  
maintenance replacements or for service of components affecting  
emission control, such non-Ford parts should be equivalent to genuine  
Ford Motor Company parts in performance and durability.  
WARNING: Do not park, idle, or drive your vehicle in dry grass  
or other dry ground cover. The emission system heats up the  
engine compartment and exhaust system, which can start a fire.  
Illumination of the service engine soon  
indicator, charging system  
warning light or the temperature warning light, fluid leaks, strange odors,  
317  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
smoke or loss of engine power could indicate that the emission control  
system is not working properly.  
An improperly operating or damaged exhaust system may allow exhaust  
to enter the vehicle. Have a damaged or improperly operating exhaust  
system inspected and repaired immediately.  
WARNING: Exhaust leaks may result in entry of harmful and  
potentially lethal fumes into the passenger compartment.  
Do not make any unauthorized changes to your vehicle or engine. By  
law, vehicle owners and anyone who manufactures, repairs, services,  
sells, leases, trades vehicles, or supervises a fleet of vehicles are not  
permitted to intentionally remove an emission control device or prevent  
it from working. Information about your vehicle’s emission system is on  
the Vehicle Emission Control Information Decal located on or near the  
engine. This decal also lists engine displacement.  
Please consult your Warranty Guide for complete emission warranty  
information.  
On-board diagnostics (OBD-II)  
Your vehicle is equipped with a computer that monitors the engine’s  
emission control system. This system is commonly known as the  
on-board diagnostics system (OBD-II). The OBD-II system protects the  
environment by ensuring that your vehicle continues to meet  
government emission standards. The OBD-II system also assists your  
authorized dealer in properly servicing your vehicle. When the service  
engine soon  
a malfunction. Temporary malfunctions may cause the service engine  
soon indicator to illuminate. Examples are:  
indicator illuminates, the OBD-II system has detected  
1. The vehicle has run out of fuel—the engine may misfire or run poorly.  
2. Poor fuel quality or water in the fuel—the engine may misfire or run  
poorly.  
3. The fuel fill inlet may not have been properly closed. See Easy Fuel™  
“no cap” fuel system in this chapter.  
4. Driving through deep water—the electrical system may be wet.  
These temporary malfunctions can be corrected by filling the fuel tank  
with good quality fuel, properly closing the fuel fill inlet or letting the  
electrical system dry out. After three driving cycles without these or any  
other temporary malfunctions present, the service engine soon  
318  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
indicator should stay off the next time the engine is started. A driving  
cycle consists of a cold engine startup followed by mixed city/highway  
driving. No additional vehicle service is required.  
If the service engine soon  
indicator remains on, have your vehicle  
serviced at the first available opportunity. Although some malfunctions  
detected by the OBD-II may not have symptoms that are apparent,  
continued driving with the service engine soon  
indicator on can  
result in increased emissions, lower fuel economy, reduced engine and  
transmission smoothness, and lead to more costly repairs.  
Readiness for Inspection/Maintenance (I/M) testing  
Some state/provincial and local governments may have  
Inspection/Maintenance (I/M) programs to inspect the emission control  
equipment on your vehicle. Failure to pass this inspection could prevent  
you from getting a vehicle registration. Your vehicle may not pass the I/M  
test if the service engine soon  
indicator is on or not working  
properly (bulb is burned out), or if the OBD-II system has determined  
that some of the emission control systems have not been properly  
checked. In this case, the vehicle is considered not ready for I/M testing.  
If the service engine soon  
indicator is on or the bulb does not  
work, the vehicle may need to be serviced. Refer to On-board  
diagnostics (OBD-II) in this chapter.  
If the vehicle’s engine or transmission has just been serviced, or the  
battery has recently run down or been replaced, the OBD-II system may  
indicate that the vehicle is not ready for I/M testing. To determine if the  
vehicle is ready for I/M testing, turn the ignition key to the on position  
for 15 seconds without cranking the engine. If the service engine  
soon  
indicator blinks eight times, it means that the vehicle is not  
ready for I/M testing; if the service engine soon  
indicator stays on  
solid, it means that the vehicle is ready for I/M testing.  
The OBD-II system is designed to check the emission control system  
during normal driving. A complete check may take several days. If the  
vehicle is not ready for I/M testing, the following driving cycle consisting  
of mixed city and highway driving may be performed:  
15 minutes of steady driving on an expressway/highway followed by  
20 minutes of stop-and-go driving with at least four 30-second idle  
periods.  
Allow the vehicle to sit for at least eight hours without starting the  
engine. Then, start the engine and complete the above driving cycle. The  
319  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
engine must warm up to its normal operating temperature. Once started,  
do not turn off the engine until the above driving cycle is complete. If  
the vehicle is still not ready for I/M testing, the above driving cycle will  
have to be repeated.  
BRAKE FLUID  
The fluid level will drop slowly as  
the brakes wear, and will rise when  
the brake components are replaced.  
Check fluid levels with the ignition  
in the on position. Fluid levels  
between the MIN and MAX lines are  
within the normal operating range;  
there is no need to add fluid.  
If the fluid levels are outside of the  
normal operating range the  
performance of your brake system could be compromised; seek service  
from your authorized dealer immediately.  
TRANSMISSION FLUID  
Checking electronically-controlled Continuously Variable  
Transmission (eCVT)  
The eCVT does not have an underhood transmission fluid dipstick.  
Your transmission does not consume fluid. It is designed to be filled for  
life. However, the fluid level should be checked if the transmission is not  
working properly, or if you notice some sign of fluid leakage.  
Transmission fluid should be checked and, if required, fluid  
should be added by an authorized dealer.  
Do not use supplemental transmission fluid additives, treatments or  
cleaning agents. The use of these materials may affect transmission  
operation and result in damage to internal transmission components.  
AIR FILTER  
Refer to scheduled maintenance information for the appropriate  
intervals for changing the air filter element.  
When changing the air filter element, use only the air filter element  
listed. Refer to Motorcraftpart numbers in this chapter.  
320  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
WARNING: To reduce the risk of vehicle damage and/or  
personal burn injuries do not start your engine with the air  
cleaner removed and do not remove it while the engine is running.  
Changing the air filter element  
1. Release the clamps that secure the air filter housing cover.  
2. Carefully separate the two halves  
of the air filter housing.  
3. Remove the air filter element from the air filter housing.  
4. Wipe the air filter housing and cover clean to remove any dirt or  
debris and to ensure good sealing.  
5. Install a new air filter element. Be careful not to crimp the filter  
element edges between the air filter housing and cover. This could cause  
filter damage and allow unfiltered air to enter the engine if not properly  
seated.  
6. Replace the air filter housing cover and secure the clamps.  
Note: Failure to use the correct air filter element may result in severe  
engine damage. The customer warranty may be voided for any damage to  
the engine if the correct air filter element is not used.  
VEHICLE STORAGE  
If you plan on storing your vehicle for an extended period of time  
(30 days or more), refer to the following maintenance recommendations  
to ensure your vehicle stays in good operating condition.  
All motor vehicles and their components were engineered and tested for  
reliable, regular driving. Long term storage under various conditions may  
lead to component degradation or failure unless specific precautions are  
taken to preserve the components.  
321  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
General  
Store all vehicles in a dry, ventilated place.  
Protect from sunlight, if possible.  
If vehicles are stored outside, they require regular maintenance to  
protect against rust and damage.  
Body  
Wash vehicle thoroughly to remove dirt, grease, oil, tar or mud from  
exterior surfaces, rear-wheel housing and underside of front fenders.  
See the Cleaning chapter for more information.  
Periodically wash vehicles stored in exposed locations.  
Touch-up raw or primed metal to prevent rust.  
Cover chrome and stainless steel parts with a thick coat of auto wax  
to prevent discoloration. Re-wax as necessary when the vehicle is  
washed. See the Cleaning chapter for more information.  
Lubricate all hood, door and trunk lid hinges, and latches with a light  
grade oil. See the Cleaning chapter for more information.  
Cover interior trim to prevent fading.  
Keep all rubber parts free from oil and solvents.  
Engine  
The engine oil and filter should be changed prior to storage, as used  
engine oil contain contaminates that may cause engine damage.  
Start the engine every 15 days. Run at fast idle until it reaches normal  
operating temperature.  
With your foot on the brake, shift through all the gears while the  
engine is running.  
Fuel system  
Fill the fuel tank with high-quality fuel until the first automatic shutoff  
of the fuel pump nozzle.  
Note: During extended periods of vehicle storage (30 days or more),  
fuel may deteriorate due to oxidation. Add MotorcraftGas Stabilizer or  
equivalent meeting Ford material specification ESE-M99C112-A to the  
vehicle fuel system whenever actual or expected storage periods exceed  
30 days. Follow the instructions on the additive label. The vehicle should  
then be operated at idle speed to circulate the additive throughout the  
fuel system.  
322  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
Cooling system  
Protect against freezing temperatures.  
When removing vehicle from storage, check coolant fluid level.  
Confirm there are no cooling system leaks, and fluid is at the  
recommended level.  
Battery  
Check and recharge as necessary. Keep connections clean.  
If storing your vehicle for more than 30 days without recharging the  
battery, it may be advisable to disconnect the battery cables to ensure  
battery charge is maintained for quick starting.  
Note: If battery cables are disconnected, it will be necessary to reset  
memory features.  
Brakes  
Make sure brakes and parking brake are fully released.  
Tires  
Maintain recommended air pressure.  
Miscellaneous  
Make sure all linkages, cables, levers and pins under vehicle are  
covered with grease to prevent rust.  
Move vehicles at least 25 feet (8 m) every 15 days to lubricate  
working parts and prevent corrosion.  
Removing vehicle from storage  
When your vehicle is ready to come out of storage, do the following:  
Wash your vehicle to remove any dirt or grease film build-up on  
window surfaces.  
Check windshield wipers for any deterioration.  
Check under the hood for any foreign material that may have collected  
during storage (mice/squirrel nests).  
Check the exhaust for any foreign material that may have collected  
during storage.  
Check tire pressures and set tire inflation per the Tire Label.  
Check brake pedal operation. Drive the vehicle 15 ft (4.5 meters) back  
and forth to remove rust build up.  
Check fluid levels (including coolant, oil and gas) to make sure there  
are no leaks, and fluids are at recommended levels.  
323  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
If the battery was removed, clean the battery cable ends and inspect.  
If you have any concerns or issues, contact your authorized dealer.  
MOTORCRAFT PART NUMBERS  
Component  
2.5L I4 engine  
Oil filter  
Spark plugs  
FL-910  
1
Engine air filter element  
Cabin air filter  
FA-1772  
FP-66  
Low voltage (underhood)  
battery  
BXT-96R  
1For spark plug replacement, see your authorized dealer. Refer to  
scheduled maintenance information chapter for the appropriate  
intervals for changing the spark plugs.  
Replace the spark plugs with ones that meet Ford material and  
design specifications for your vehicle, such as Motorcraftor  
equivalent replacement parts. The customer warranty may be  
void for any damage to the engine if such spark plugs are not  
used.  
324  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
325  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
326  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
327  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
ENGINE DATA  
Engine  
2.5L I4 engine  
Cubic inches  
Required fuel  
Firing order  
152  
87 octane  
1-3-4-2  
Ignition system  
Spark plug gap  
Compression ratio  
Coil on plug  
0.049–0.053 inch (1.25–1.35mm)  
12.3:1  
Engine drivebelt routing  
HIGH VOLTAGE BATTERY DATA  
High voltage battery  
Battery chemistry  
Nominal voltage  
Nickel metal hydride  
330 volts  
Battery system capacity  
6 amp-hours  
328  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
IDENTIFYING YOUR VEHICLE  
Safety Compliance Certification Label  
The National Highway Traffic Safety  
Administration Regulations require  
that a Safety Compliance  
Certification Label be affixed to a  
vehicle and prescribe where the  
Safety Compliance Certification  
Label may be located. The Safety  
Compliance Certification Label is  
located on the structure (B-Pillar)  
by the trailing edge of the driver’s  
door or the edge of the driver’s  
door.  
Vehicle identification number (VIN)  
The vehicle identification number is  
located on the driver side  
instrument panel.  
XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX  
Please note that in the graphic,  
XXXX is representative of your  
vehicle identification number.  
329  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
The Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) contains the following  
information:  
1. World manufacturer identifier  
2. Brake system / Gross Vehicle  
Weight Rating (GVWR) / Restraint  
Devices and their location  
3. Make, vehicle line, series, body  
type  
4. Engine type  
5. Check digit  
6. Model year  
7. Assembly plant  
8. Production sequence number  
TRANSMISSION CODE DESIGNATIONS  
You can find a transmission code on  
the Safety Compliance Certification  
Label. The following table tells you  
which transmission each code  
represents.  
Description  
Code  
Electronically-controlled continuously variable  
transmission, eCVT  
H
330  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Accessories  
FORD CUSTOM ACCESSORIES FOR YOUR VEHICLE  
A wide selection of Ford Custom Accessories are available for your  
vehicle through your local Ford or Ford of Canada dealer. These quality  
accessories have been specifically engineered to fulfill your automotive  
needs; they are custom designed to complement the style and  
aerodynamic appearance of your vehicle. In addition, each accessory is  
made from high quality materials and meets or exceeds Ford’s rigorous  
engineering and safety specifications. Ford Motor Company will repair or  
replace any properly dealer-installed Ford Custom Accessories found to  
be defective in factory-supplied materials or workmanship during the  
warranty period, as well as any component damaged by the defective  
accessories. The accessories will be warranted for whichever provides  
you the greatest benefit:  
12 months or 12,000 miles (20,000 km) (whichever occurs first), or  
the remainder of your new vehicle limited warranty.  
Contact your dealer for details and a copy of the warranty.  
The following is a list of several Ford Custom Accessories. Not all  
accessories are available for all models. For a complete listing of the  
accessories that are available for your vehicle, please contact your dealer  
or visit our online store at: www.fordaccessories.com.  
Exterior style  
Bug shields  
Deflectors  
Rear spoiler  
Splash guards  
Custom graphics*  
Interior style  
Ambient lighting kit  
Floor mats  
Subwoofer*  
Custom seat covers*  
Rear seat entertainment*  
331  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Accessories  
Lifestyle  
Ash cup / smoker’s package  
Cross bars  
Roof racks and carriers*  
Rear bumper protector*  
Cargo net*  
Navigation*  
SUV camping net*  
Cargo organization and  
management  
Peace of mind  
Keyless entry keypad  
Wheel locks  
Windshield wiper shaker*  
Back up camera*  
Vehicle tracking and recovery*  
Protective seat covers*  
Back up alarm*  
Bumper and hitch mounted  
parking sensors*  
*Ford Licensed Accessories (FLA) are warranted by the accessory  
manufacturer’s warranty. Ford Licensed Accessories are fully designed  
and developed by the accessory manufacturer and have not been  
designed or tested to Ford Motor Company engineering requirements.  
Contact your Ford dealer for details regarding the manufacturer’s limited  
warranty and/or a copy of the FLA product limited warranty offered by  
the accessory manufacturer.  
For maximum vehicle performance, keep the following information in  
mind when adding accessories or equipment to your vehicle:  
When adding accessories, equipment, passengers and luggage to your  
vehicle, do not exceed the total weight capacity of the vehicle or of  
the front or rear axle (GVWR or GAWR as indicated on the Safety  
Compliance Certification label). Consult your authorized dealer for  
specific weight information.  
The Federal Communications Commission (FCC) and Canadian Radio  
Telecommunications Commission (CRTC) regulate the use of mobile  
communications systems — such as two-way radios, telephones and  
theft alarms - that are equipped with radio transmitters. Any such  
equipment installed in your vehicle should comply with FCC or CRTC  
regulations and should be installed only by a qualified service  
technician.  
332  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Accessories  
Mobile communications systems may harm the operation of your  
vehicle, particularly if they are not properly designed for automotive  
use.  
To avoid interference with other vehicle functions, such as anti-lock  
braking systems, amateur radio users who install radios and antennas  
onto their vehicle should not locate the Amateur Radio Antennas in  
the area of the driver’s side hood.  
Electrical or electronic accessories or components that are added to  
the vehicle by the authorized dealer or the owner may adversely affect  
battery performance and durability.  
333  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Ford Extended Service Plan  
FORD ESP EXTENDED SERVICE PLANS (U.S. ONLY)  
More than 30 million Ford, Lincoln, and Mercury owners have discovered  
the powerful protection of Ford ESP. It is the only extended service plan  
backed by Ford Motor Company, and provides “peace of mind”  
protection beyond the New Vehicle Limited Warranty coverage.  
Up to 500+ Covered Vehicle Components  
There are four, new-vehicle Extended Service Plans with different levels  
of coverage. Ask your dealer for details.  
PremiumCare – Our most comprehensive coverage. With over 500  
covered components, this plan is so complete that we generally only  
discuss what’s not covered!  
ExtraCare – Covers 113 components, and includes many high-tech  
items.  
BaseCare – Covers 84 components.  
PowertrainCare – Covers 29 critical components.  
Ford ESP is honored by all Ford, Lincoln and Mercury Dealers in  
the U.S. and Canada It’s the only extended service plan authorized and  
backed by Ford Motor Company. That means you get:  
Reliable, quality service anywhere you go.  
Factory-trained technicians.  
Genuine Ford and MotorcraftParts.  
Rental car reimbursement  
If your vehicle is kept overnight for covered repairs, you are  
eligible for rental car coverage, including Bumper-to-Bumper warranty  
repairs, or manufacturer’s recalls.  
Transferable coverage  
If you sell your vehicle before your Ford ESP coverage expires, you can  
transfer any remaining coverage to the new owner. Whenever you’re  
ready to sell your car, prospective buyers may feel better about taking a  
risk on your used vehicle. Ford ESP may add resale value!  
Plus, exclusive 24/7 roadside assistance, including:  
Towing, flat-tire change and battery jump starts.  
Out-of-fuel and lock-out assistance.  
Travel expense reimbursement for lodging, meals and rental car.  
Destination assistance for taxi, shuttle, rental car coverage and  
emergency transportation.  
334  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Ford Extended Service Plan  
Ford ESP Can Quickly Pay for Itself  
One service bill – the cost of parts and labor – can easily exceed the  
price of your Ford ESP Service Contract. With Ford ESP, you minimize  
your risk for unexpected repair bills and rising repair costs.  
Avoid the rising cost of properly maintaining your vehicle!  
Ford ESP also offers a Premium Maintenance Plan that covers items that  
routinely wear out.  
The coverage is prepaid, so you never have to worry about affording  
your vehicle maintenance. It covers regular checkups, routine  
inspections, preventive care and replacement of items that require  
periodic attention for normal “wear”:  
Wiper blades  
Brake pads and linings  
Spark plugs (except California) Shock absorbers  
Clutch disc  
Belts and hoses  
Contact your selling Ford, Lincoln, or Mercury dealership today so they  
can customize a Ford Extended Service Plan that fits your driving  
lifestyle and budget.  
Interest free finance options available  
Take advantage of our installment payment plan, just a 10% down  
payment will provide you with an affordable no interest, no-fee payment  
opportunity.  
335  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Ford Extended Service Plan  
336  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Ford Extended Service Plan  
FORD ESP EXTENDED SERVICE PLANS (CANADA ONLY)  
You can get more protection for your vehicle by purchasing a Ford  
Extended Service Plan (ESP). Ford ESP is the only service contract  
backed by Ford Motor Company. Depending on the plan you purchase,  
Ford ESP provides benefits such as:  
Rental reimbursement  
Coverage for certain maintenance and wear items  
Protection against repair costs after your New Vehicle Limited  
Warranty Coverage expires  
Roadside Assistance benefits  
You may purchase Ford ESP from any participating Ford Motor Company  
dealership. There are several Ford ESP plans available in various time,  
distance and deductible combinations. Each plan is tailored to fit your  
own driving needs, including reimbursement for towing and rental.  
When you purchase Ford ESP, you receive peace-of-mind protection  
throughout Canada and the United States, provided by a network of Ford  
Motor Company dealers.  
For more information, visit your local Ford of Canada dealer or  
www.ford.ca to find the Ford Extended Service Plan that is right for you.  
NOTE: Repairs performed outside of Canada and the United States are  
not eligible for Ford ESP coverage. This information is subject to change.  
337  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Scheduled Maintenance Guide  
GENERAL MAINTENANCE INFORMATION  
Why maintain your vehicle?  
This guide describes the scheduled maintenance required for your  
vehicle. Carefully following this schedule helps protect against major  
repair expenses resulting from neglect or inadequate maintenance and  
may also help to increase the value of your vehicle when you sell or  
trade it.  
It is your responsibility to see that all scheduled maintenance is  
performed and that the materials used meet Ford engineering  
specifications. Failure to perform scheduled maintenance specific in this  
guide will invalidate warranty coverage on parts affected by the lack of  
maintenance. Be sure receipts for completed maintenance are kept with  
the vehicle and confirmation of the work performed is always recorded in  
this guide.  
Your Ford or Lincoln Mercury dealer has factory-trained technicians who  
can perform the required maintenance using genuine Ford parts. They  
are committed to meeting your service needs and to assuring your  
continuing satisfaction.  
Protecting your investment  
Maintenance is an investment that will pay dividends in the form of  
improved reliability, durability and resale value. To ensure the proper  
performance of your vehicle and its emission control systems, it is  
imperative that scheduled maintenance be completed at the designated  
intervals.  
Your vehicle is very sophisticated and built with multiple complex  
performance systems. Every manufacturer develops these systems using  
different specifications and performance features. That’s why it’s  
important to rely upon your Ford or Lincoln Mercury dealership to  
properly diagnose and repair your vehicle.  
Ford Motor Company has recommended maintenance intervals for  
various parts and component systems based upon engineering testing.  
Ford Motor Company relies upon this testing to determine the most  
appropriate mileage for replacement of oils and fluids to protect your  
vehicle at the lowest overall cost to you and recommends against  
maintenance schedules that deviate from the scheduled maintenance  
information.  
338  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Scheduled Maintenance Guide  
Ford strongly recommends the use of genuine Ford replacement parts.  
Parts other than Ford, Motorcraftor Ford-authorized remanufactured  
parts that are used for maintenance replacement or for the service of  
components affecting emission control must be equivalent to genuine  
Ford Motor Company parts in performance and durability. It is the  
owner’s responsibility to determine the equivalency of such parts. Please  
consult your Warranty Guide for complete warranty information.  
Non-Ford approved chemicals or additives are not required for factory  
recommended maintenance. In fact, Ford Motor Company recommends  
against the use of such additive products unless specifically  
recommended by Ford for a particular application.  
Oil, fluids and flushing  
In many cases, fluid discoloration is a normal operating characteristic  
and, by itself, does not necessarily indicate a concern or that the fluid  
needs to be changed. However, discolored fluids that also show signs of  
overheating and/or foreign material contamination should be inspected  
immediately by a qualified expert such as the factory-trained technicians  
at your Ford or Lincoln Mercury Dealership. Your vehicle’s oils and fluids  
should be changed at the specified intervals or in conjunction with a  
repair. Flushing is a viable way to change fluid for many vehicle  
sub-systems during scheduled maintenance. It is critical that systems are  
flushed only with new fluid that is the same as that required to fill and  
operate the system, or using a Ford-approved flushing chemical.  
Genuine Ford parts and service  
When planning your maintenance services, consider your Ford and  
Lincoln Mercury dealership for all your vehicle’s needs.  
Get the most from your service and maintenance visits  
There are a lot of reasons why visiting your Ford or Lincoln Mercury  
dealership for all your service needs is a great way to help keep your  
vehicle running great.  
Convenience  
Many dealerships have extended evening and Saturday hours to make  
your service visit more convenient. How’s that for quality service?  
339  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Scheduled Maintenance Guide  
Factory-trained technicians  
Ford and Lincoln Mercury service technicians participate in extensive  
factory-sponsored certification training to help them become experts on  
the operation of your vehicle. Ask your dealership about the training and  
certification their technicians have received.  
Genuine Ford and Motorcraftreplacement parts  
Ford and Lincoln Mercury dealerships stock Ford and Motorcraft௡  
branded replacement parts. These parts meet or exceed Ford Motor  
Company’s specifications, and we stand behind them. Parts installed at  
your Ford or Lincoln Mercury dealership carry a nationwide, 12 months,  
12,000 mile (20,000 km) parts and labor limited warranty. Your dealer  
can give you details.  
Value shopping for your vehicle’s maintenance needs  
Your dealership recognizes the competitive landscape of maintenance and  
light repair automotive services. With factory-trained technicians, and  
one-stop service from routine maintenance like oil changes and tire  
rotations to repairs like brake service, check out the value your Ford and  
Lincoln Mercury dealers can offer.  
WHICH MAINTENANCE SCHEDULE SHOULD YOU FOLLOW?  
Owner checks and services  
Certain basic maintenance checks and inspections should be performed  
by the owner or a service technician at the intervals indicated. Service  
information and supporting specifications are provided in this owner’s  
guide.  
Any adverse condition should be brought to the attention of your dealer  
or qualified service technician as soon as possible for the proper service  
advice. The owner maintenance service checks are generally not covered  
by warranties so you may be charged for labor, parts or lubricants used.  
Maximum oil change interval  
As indicated by the instrument cluster message center (can be up to one year or 10,000 miles [16,000 km])  
Engine and motor/electronics coolant change interval  
6 years or 100,000 miles (160,000 km) - change engine and motor/electronics coolant (whichever comes first)  
After initial change - change engine and motor/electronics coolant every 3 years or 50,000 miles (80,000 km)  
340  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Scheduled Maintenance Guide  
Check every month  
Check function of all interior and exterior lights  
Check tires for wear and correct air pressure, including spare tire  
Check windshield washer fluid level  
Check engine oil level  
Check every six months  
Check lap/shoulder belts and seat latches for wear and function  
Check parking brake for proper operation  
Check safety warning lamps (brake, ABS, airbag, safety belt) for operation  
Check cooling system fluid levels and strength  
Check battery connections and clean if necessary  
Check washer spray, wiper operation and clean all wiper blades (replace as necessary)  
Check and lubricate all hinges, latches and outside locks. Inspect for correct operation  
Check and lubricate door rubber weatherstrips. Inspect for excessive wear  
Check and clean body and door drain holes. Inspect for clogs and obstructions  
Multi-point inspection  
In order to keep your vehicle running right, it is important to have the  
systems on your vehicle checked regularly. This can help identify  
potential issues and prevent major problems. Ford Motor Company  
recommends the following multi-point inspection be performed at every  
scheduled maintenance interval to help ensure your vehicle keeps  
running great.  
341  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Scheduled Maintenance Guide  
Multi-point inspection - Recommended at every visit  
Check and top-up fluid levels: brake, coolant recovery reservoir, manual and automatic transmission (if equipped with an  
underhood dipstick), power steering (if equipped) and window washer  
Inspect tires for wear and check air pressure, including spare.  
Check exhaust system for leaks, damage, loose parts and foreign material.  
Check battery performance.  
Check operation of horn, exterior lamps, turn signals and hazard warning lights.  
Check radiator, coolers, heater and air conditioning hoses.  
Inspect windshield washer spray and wiper operation.  
Check windshield for cracks, chips and pitting.  
Inspect for oil and fluid leaks.  
Inspect engine air filter.  
Inspect half shaft dust boots, if equipped.  
Check shocks and struts and other suspension components for leaks and damage.  
Inspect steering and linkage.  
Inspect accessory drive belt(s).  
Inspect clutch operation, if equipped.  
Be sure to ask your Ford or Lincoln Mercury dealership service advisor  
or technician about the multi-point vehicle inspection. It’s a  
comprehensive way to perform a thorough inspection of your vehicle. It’s  
your checklist that gives you immediate feedback on the overall  
condition of your vehicle. You’ll know what’s been checked, what’s okay,  
as well as those things that may require future or immediate attention.  
The multi-point vehicle inspection is one more way to keep your vehicle  
running great!  
342  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Scheduled Maintenance Guide  
343  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Scheduled Maintenance Guide  
NORMAL SCHEDULED MAINTENANCE AND LOG  
The following section contains the “Normal Schedule”. This schedule is  
presented at specific mileage (kilometer) intervals with exceptions  
noted. Reset your oil life monitoring system after each engine oil and  
filter change; refer to the Instrument Cluster chapter.  
344  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Scheduled Maintenance Guide  
345  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Scheduled Maintenance Guide  
Every 20,000 miles  
(32,000 km)  
Replace cabin air filter (if equipped)  
Every 30,000 miles  
(48,000 km)  
Replace climate-controlled seat filter  
(if equipped)  
Replace engine air filter  
Every 100,000 miles  
(160,000 km)  
Change engine coolant and motor/electronics  
coolant1  
Replace spark plugs  
Inspect accessory drive belt(s)2  
Replace accessory drive belt(s) if not replaced  
within the last 100,000 miles (160,000 km)  
Every 150,000 miles  
(240,000 km)  
1Initial replacement at 100,000 miles (160,000 km) or 72 months; every  
50,000 miles (80,000 km) or 36 months thereafter  
2Perform a follow-up inspection at 120,000 miles (192,000 km)  
346  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Scheduled Maintenance Guide  
Maintenance schedule log  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
P&A CODE:  
P&A CODE:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
HOURS:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
HOURS:  
MILEAGE:  
MILEAGE:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
MILEAGE:  
MILEAGE:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
MILEAGE:  
MILEAGE:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
MILEAGE:  
MILEAGE:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
MILEAGE:  
MILEAGE:  
347  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Scheduled Maintenance Guide  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
P&A CODE:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
HOURS:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
MILEAGE:  
MILEAGE:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
MILEAGE:  
MILEAGE:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
MILEAGE:  
MILEAGE:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
MILEAGE:  
MILEAGE:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
MILEAGE:  
MILEAGE:  
348  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Scheduled Maintenance Guide  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
MILEAGE:  
MILEAGE:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
MILEAGE:  
MILEAGE:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
MILEAGE:  
MILEAGE:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
MILEAGE:  
MILEAGE:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
MILEAGE:  
MILEAGE:  
349  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Scheduled Maintenance Guide  
SPECIAL OPERATING CONDITIONS  
If you operate your Ford/Lincoln/Mercury vehicle primarily in one of the  
more demanding Special Operating Conditions listed below, you will  
need to have some items maintained more frequently. If you only  
occasionally operate your vehicle under these conditions, it is not  
necessary to perform the additional maintenance. For specific  
recommendations, see your Ford or Lincoln Mercury dealership service  
advisor or technician.  
Towing a trailer or using a camper or car-top carrier  
Every 5,000 miles, 6 months or – Change engine oil and replace oil filter  
200 hours of engine operation  
(whichever comes first)  
Every 5,000 miles (8,000 km) – Inspect wheels and related components for abnormal  
noise, wear, looseness or drag.  
– Rotate tires, inspect tires for wear and measure tread  
depth.  
Extensive idling and/or low speed driving for long distances as in heavy  
commercial use such as delivery, taxi, patrol vehicle or livery. This  
operating condition is for extensive maximum A/C or heater operation  
with engine on in the above listed usage.  
Inspect frequently, service as – Replace cabin air filter (if equipped).  
required  
Every 5,000 miles, 6 months or – Change engine oil and replace oil filter  
200 hours of engine operation  
(whichever comes first)  
Every 5,000 miles (8,000 km) – Inspect wheels and related components for abnormal  
noise, wear, looseness or drag.  
– Rotate tires, inspect tires for wear and measure tread  
depth.  
Every 60,000 miles (96,000 km) – Replace spark plugs.  
350  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Scheduled Maintenance Guide  
Operating in dusty conditions such as unpaved or dusty roads  
Inspect frequently, service as – Replace cabin air filter (if equipped).  
required  
– Replace engine air filter.  
Every 5,000 miles, 6 months or – Change engine oil and replace oil filter.  
200 hours of engine operation  
(whichever comes first)  
Every 5,000 miles (8,000 km) – Inspect wheels and related components for abnormal  
noise, wear, looseness or drag.  
– Rotate tires, inspect tires for wear and measure tread  
depth.  
Reset your oil life monitor after each engine oil and filter change; refer  
to the Instrument Cluster chapter.  
Off-road operation  
Inspect frequently, service as – Replace cabin air filter (if equipped).  
required  
– Replace engine air filter.  
Every 5,000 miles, 6 months or – Change engine oil and replace oil filter.  
200 hours of engine operation  
(whichever comes first)  
– Inspect wheels and related components for abnormal  
noise, wear, looseness or drag.  
– Rotate tires, inspect tires for wear and measure tread  
depth.  
Reset your oil life monitor after each engine oil and filter change; refer  
to the Instrument Cluster chapter.  
Exclusive use of E85 (Flex Fuel Vehicles only)  
Every oil change interval – If ran exclusively on E85, fill the fuel tank full with  
regular unleaded fuel.  
351  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Scheduled Maintenance Guide  
Special operating condition log  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
MILEAGE:  
MILEAGE:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
MILEAGE:  
MILEAGE:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
MILEAGE:  
MILEAGE:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
MILEAGE:  
MILEAGE:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
MILEAGE:  
MILEAGE:  
352  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Scheduled Maintenance Guide  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
MILEAGE:  
MILEAGE:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
MILEAGE:  
MILEAGE:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
MILEAGE:  
MILEAGE:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
MILEAGE:  
MILEAGE:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
MILEAGE:  
MILEAGE:  
353  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Scheduled Maintenance Guide  
EXCEPTIONS  
In addition, there are several exceptions to the Normal Schedule. They  
are listed below:  
Normal vehicle axle maintenance  
Rear axles and power take-off (PTO) units containing synthetic lubricant and light duty trucks equipped with Ford-design  
axles are lubricated for life. These lubricants are not to be checked or changed unless a leak is suspected, service is re-  
quired or the axle assembly has been submerged in water. The axle and PTO lubricant should be changed anytime the axle  
and PTO have been submerged in water. During extended trailer tow operation above 70°F (21°C) ambient and wide open  
throttle for extended periods above 45 mph (72 km/h), non-synthetic rear axle lubricants should be replaced every  
3,000 miles (4,800 km) or three months, whichever occurs first. The 3,000 mile (4,800 km) lubricant change interval  
may be waived if the axle was filled with 75W140 synthetic gear lubricant meeting Ford specification WSL-M2C192-A, part  
number F1TZ-19580-B or equivalent. Add friction modifier XL-3 (EST-M2C118-A) or equivalent for complete refill of Traction-  
Lok rear axles (refer to Maintenance product and specifications in the Maintenance and Specifications chapter for details).  
The axle lubricant should be changed anytime an axle has been submerged in water.  
Police/Taxi/Livery vehicle axle maintenance  
Replace rear axle lubricant every 100,000 miles (160,000 km). Rear axle lubricant change may be waived if the axle  
was filled with 75W140 synthetic gear lubricant meeting Ford specification WSL-M2C192-A, part number FITZ-19580-B or  
equivalent. Add four ounces (118 mL) of friction modifier XL-3 (EST-M2C118-A) or equivalent for complete refill of Traction-  
Lok rear axles. The axle lubricant should be changed anytime the axle has been submerged in water.  
California fuel filter replacement  
If vehicle is registered in California, the California Air Resources Board has determined that the failure to perform this main-  
tenance item will not nullify the emission warranty or limit recall liability prior to the completion of the vehicle’s useful life.  
Ford Motor Company, however, urges you to have all recommended maintenance services performed at the specified inter-  
vals and to record all vehicle service.  
Hot climate oil change intervals  
If operating conditions are normal and you drive your Ford, Lincoln or Mercury vehicle under typical, everyday conditions  
and you are using an API performance category oil of SL or later (for example SM, etc.) then you can follow the  
7,500 mile (12,000 km) normal service oil change intervals schedule. Vehicles operating in the Middle East, North Africa,  
Sub-Saharan Africa or locations with similar climates must follow the oil change interval of 3,000 mile (5,000 km) if the  
owner is using oils defined by the American Petroleum Institute (API) performance category of API SK or earlier (for ex-  
ample SJ, etc.).  
Engine air filter & cabin air filter replacement  
Engine air filter and cabin air filter life is dependent on exposure to dusty and dirty conditions. Vehicles operated in these  
conditions will require frequent inspection and replacement of the engine air filter and cabin air filter.  
354  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Scheduled Maintenance Guide  
COOLANT CHANGE RECORD  
Engine coolant  
6 years or 100,000 miles (160,000 km) - change engine and motor/electronics coolant (whichever comes first).  
After initial change - change engine and motor/electronics coolant every 3 years or 50,000 miles (80,000 km).  
355  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Scheduled Maintenance Guide  
Engine coolant change log  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
MILEAGE:  
MILEAGE:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
MILEAGE:  
MILEAGE:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
MILEAGE:  
MILEAGE:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
MILEAGE:  
MILEAGE:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
DEALER VALIDATION:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
P&A CODE:  
HOURS:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
RO#:  
DATE:  
MILEAGE:  
MILEAGE:  
356  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
A
Axle  
B
Air conditioning  
C
Automatic transaxle  
Automatic transmission  
357  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Index  
D
Cleaning your vehicle  
Dipstick  
E
Emergencies, roadside  
Controls  
Coolant  
358  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
G
F
H
Four-Wheel Drive vehicles  
Heating  
I
Instrument panel  
359  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
J
M
K
Manual transmission  
Keyless entry system  
L
Lamps  
N
O
P
Locks  
360  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
S
R
Scheduled Maintenance Guide  
361  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
Special notice  
Steering wheel  
Stereo  
T
U
Tire Pressure Monitoring  
System (TPMS)  
V
362  
2011 Escape Hybrid (ehv)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Edimax Technology Network Card Ethernet Cardbus Adapter User Manual
Fujioh Ventilation Hood BUF 04J User Manual
Fujitsu Security Camera RX100 S3 User Manual
Fujitsu Water Dispenser MAN3184 User Manual
Gaggenau Dishwasher DF 241 User Manual
Gardena Trimmer THS 400 User Manual
GarrettCom Switch 500 Series User Manual
Gefen TV Converter Box EXT 3GSDI 2 HDMI13 User Manual
GE Washer WWA8850S User Manual
Gianni Industries Door LZ 300N User Manual